faculty handbook - university of the incarnate...
TRANSCRIPT
2
Table of Contents
Letter from the President .............................................................................................................................................. 7
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................................... 8 Mission Statement................................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 Faculty and Shared Governance at UIW ................................................................................................................................................................. 8
CHAPTER 2: THE STRUCTURE OF ACADEMIC ORGANIZATION ............................................................. 10 General Administration ............................................................................................................................................. 10
Principles Governing Policies ............................................................................................................................................................................... 10 Major Administrative Committees ........................................................................................................................... 14
Executive Council ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 14 Institutional Effectiveness Council ....................................................................................................................................................................... 14 Core Advisory Council ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 15 Academic Deans Councils .................................................................................................................................................................................... 15
Academic Administration .......................................................................................................................................... 16 Provost .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 Associate Provost for Institutional Effectiveness .................................................................................................................................................. 16 Assistant/Associate Provost .................................................................................................................................................................................. 16 Vice President for Extended Academic Programs ................................................................................................................................................. 16 Vice President for International Affairs ................................................................................................................................................................ 16 Academic Deans ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 16
CHAPTER 3: FACULTY SENATE CONSTITUTION AND BYLAWS .............................................................. 22 Preamble ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 Article I - Name .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 Article II - Purposes / Responsibilities .................................................................................................................................................................. 22 Article III - Membership ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 22 Article IV - Officers and Standing Committees .................................................................................................................................................... 23 Article V - Elections and Terms of Office ............................................................................................................................................................ 23 Article VI - Meetings ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 24 Article VII - Officers’ and Senators’ Duties and Responsibilities ......................................................................................................................... 25 Article VIII - Senate Executive Committee .......................................................................................................................................................... 26 Article IX - Nominations and Elections Committee .............................................................................................................................................. 26 Article X - Grievance Committee ......................................................................................................................................................................... 27 Article XI - Undergraduate Council ...................................................................................................................................................................... 28 Article XII - Graduate Council ............................................................................................................................................................................. 29 Article XIII - Faculty Affairs Committee .............................................................................................................................................................. 29 Article XIV - Rank and Tenure Committee .......................................................................................................................................................... 29 Article XV - Faculty Development Fund Review Committee ............................................................................................................................... 29 Article XVI - Amendments ................................................................................................................................................................................... 30 Article XVII - Ratification .................................................................................................................................................................................... 30 Faculty Governance Representation Chart ............................................................................................................................................................ 31
CHAPTER 4: POLICIES AND PROCEDURES GOVERNING FULL-TIME FACULTY EMPLOYMENT . 32 General Statement on Policies Concerning Faculty ................................................................................................. 32 Faculty Membership ................................................................................................................................................... 32
General Faculty ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32 Graduate Faculty ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 32
Policies on Academic Freedom .................................................................................................................................. 33 Faculty Personnel Policies .......................................................................................................................................... 33
General Duties and Responsibilities...................................................................................................................................................................... 33 Workload .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 33 Guidelines for Evidence of Institutional Fit with the Mission of UIW .................................................................................................................. 34
Appointment ................................................................................................................................................................ 35 Statement of Terms of Appointment ..................................................................................................................................................................... 35 Initial Appointments ............................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 Contracts for Services ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 36 Faculty Titles ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 36
Reappointment, Promotion, and Tenure .................................................................................................................. 38 General Criteria .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 Promotion in Rank ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 38
3
Procedures for Promotion in Rank to Senior Instructor......................................................................................................................................... 39 College/School Rank and Tenure Advisory Committee Guidelines ...................................................................................................................... 39 Application Timeline for Promotion to Senior Instructor ...................................................................................................................................... 40 Procedures for Promotion in Rank to Assistant Professor ..................................................................................................................................... 40 Promotion in Rank to Associate Professor and Tenure ......................................................................................................................................... 41 Application Timeline for Third-Year Review ....................................................................................................................................................... 42 Procedures for Tenure/Promotion to Associate Professor ..................................................................................................................................... 42 Procedures for Promotion in Rank to Full Professor ............................................................................................................................................. 44 Application Timeline for Tenure/Promotion to Associate Professor and Full Professor ....................................................................................... 44 Portfolio Instructions to Faculty from the Chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee ........................................................................................... 46 Format for Tenure/Promotion Portfolio and Checklists ........................................................................................................................................ 48 Designation of Relative Weight of Faculty Work ................................................................................................................................................. 49 Self Evaluation Form Checklists ........................................................................................................................................................................... 50 Scholarship Activity Checklist Guidelines Name ................................................................................................................................ 52 Administrators with Faculty Status ....................................................................................................................................................................... 55 Guidelines for Academic Administrators Seeking Tenure .................................................................................................................................... 56 Non-Reappointment of Probationary Faculty or Faculty Not on the Tenure Track ............................................................................................... 58 Non-Tenure Track Non-Reappointment Appeal Process....................................................................................................................................... 59 Tenure Track and Denial of Recommendation for Promotion Appeal Process ..................................................................................................... 59 Sexual Harassment, National Origin Harassment, and Other Forms of Prohibited Behavior ................................................................................ 60 Termination of Appointment by the Faculty Member ........................................................................................................................................... 60 Termination of Appointments by the University ................................................................................................................................................... 61 Dismissal for Adequate Cause .............................................................................................................................................................................. 61 Termination Because of Physical or Mental Disability ......................................................................................................................................... 64 Termination Because of Financial Exigency ......................................................................................................................................................... 65
Leave Policies .............................................................................................................................................................. 68 Leaves of Absence ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 68 9-Month Faculty Family and Medical Leave Policy ............................................................................................................................................. 69 12-month Professional School Faculty Leave Policy ............................................................................................................................................ 70 Sabbatical Leave ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 72
CHAPTER 5: FACULTY EVALUATION SYSTEM ............................................................................................. 75 The Philosophy of Evaluation at the University of the Incarnate Word ................................................................................................................ 75 Reward and Pay Policy Statement ......................................................................................................................................................................... 75 The Faculty Evaluation System (FES) .................................................................................................................................................................. 76 General Standards for Faculty Performance .......................................................................................................................................................... 76 Teaching ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 77 Annual Evaluation of Teaching Effectiveness: Examples ..................................................................................................................................... 82 Scholarship ........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 82 Guidelines and Principles for Determining Minimal Scholarship Expectations For Promotion and Tenure ......................................................... 82 SCHOLARSHIP: Annual Evaluation ................................................................................................................................................................... 86 University and Community Service ...................................................................................................................................................................... 87 Professional Activities .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 87
Faculty Evaluation Procedures .................................................................................................................................. 88 Dean Evaluation of First-Year Faculty.................................................................................................................................................................. 88 Dean Annual Evaluation of Faculty ...................................................................................................................................................................... 88 Third-Year Review of Tenure-Track Faculty ........................................................................................................................................................ 89 Promotion and Tenure Evaluation for Tenure-Track Faculty ................................................................................................................................ 89 Promotion Evaluation for Instructors to Senior Instructors ................................................................................................................................... 90
Evaluation Materials and Processes .......................................................................................................................... 90 The Schedule of Dean and Peer Evaluations of Teaching ..................................................................................................................................... 90 Criteria for Dean or Peer Review of Teaching Form (supplied by the Dean) ........................................................................................................ 91 Dean Observing a Class Option ............................................................................................................................................................................ 93 Criteria for Peer Review of Teaching Materials Form (supplied by the Dean) ..................................................................................................... 94 Student Evaluation of Teaching Form ................................................................................................................................................................... 95 Peer Evaluation of University Committee Service Form ...................................................................................................................................... 96 Faculty Self-Evaluation: The Faculty Self Inventory (FSI) .................................................................................................................................. 97 Unsatisfactory Performance .................................................................................................................................................................................. 97 Procedures for Resolving Disputes Concerning the FSI ........................................................................................................................................ 98
CHAPTER 6: POLICIES/PROCEDURES RELATED TO INSTRUCTION ...................................................... 99 Course Syllabi/Outlines ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 99 Blended and On-line Courses................................................................................................................................................................................ 99 Attendance Policy and Other Regulations ........................................................................................................................................................... 101 Reporting Student Absences ............................................................................................................................................................................... 102 Faculty Concerns about Students ........................................................................................................................................................................ 102 Faculty Absence .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 102 Faculty Office Hours .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 102 Student Attendance, Progress, and Grade Processes ........................................................................................................................................... 102
4
Classroom Scheduling ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 103 System of Grading and Honor Points .................................................................................................................................................................. 103 Privacy Act ......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 103 Duplication Guidelines ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 103 Outside Speakers ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 103 Cancellation of Course Offerings ........................................................................................................................................................................ 103 Policy on Academic Integrity.............................................................................................................................................................................. 103 Student Complaints Related to Faculty Decisions about Student Course Work .................................................................................................. 103 Classroom Recording Policy ............................................................................................................................................................................... 103
CHAPTER 7: CURRICULUM DEVELOPMENT AND REVISION ................................................................. 104 Categories of Curriculum Change (see procedures sections for detailed differentiation of categories) ............................................................... 104 Procedures: Category “A” Change ...................................................................................................................................................................... 104 Procedures: Category “B” Change ...................................................................................................................................................................... 105 Procedure: Category “C” Change ....................................................................................................................................................................... 105 College/School Curriculum Committee Guidelines ............................................................................................................................................ 107 Definition of a Credit Hour ................................................................................................................................................................................. 108 Flow Diagram for Curriculum Proposals to Undergraduate and Graduate Councils ........................................................................................... 112
CHAPTER 8: PART-TIME FACULTY—RIGHTS AND RESPONSIBILITIES ............................................. 113 Types of Part-Time Faculty ................................................................................................................................................................................ 113 Employment Offer .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 114 Issues During Employment ................................................................................................................................................................................. 114 Reappointment .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 114 Dismissal Before End of Term ............................................................................................................................................................................ 114 Part-Time Faculty Workload Policy.................................................................................................................................................................... 114
APPENDIX 1: ORGANIZATIONAL CHARTS ................................................................................................... 118 President—Executive Administration ................................................................................................................................................................. 118 Provost—Academic Administration ................................................................................................................................................................... 119
APPENDIX 2: UIW EXCEPTIONS TO THE TERMINAL DEGREE .............................................................. 120
APPENDIX 3: FACULTY DEVELOPMENT FUND REVIEW GUIDELINES ............................................... 121 FDF Application Process .......................................................................................................................................... 123
APPENDIX 4: FACULTY AWARD REPORTING FORM ................................................................................ 126
APPENDIX 5: FACULTY AWARDS SUMMARY .............................................................................................. 127
APPENDIX 6: OPTIONAL FACULTY RETIREMENT INCENTIVE PROGRAM ....................................... 129
APPENDIX 7: POLICY CONCERNING SALARIES FUNDED BY GRANTS ................................................ 132
APPENDIX 8: POLICY STATEMENT RELATING TO MISCONDUCT IN SCIENCE ............................... 133
APPENDIX 9: RESEARCH ACTIVITIES PERFORMED BY OUTSIDE ORGANIZATIONS ...................... 135
APPENDIX 10: PROFESSIONAL ETHICS COMPLAINT PROCEDURES ................................................... 136
APPENDIX 11: PUBLIC WRITING/SPEAKING POLICIES ............................................................................ 138
APPENDIX 12: COPYRIGHT POLICY AND GUIDELINES ............................................................................ 140
APPENDIX 13: ACADEMIC SERVICES ............................................................................................................. 148 J.E. and L.E. Mabee Library Services for Faculty ................................................................................................ 148 Other UIW Libraries ................................................................................................................................................ 151
George W. Brackenridge Library at the Feik School of Pharmacy ..................................................................................................................... 151 Geneva R. Johnson School of Physical Therapy Library .................................................................................................................................... 151 UIW School of Osteopathic Medicine Library .................................................................................................................................................... 151 George W. Brackenridge Library at the Rosenberg School of Optometry .......................................................................................................... 151
APPENDIX 14: FACULTY SEARCH PROCEDURE GUIDELINES ............................................................... 155
APPENDIX 15: DEAN SEARCH PROCEDURE GUIDELINES ....................................................................... 166
APPENDIX 16: AWARDING OF HONORARY DEGREES .............................................................................. 171
APPENDIX 17: AWARDING OF POSTHUMOUS DEGREES .......................................................................... 172
5
APPENDIX 18: POLICY ON ACADEMIC INTEGRITY ................................................................................... 173
APPENDIX 19: STUDENT COMPLAINTS.......................................................................................................... 176 Student Complaint Policy ........................................................................................................................................ 176
Student Complaints Related To Faculty Decisions About Student Course Work Procedure Guidelines ............................................................. 178 Appeal Form For Student Complaints About Faculty Decisions ......................................................................................................................... 181 Student Receipt of Complaint Procedure Guidelines and Forms ......................................................................................................................... 183
APPENDIX 20: GRADUATE FACULTY APPOINTMENT PROCEDURE .................................................... 184
APPENDIX 21: CLASSROOM RECORDING POLICY .................................................................................... 186
APPENDIX 22: BLENDED-ONLINE COURSE POLICY .................................................................................. 190
APPENDIX 23: FACULTY CREDENTIALS FOR TEACHING ....................................................................... 193
APPENDIX 24: MULTI-YEAR, RENEWABLE TERM FACULTY APPOINTMENTS ................................ 195
REVISIONS SINCE OCTOBER 2012—SUMMARY ........................................................................................... 196
6
All faculty at the University of the Incarnate Word (UIW) are bound and protected by this Faculty
Handbook. Supplements for schools may include policies and procedures unique to their circumstances as
long as those additional policies and procedures do not deny rights articulated in this UIW Faculty
Handbook and assure due process.
All changes to the Faculty Handbook must be forwarded to the provost for approval. The provost is
responsible for posting the official edition on the provost website. These editions with any revisions are
posted twice a year, in May and December. The provost oversees a comprehensive review of the Faculty
Handbook every five years (2017, 2022, 2027, 2032, etc.).
The Employee Handbook at the Human Resources website includes the following for faculty information:
Chapter 5—Benefits
7—Rules and Conduct
8—Life Threatening Illness Policy 9—Harassment-Free Work and Learning Environment Policy
13—Computer Policy
14—Intellectual Property
7
Letter from the President
The very heart of the mission of the University of the Incarnate Word is embodied in the interaction between
faculty and students, faculty and administration, and faculty with each other. The policies and procedures in
the Faculty Handbook may at times seem far from the daily life of the University of the Incarnate Word. In
reality, the Faculty Handbook is a living document that has been developing for over fifty years and comes
out of the lived experiences of UIW faculty. It supports both the work and shared governance of the faculty
and faculty interaction with other groups within the University.
When these policies and procedures are known and observed by individual faculty, deans and other
administrators, they contribute to harmonious and orderly relationships and the resolution of problems and
questions that are bound to arise. This will contribute to an “atmosphere which will promote individual
self-realization” as we work together to serve our students.
I am grateful to the Faculty Senate and all who work so patiently at keeping the Faculty Handbook current
and accurate. You will find the most definitive edition of the Handbook on the Provost’s website.
Dr. Thomas M. Evans
8
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION
Mission Statement
(Endorsed by the Board, 12/5/14; approved by the Congregation, 2/5/15)
The first Sisters of Charity of the Incarnate Word, three young French women motivated by the love of God
and their recognition of God's presence in each person, came to San Antonio in 1869 to minister to the sick
and the poor. Their spirit of Christian service is perpetuated in the University of the Incarnate Word
primarily through teaching and scholarship, encompassing research and artistic expression. Inspired by
Judeo-Christian values, the Catholic intellectual tradition, and Catholic Social Teaching, the University of
the Incarnate Word aims to educate men and women who will become concerned and enlightened citizens
within the global community.
The university is committed to educational excellence in a context of faith in Jesus Christ, the Incarnate
Word of God. Thus, through a liberal education the university cultivates the development of the whole
person and values of life-long learning. To that end, faculty and students support each other in the search
for and communication of truth, thoughtful innovation, care of the environment, community service, and
social justice.
The University of the Incarnate Word is a Catholic institution that welcomes to its community persons of
diverse backgrounds, in the belief that their respectful interaction advances the discovery of truth, mutual
understanding, self-realization, and the common good.
Faculty and Shared Governance at UIW
History
A plan for faculty participation in the governance of Incarnate Word was first introduced by Sr. Margaret
Patrice Slattery in 1969. She was appointed academic dean in that year and based her plan on the document
published in 1962 by the American Association of University Professors. The plan included creation of the
Faculty Association and standing committees in curriculum, library, admissions and financial aid, student
life, faculty affairs, budget and physical plant, and public relations. With this structure in place, “The faculty
became responsible for making changes in the academic program, for formulating policies on admissions,
for recommending promotions and tenure, for awarding scholarships to students, and for recommending
changes in student life related to the educational process.” (Promises to Keep, V. 2, pp. 353-4) Details with
processes were outlined in the first Faculty Handbook.
In 1975, the Board of Trustees approved the document, “Board of Trustees on Campus Governance.” This
clarifies the basic philosophy of shared governance and also summarizes the primary responsibilities and
authority of the Board, the president, and the faculty. The first section is titled “Areas of Shared
Responsibility” and has been included in the Faculty Handbook since then under the section called the
Board Policy on Campus Governance (from the Board of Trustees Handbook, section 5--‘UIW’ has been
substituted in the document for ‘IWC’):
The University of the Incarnate Word supports the principle of interdependence among the Board of
Trustees, administration, faculty, and students for effective operation of the total educational program.
Adequate communication and full opportunity for joint planning and effort are the means of effecting
this interdependence. Recommendations for change in the educational program may be initiated by the
Board, the administration, the faculty, or the students. Differences in the weight of each voice from one
point to the next are determined by reference to the responsibility of each component for the particular
matter at hand.
9
The areas of shared responsibility include:
1. The establishment of the philosophy and the general educational policies of the university,
although the final responsibility for these matters rests in the Board of Trustees.
2. Major changes in the academic program and the relative emphasis to be given to the various
elements of the program.
3. Major changes in the size or composition of the student body.
4. Long-range planning. 5. Major decisions on use of physical resources and the construction of new resources to be used in
the educational work of the university.
6. Major allocation of financial resources.
7. Selection of the president, provost.
8. Determination of faculty status, including appointments, re-appointments, decisions not to
reappoint, dismissals, promotions, and tenure.
9. Obtaining and maintaining all accreditation.
The last section of the 1975 Board of Trustees document outlines the scope of faculty authority and
responsibilities and serves as a useful introduction to the current edition of the Faculty Handbook.
The University of the Incarnate Word [UIW] is dedicated to the free pursuit of truth and the
responsible dissemination of knowledge. Involved in the achievement of these goals is a community of
scholars made up of students, faculty and administration. As members of this community, faculty
have the freedom and the responsibility to pursue the truth and to present it effectively. They are
expected to continually improve their scholarly competence and to demonstrate such improvement by
excellence in teaching, as well as published research, artistic production, or distinguished performance.
The faculty of UIW consists of the president and those members of the instructional and
administrative staff accorded faculty status.
The faculty has primary responsibility for the curriculum, subject matter and methods of
instruction, research, faculty status, and those aspects of student life which relate to the educational
process. On these matters the power of review or final decision is lodged in the Board of Trustees or
delegated by it to the president. If a recommendation of the faculty is not approved, the reasons will be
communicated to the faculty. Following such communication, the faculty has the right of further
consideration and transmittal of its views to the president and through the president to the Board of
Trustees.
The faculty is responsible for establishing requirements for academic degrees; for determining
when the requirements have been met; and for authorizing the president and the Board to grant the
degrees.
The university recognizes that scholars in a particular field have the chief competence for judging
the work of their colleagues. Thus, faculty members are primarily responsible for faculty appointments,
re-appointments, decisions not to reappoint, promotions, tenure, and dismissal. Determinations on these
matters should be by faculty action exercised through established procedures and reviewed by the chief
academic officer and approved by the president.
The faculty actively participates in policies and procedures governing salary increases.
Currently
Besides membership on the Faculty Senate, “the representative body through which the faculty may
effectively exercise its authority and the responsibility it shares with administration for carrying out the
educational functions of UIW” (Preamble to the “Faculty Senate Constitution and Bylaws”—see Chapter
3), faculty share in governance by also sitting on the Board of Trustees, the president’s Executive Council,
the Institutional Effectiveness Council, and the Academic Deans Council.
10
CHAPTER 2: THE STRUCTURE OF ACADEMIC ORGANIZATION
General Administration
(See chart A. President—Executive Administration)
Principles Governing Policies
1. The basic policies are established by the Board of Trustees to be implemented by the president,
who delegates authority as required to the provost, vice presidents and deans for translating policies
into standard operating procedures, regulatory enforcement, and other administrative details as
required.
2. The academic program is the reason for the existence of the University of the Incarnate Word. Its
integrity must guide all decision making.
3. All issues relating to personnel must be handled with respect, tact, and the proper written
documentation.
4. All programs and services must be congruent with the spirit embodied in the Mission of the
university, reflecting the Catholic nature of the institution.
5. All programs, facilities and services must be operated within the confines of the university budget.
6. The students, their needs and their development as persons and as professionals are primary. They
are to be treated with the utmost respect and consideration.
7. All policies of the university contained in the university bulletins, student, faculty and
administrative/staff handbooks, along with those operational procedures outlined by the offices of
Human Resources, Business and Finance, Public Relations, etc. are strictly adhered to and, as
effectively as possible, promulgated throughout the university community in which we serve.
8. The president is the chief institutional spokesperson for the university and its high schools.
9. The university and its high schools are directed by policies and procedures mandated by the Board
of Trustees and by all external accrediting and regulating agencies; these policies and procedures
are adhered to.
10. Providing professional services requires appropriate documentation and the confidential
maintenance of records.
11. The professional development of the staff, their services and programs requires ongoing support
and evaluation.
12. The business and personnel functions of the university and its high schools adhere to federal, state
and local laws regarding affirmative action employment, personnel, and payroll policies, and
adhere to generally accepted accounting principles.
14
Major Administrative Committees
Executive Council
The primary advisory council to the president. The Executive Council is made up of the president, provost,
vice-presidents, president of the Faculty Senate, and the chief of staff to the president.
Institutional Effectiveness Council
(Revised by Provost, 8/6/13)
The Institutional Effectiveness Council (IEC) is responsible for overseeing the process of measuring
institutional performance against the UIW mission. Continuous improvement processes serve as a
framework to link mission to planning in the specific areas of: educational programs, to include student
learning outcomes; administrative support services; academic and student support services; research; and
community/public service. The council is chaired by the associate provost for institutional effectiveness
and makes recommendations to the Executive Council through the provost.
The functions of the IEC are to:
1. Solicit periodic assessment updates from the university Strategic Goal Chairs, to report to the
Executive Council.
2. Coordinate, and consult as needed, the annual and five-year Program Review processes for all
major educational programs, including the Core Curriculum, and all administrative and academic
offices and services.
3. Facilitate dialog and projects that encourage collaborative and integrative assessment.
4. Coordinate analysis of all major institutional surveys and report results to the Executive Council
which will identify actions to improve UIW effectiveness.
5. Communicate assessment activities and results to the broader UIW community and maintain an
Institutional Effectiveness website.
6. Approve the scheduling and target audiences for university-wide assessment instruments used
with students, faculty, administrators, staff, or alumnae. This role is subsequent to any IRB
reviews that might be needed.
7. Monitor compliance with SACS accreditation requirements related to assessment.
Minimum Membership of IEC:
Associate Provost for Institutional Effectiveness
(chair) VP for Mission and Ministry
Dean, Graduate Studies and Research
1 additional academic dean -- (appointed by the provost for a 1-year term)* 3 faculty with assessment experience – (appointed by the provost for 2-year
terms)* Director of Athletics
Director of the Center for Teaching and Learning
Director of Assessment, Extended Academic
Programs Director of Institutional Research
Director of the Center for Civic
Leadership Dean of Student Success
Director of Campus Engagement
(Ex Officio, receiving
minutes) Provost
VP for Student Services and Enrollment Management
15
VP for Information Services
* Selected to assure representation from Main Campus, Extended Studies, and Professional Schools
Core Advisory Council (Revised by Provost, 11/20/13)
The Core Advisory Council (CAC) is an administrative committee that advises and reports to the
provost on issues related to undergraduate Core Learning Outcomes. Members serve by appointment
of the provost, based on their university responsibilities and their qualifications related to the broad
areas of UIW’s Core Learning Outcomes. Faculty appointments in the respective disciplines are for
three years, and may be renewed, with the concurrence of their dean.
The main responsibilities of CAC are to:
1. Recommend approval/disapproval of curricular proposals to the Undergraduate Council
(UC);
2. Coordinate the assessment of Core Learning Outcomes;
3. Share the results of surveys and assessments with all college/schools;
4. Review updates to the “Advisor’s Guide to the Core Curriculum”;
5. Inform UC about CAC activities via distribution of CAC meeting minutes.
CAC minimum membership includes:
Associate provost for Institutional Effectiveness (Chair)
A Faculty Co-Chair
University Registrar
Dean or Associate Dean, College of Humanities, Arts, and Social Sciences
Director of Assessment for Extended Academic Programs
Director, University Advising Center
Director, Writing and Learning Center
Faculty representatives (at least 5), from Main Campus and Extended Academic Programs, in disciplines
that address the undergraduate Core Learning Outcomes
Academic Deans Councils
The Deans Councils serve as the primary advisory bodies to the provost. The functions of the Deans
Councils are to:
1. Advise the provost.
2. Facilitate effective communications within the university community.
3. Channel appropriate information and issues to existing committees as required to accomplish
goals.
Membership of the Deans Councils include all academic deans and other members as determined by the
provost.
16
Academic Administration
Provost
Reporting directly to the president, the provost is the chief academic officer of the university. The provost
oversees the integrity of all academic programs of the university, representing the academic endeavors of the
university to external accrediting agencies and constituencies. The provost is responsible for academic
strategic planning, evaluating academic deans, the overall quality of the curriculum and instruction, faculty
recruitment, development activities, and promotion and tenure. The provost fosters a spirit of collaboration
among all departments in order to better achieve the Mission of the university and create an environment
committed to student success.
Associate Provost for Institutional Effectiveness
The associate provost for IE is responsible overall for planning, budgeting, organizing, and coordinating
activities required for institution-wide assessment and is normally the UIW liaison with SACSCOC.
Assistant/Associate Provost
Reporting directly to the provost, the assistants or associates provide support on various academic projects
for the provost and perform duties as assigned.
Vice President for Extended Academic Programs
The vice president for extended academic programs reports directly to the president in matters of strategic
planning, business operations, and annual goals, and to the provost in matters relevant to academic
programs, faculty, curriculum development, assessment, and accreditation. The vice president is responsible
for the School of Professional Studies and the School of Applied Science.
Vice President for International Affairs
Reporting directly to the president, the vice president for international affairs oversees academic programs
on campuses in Mexico, and Germany, as well as Study Abroad, Work Abroad, and special projects with
Sister School partners, and the English as a Second Language Program.
Academic Deans
The deans, including those reporting to the provost as well as the vice president for extended academic
programs, implement the priorities of the university as set by the president and provost. The deans are
responsible for: recruiting, developing, and evaluating personnel; preparing budgets and allocating
resources; identifying needs and developing new programs/services as appropriate; and ensuring the
integrity and excellence of all programs/services in support of student success. The deans exercise
leadership within the divisional unit, within the university, and in the external community.
17
Dean of the Office of Research and Graduate Studies
Duties and Responsibilities
The College/Schools
1. Works with Graduate Council in the articulation of graduate academic policy and its
implementation.
2. Works with Graduate Council and program coordinators to ensure that programs meet the
SACSCOC standards in the syllabi, maintaining the appropriate records, and revising the
Graduate Bulletin.
3. Works with the admission office and program coordinators in processing applications to graduate
school.
The University
1. Works with other deans and program coordinators in the recruitment of students, and in the
organization of education projects related to cohorts.
2. Manages the disbursement of certain research grant funds.
3. Participates in long-range planning to meet current university objectives and develops strategies
for future directions related to post-graduate education.
The External Community 4. Establishes and maintains relationships with institutions, agencies and businesses to determine
how the university can provide them with educational services.
All Academic Deans
Duties and Responsibilities
Role of the Dean
1. Provide leadership to faculty and staff for implementing the university mission in the academic
programs of the college/school.
2. Communicate frequently and effectively with the college/school’s faculty and staff.
3. Promote excellence in faculty teaching, scholarship, service, and professional activities.
4. Oversee the process of hiring, evaluating, and mentoring full- and part-time faculty and staff.
5. Determine workload assignments for program coordinators, directors, faculty, and staff.
6. Keep department chairs informed by responding to issues related to their programs and faculty.
7. Develop and manage the budget, technical support, and other college/school services.
8. Work with other deans to advance and provide leadership for the university.
18
9. Participate in long-range planning to meet current university objectives and develop strategies for
future directions.
10. Ensure compliance with safety standards, human resource policies, and other legal liability
concerns.
Specific Responsibilities
11. Lead faculty in the planning, assessment, and accreditation process for the college/school’s
programs.
12. Participate in securing resources for the college/school both internally and externally.
13. Provide leadership for managing enrollment of the college/school and working with the
Admissions Office.
14. Represent the school to professional associations, regulatory and accrediting agencies and the
community at large.
15. Build and maintain relationships, connections, and associations in the external community.
16. Participate in personal professional development and scholarship.
17. Promote the visibility of the college/school via a range of public relations, events, face-to-face
and electronic communications processes.
18. Respond to student appeals and complaints.
19. Respond promptly to faculty, staff, and student needs.
20. Ensure the coordination and articulation of college/school programs with other academic
programs and institutional support programs.
Supplementary Duties May Include
21. Supervise formation of class schedules and maximize use of physical space.
22. Gather data and prepare documents and reports.
23. Assure effective advising of students.
24. Engage students by teaching a semester-long course.
25. Oversee hiring and evaluation of student assistants, graduate assistants, and other temporary
workers.
Desirable Knowledge, Abilities, and Skills
1. Understanding of budget, planning, and personnel processes.
2. Aptitude for soliciting external funding for the college/school.
19
3. Knowledge of assessment, accreditation, and data-based decision making processes.
4. Ability to build teams, lead, and motivate a diverse workforce.
5. Capability for developing faculty and staff skills, capabilities, and talents.
Desired Qualifications
1. Earned doctorate in an academic area tenurable with the college/school.
2. Administrative experience in a regionally accredited college or university.
3. Scholarly achievement and teaching effectiveness.
Dean of Library Services
Duties and Responsibilities
Within the Library
1. Promotes the educational and personal development goals of the community through provision of appropriate library resources, services, equipment, and facilities.
2. Provides quality services for the various university constituencies and off-campus programs.
3. Assesses user satisfaction and elicit suggestions for improvement.
The University
4. Cooperates with other deans, administrators and those served in planning for future development
of library services, resources, equipment, and facilities.
5. Communicates with patrons and administration to interpret the library program.
6. Prepares reports for accreditation, state agencies, and surveys as needed.
The External Community 7. Participates in local, statewide, and national library consortia to advance the Mabee Library
through beneficial partnerships.
8. Serves the broader community with on-site and interlibrary loan sharing of Mabee Library
resources.
9. Seeks and applies for outside funding to develop various opportunities, purposes and projects.
Chair/Coordinator/Director of Academic Programs
Description: Reporting to the dean, academic program leaders (APL) may carry one of several titles such
as program chair, program coordinator, or program director. Titles may vary according to the needs or
practices in a college/school or discipline. The APL is a faculty member and administrative leader of a
discipline or group of related disciplines. This individual may be responsible for undergraduate and
graduate level programs, or for programs at only one level. The primary role of the APL is to assist the dean
by coordinating the activities of a specific academic program. Appointment to the position of
chair/coordinator/director of academic programs is made by the dean, with approval of the provost. The
dean delegates authority and responsibility to the academic program leader for designated functions,
including but not limited to the following list of minimum duties and responsibilities.
Duties and Responsibilities:
The following duties and responsibilities are general and essential duties for all academic program
leaders. These duties may be described in further detail by specific program documents.
1. Articulates and implements university policy within assigned program(s), and ensures that
20
program policies and practices are consistent with those of the college/school and university. 2. Facilitates the 5-year program review by assessing and evaluating curriculum and resource needs
for assigned program(s). 3. Insures that curriculum changes are processed through appropriate channels according to
university policy and procedures.
4. Facilitates completion of the annual program assessment summary. 5. Assists with preparation of class schedules that efficiently uses faculty and classroom resources. 6. Assists with maintaining accuracy and relevancy of program materials including print and
website information. 7. Assists the dean in the preparation of reports for the university, accrediting and external funding
agencies. 8. Assists the dean in the recruitment, orientation, and formative evaluation of program faculty. 9. May assist with student recruitment, advising, monitoring student progress, coordinating summer
orientation and/or annual academic fairs. 10. May assist with student complaint procedures.
11. May assist the dean in budgeting and monitoring expenditures. 12. Serves as a liaison with relevant external constituencies. 13. Facilitates regular meetings of the program faculty. 14. Represents the program(s) in meetings with other academic program leaders, administrators, and
faculty.
15. Cooperates and consults with other academic program leaders regarding curriculum and program development.
16. Models the traditional faculty roles of teaching, scholarship, professional activities, and service to program faculty.
17. Assumes additional responsibilities as requested by the dean.
Compensation Academic program leaders are normally compensated through course release(s), stipends, or both. Course
releases will be determined by the dean in consultation with the provost and will take into consideration the
size of the program: numbers of students, numbers of full and part-time faculty, numbers of staff (student
employees, non-faculty staff) to be supervised, regulatory requirements, etc. APLs who agree to take on
summer responsibilities for recruiting and advising and summer orientations will be compensated with a
stipend added to their academic year contract. The stipend does not affect the base salary.
Evaluation
APLs will be evaluated annually according to the duties laid out in this document and any specific, and
agreed upon duties in a program specific job description. APLs should attach this document to the annual
Faculty Self-Inventory. Deans will consider the evaluation of administrative duties when making a
determination about annual merit increases.
Faculty Athletics Representative
The Faculty Athletic Representative (FAR) serves as the principal faculty spokesperson in conveying,
representing, and protecting the academic mission, values and goals of the University of the Incarnate
Word as reflected in intercollegiate athletics. The FAR is involved in the assurance of the academic
integrity of the athletics program, in the promotion of student athlete well-being, and in the support of
institutional control and rules compliance efforts regarding intercollegiate athletics.
The FAR shall be a full‐time member of the faculty (or an administrator holding faculty status) and shall
not hold an administrative or coaching position in Athletics.
21
The University President receives nominations from the Athletic Advisory Council and appoints the FAR
for a three-year term (the FAR may not serve more than two consecutive terms). The FAR reports to the
President, and represents the University of the Incarnate Word in its relationship with the Southland
conference and the NCAA.
The FAR shall sit as a non-voting member of the Faculty Senate and report on matters related to
intercollegiate athletics and student athlete well-being.
22
CHAPTER 3: FACULTY SENATE CONSTITUTION AND BYLAWS (Approved by Provost, 3/19/14)
Preamble
The Faculty Senate at UIW of the Incarnate Word (UIW) is the representative body through which the
faculty may effectively exercise its authority and the responsibility it shares with administration for carrying
out the educational functions of UIW. The Faculty Senate shall promote the growth and general welfare of
UIW by serving as the agent of the faculty in initiating and reviewing policies, making recommendations,
and communicating with UIW community.
Article I - Name
This organization shall be known as university of the Incarnate Word Faculty Senate.
Article II - Purposes / Responsibilities
A. The Faculty Senate shall be the governing body of the faculty as a whole. The voting membership
of the faculty as a whole consists of all full-time instructional and research faculty who teach at
least half-time. Faculty who hold a position in administration at the level of college/school dean or
higher are not eligible for membership on the Faculty Senate.
B. The Faculty Senate shall function as the agent of the faculty as a whole: To initiate and review policies relating to academic matters and to make recommendations to the
administration.
1. To initiate and review policies relating to the economic, cultural, and social welfare of the
faculty as a whole and as individuals and to make recommendations to the administration.
2. To promote and protect the rights of faculty in matters pertaining to academic freedom,
rank and tenure review, and the processing of grievances.
3. To initiate and review changes and additions to the Faculty Handbook.
4. To receive reports and recommendations from standing and ad hoc committees.
5. To serve as the official representatives of faculty. 6. To make the final faculty decision on all recommendations forwarded to the provost for
administrative action.
7. To promote participation in governance by the faculty as a whole by: a. Holding Faculty Forums of the faculty as a whole as needed for the purpose of sharing
information and/or gathering faculty viewpoints. (See Article VI.)
b. Taking other action as determined appropriate by the Faculty Senate, such as calling
special meetings of the faculty as a whole, conducting polls, drafting petitions, and
creating ad hoc committees and task forces.
c. Facilitating the election of officers, senators, and chairs and members of the Faculty
Senate standing committees.
d. Facilitating faculty votes for removal from office of those who fail to perform the
duties of elected positions.
e. Facilitating faculty review and amendment of the Constitution and Bylaws.
Article III - Membership
A. The voting members of Faculty Senate shall include four officers, four at-large senators, and two
senators from each college/school. The four at-large senators shall be elected by majority vote of
23
the faculty as a whole and vote in the interest of UIW. The college/school senators shall be
elected by the voting faculty in each college/school and vote in the interest of the college/school.
B. Voting members of the faculty as a whole who have been employed on a full-time basis for at least
one academic year are eligible to serve as members of standing committees.
C. Voting members of the faculty as a whole who have been employed for at least one academic year
and do not evaluate full-time faculty in a supervisory role are eligible to serve as officers and voting
members of the Faculty Senate.
D. The chairpersons of the Undergraduate Council, Faculty Affairs Committee, and Graduate Council
shall be voting members of the Faculty Senate.
E. The provost is a non-voting member on the Faculty Senate serving as a liaison with administration.
F. The faculty athletic representative is a non-voting member on the Faculty Senate serving as a liaison
with the athletic programs.
G. The Faculty Senate shall be responsible for resolving issues of membership eligibility.
Article IV - Officers and Standing Committees
A. The officers of the Faculty Senate shall be the president, vice president, secretary, and treasurer.
The president and vice president shall be faculty that have tenure or multi-year renewable-term
appointments. The duties and responsibilities of the officers are specified in Article VII.
B. The Senate Executive Committee (committee) shall consist of the officers; the chairs of the Faculty
Affairs Committee, the Undergraduate Council, and the Graduate Council; and one untenured
member of the Faculty Senate, selected by the Faculty Senate at the last meeting of each academic
year. The immediate past president shall serve as a consultant to committee for one year. The duties
and responsibilities of the committee are specified in Article VIII.
C. Standing committees of the Faculty Senate are the Undergraduate Council, Graduate Council, the
Faculty Affairs Committee, the Rank and Tenure Committee, the Faculty Development Fund
Review Committee, the Grievance Committee, and the Nominations and Elections Committee. All
standing committees shall submit reports of progress and goals to the Faculty Senate at the end of
each semester. Specific procedures and duties of the standing committees are detailed in Articles
IX-XV.
D. Every college/school has a right to representation as described above. They may, if preferred,
choose to combine their representation with another college/school. Each committee member has
a single vote.
Article V - Elections and Terms of Office
A. The regular election of officers (president, vice president, treasurer, and secretary), senators elected
at-large, and the chairs of standing committees shall be held within three weeks of the opening of
the spring semester. All officers, senators, chairs and members of standing committees are
restricted to holding no more than one of these positions at a time.
B. Each officer shall be elected for a two-year term with the president and treasurer being elected in
the spring of odd-numbered years and the vice president and secretary being elected in the spring
of even-numbered years. The president shall be limited to two consecutive terms.
C. Two at-large senators shall be elected in odd-numbered years and two at-large senators shall be
elected in even-numbered years.
D. Chairs of standing committees shall serve two-year terms. The chairs of the Nominations and
Elections Committee, the Undergraduate Council, and the Graduate Council shall be elected in
even numbered years. The chairs of the Faculty Affairs Committee, the Rank and Tenure
24
Committee, and the Faculty Development Funds Review Committee shall be elected in odd
numbered years.
E. A majority of votes cast by the voting faculty as a whole is required for election to office. To break
a tie vote:
1. Each candidate is contacted to ascertain interest in continuing the process. If one concedes,
the other takes the position.
2. If both candidates are still interested in the position, a second election shall be scheduled
as soon as possible. The person with the majority of votes takes the position.
3. If there is still a tie, the Nomination and Election Committee elects the winner.
F. Incumbents shall hold their positions until their successors take office. In the event of a vacancy
prior to the expiration of the term of an at-large position other than president, the Faculty Senate
shall appoint the person who obtained the next highest number of votes for the position in the last
election or, if none is available, the Faculty Senate shall call for a special election.
G. Nominations for the college/school senate and committee member positions will be reported to the
Nominations and Elections Committee by the college/school committee member for preparation of
the ballot within three weeks of the announcement of at-large election results. The committee will
distribute ballots and report election results within six weeks of the announcement of at-large
election results.
H. Members of the Faculty Senate shall be elected for two-year terms; one senator from each
college/school shall be elected each year by the respective college/school.
I. If a senator or committee member elected by a college/school must relinquish the position, the
college/school will elect a replacement.
J. Attendance at Faculty Senate is required. Senators should designate a substitute to attend on any
occasion when they cannot fulfill this obligation. If a senator demonstrates continued absence from
meetings, the senator may be dismissed.
K. A duly elected officer, senator, committee member, or chair of a standing committee may not be
removed from office except for failure to perform the duties of the position.
a. A recall of a person serving in an at-large position may be initiated by a majority of the
Faculty Senate or by a petition signed by twenty-five percent of the voting membership of
the faculty. A two-thirds vote by the voting membership of the Faculty Senate is required
for removal of duly elected persons.
b. A recall of a senator or committee member selected by the college/school may be initiated
by the college/school. A recall may be decided by a two-thirds majority of the voting
faculty of the college/school.
Article VI - Meetings
Faculty Senate Meetings
A. At the beginning of each semester, the Faculty Senate shall determine the frequency with which it
shall meet in regular session during that semester, but at least once every full month in the fall and
spring semesters.
B. Special meetings of the Faculty Senate may be called during June and July. C. At least one week prior to each regular meeting, the secretary shall send to each member of the
Faculty Senate an agenda for the meeting and the unapproved minutes of the last meeting.
D. Dates of regular meetings and agendas shall be posted for all faculty. All meetings shall be open to
voting members of the faculty as a whole who do not evaluate faculty. Individuals or groups
wishing to speak at a Faculty Senate meeting must make prior arrangements with the president.
E. Voting shall be by voice or a show of hands; no voting shall be held by secret ballot or by digital
means unless approved by a show of hands.
F. A quorum shall consist of a majority of the Faculty Senate.
25
G. Unless otherwise stated, decisions of the Faculty Senate shall be determined by a majority of those
members who are present and voting, provided a quorum is present.
H. The most recent edition of Robert’s Rules of Order shall govern the conduct of all business unless
other rules are adopted by the Faculty Senate.
I. The Faculty Senate shall be the final authority on any question of interpretation of this Constitution
and Bylaws.
Forums of the Faculty as a Whole
A. Faculty Forums shall be held as needed for the purpose of sharing information and/or gathering
faculty viewpoints.
B. Forums of the faculty as a whole may be called by the president of the Faculty Senate, by a majority
of the Faculty Senate, or by a petition signed by twenty-five percent of the voting membership of
the faculty.
C. Forum shall be called upon written notice setting forth the purpose of the forum at least seven days
in advance of the meeting.
Article VII - Officers’ and Senators’ Duties and Responsibilities
A. The president shall be the chief executive officer representing the Faculty Senate. The president
or designee shall preside at all meetings of the Faculty Senate, at all meetings of the Senate
Executive Committee, and at Faculty Forums. The president shall serve as an ex-officio member
of all standing and ad hoc committees. The president also serves as a voting member on the UIW
president’s Executive Council, the Board of Trustees, and the Academic Dean’s Council. The
president facilitates communication and transparency of processes among the Faculty Senate and
the UIW faculty as whole, shared governance committees, academic deans, and the UIW
president’s Executive Council. The president shall vote in the interest of UIW. The president
receives 25% release time for service to the Faculty Senate and university.
B. The vice president shall act for the president in the event of the inability of the latter to perform the
duties of the office; present to the Faculty Senate the motions, reports, and recommendations of the
Senate Executive Committee; serve as Faculty Senate parliamentarian, facilitate the faculty
recognition process including the annual awards. The vice president shall organize the Faculty
Forums. The vice president shall vote in the interest of UIW.
C. The secretary is charged with recording the minutes of all regular and special meetings of the
Faculty Senate, all regular and special meetings of the faculty as a whole, and the meetings of the
Senate Executive Committee; maintaining such records as are necessary to the conduct of Faculty
Senate business; and preparing and processing such correspondence as Faculty Senate business
requires. The secretary shall vote in the interest of UIW.
D. The treasurer is responsible for receiving and accounting for all monies and properties of the
Faculty Senate and maintaining the financial records in the manner required by Generally Accepted
Accounting Principles (GAAP); facilitating expenditures of the Faculty Senate as directed by the
Senate Executive Committee; preparing and presenting monthly reports to the Faculty Senate. The
treasurer shall vote in the interest of UIW.
E. Duties of College/School Senators
1. Attend all Senate meetings or supply a substitute when that is not possible. Maintain an
active role in the Senate meetings and ad hoc committees.
2. Report Senate happenings to the College/School. Obtain feedback from the College/School
on matters under consideration in Senate.
26
3. Represent the College/School interest in Senate meetings.
F. Duties of Senators-at-Large 1. Attend all Senate meetings or supply a substitute when that is not possible. Maintain an
active role in the Senate meetings and ad hoc committees.
2. Maintain communication between College/Schools.
3. Support Faculty Forum activities as needed.
4. Represent the interests of the university in Senate meetings.
Article VIII - Senate Executive Committee
A. The Senate Executive Committee shall meet as necessary for the purpose of preparing agenda and
relevant information for regular and special meetings of the Faculty Senate and the faculty.
B. The committee shall receive written reports from the Rank and Tenure Committee and the
Grievance Committee and forward their recommendations to the provost.
C. The committee shall receive written reports from the chairpersons of other standing committees
and ad hoc committees.
D. The committee shall report on Faculty Senate business at Faculty Forums as needed.
E. When a concern is raised by the Nominations and Elections Committee about an election, the committee shall review and resolve the matter. The committee’s decision shall be final and shall
be reported to the Faculty Senate. F. The committee shall conduct other business as needed for the effective functioning of the academic
community.
Article IX - Nominations and Elections Committee
A. The Nominations and Elections Committee shall facilitate the elections process for the Faculty
Senate.
At-large Elections B. The committee shall elicit nominees from the college/schools for upcoming vacancies in positions
for officers, chairs of standing committees, and senators elected at-large.
C. The committee shall prepare a ballot for the election of all at-large positions and submit it to Faculty
Senate for approval no later than the last Faculty Senate meeting of the fall semester. The ballot
shall include the following information:
1. Name, college/school and department/position,
2. Academic rank, tenure status, and number of years at UIW,
3. Brief biographical statement (less than 100 words) and
4. UIW faculty photo.
D. Upon approval of the Faculty Senate, the chair of the committee uploads the approved ballot into
the balloting system. The chair or faculty senate president shall distribute the ballot to eligible
voting members of the faculty, with controls to ensure one vote per eligible
member. SurveyMonkey® or similar platform with the ballots tied to the eligible voting member’s
UIW email address currently meets the requirements of the online balloting system with voting
controls.
E. If there is a concern raised by the committee within seven days after the election results have been
disseminated, the committee shall request a review by the Senate Executive Committee. The
decision of the Senate Executive Committee shall be final and shall be reported to the Faculty
Senate.
College/School Elections F. Each member of the committee shall elicit nominations from the college/school for senate,
committee member positions, IRB member, and Awards Committee member. Nominations will be
27
submitted to the Nominations and Elections Committee for preparation of the ballot within three
weeks of the announcement of at-large election results.
G. The committee will distribute ballots and report election results to Senate Executive Committee
within six weeks of the announcement of the at-large election results.
H. The chair of the committee shall be elected by the faculty as a whole in even-numbered years. The
chair serves in the interest of UIW and does not represent a college/school. The chair does not vote
except to break a tie.
I. The voting membership of the committee shall be composed of one member elected by the voting
faculty of each college/school and shall vote in the interest of UIW. Half of the members shall be
elected for two-year terms in even-numbered years and half of the members shall be elected for
two-year terms in odd-numbered years. When there are an odd number of colleges/schools, the
extra member shall be elected in odd-numbered years.
J. A simple majority of voting members must be present at each meeting to achieve a quorum.
Article X - Grievance Committee
A. The Grievance Committee provides a venue for the right to a legitimate appeal. The committee
considers faculty allegations of misconduct by providing a hearing to seek redress and the
correction of abuse or injustice. The committee has jurisdiction over matters of professional
ethics, academic freedom, conditions of employment, and the wellbeing of the faculty. The role
of the committee is to hear the grievance, create written findings of fact, determine the merits of
the allegations, and recommend sanctions, if any.
The role of the committee specifically related to appeal procedures in matters of promotion and
tenure denial, non-reappointment of probationary faculty, termination for adequate cause, or
financial exigency or program discontinuance or reduction is detailed in Chapter 4; the
professional ethics complaint procedures are in Appendix 11.
B. The committee shall be composed of one member elected by the voting faculty of each
college/school from a list of all full-time faculty with tenure or multi-year renewable-term
appointments and vote in the interest of UIW. Half of the members shall be elected for two-year
terms in even-numbered years and half of the members shall be elected for two-year terms in odd-
numbered years. When there are an odd number of colleges/schools, the extra member shall be
elected in odd-numbered years.
C. The committee is chaired by the president or a member elected by the committee. (See Section
E.1 below.)
Initiation of a Grievance
D. Prior to a case coming to the Grievance Committee, other avenues of redress should have been
exhausted through informal and formal proceedings and through consultation and negotiation
between the parties concerned. To initiate a grievance review, the complaining party, or grievant,
must file a written complaint with the president of the Faculty Senate, stating with particularity the
nature of the grievance, the identity of the alleged wrongdoer, the factual allegations, and the
redress sought.
1. The president shall, within three working days, inform in writing the accused party of the
grievance, disclosing the identity of the grievant and providing a full account of the charges
made.
2. The president of the Faculty Senate shall call the committee to service. 3. Each case shall be heard by not less than five members of the committee, including the
chairperson. Members who have a bias or interest in the case must recuse themselves from
hearing the case. In the event that a five-member panel cannot be maintained following
recusals, the committee chair shall request replacements from the college/schools without
representation.
28
Grievance Procedures
E. The committee shall observe the following procedures in conducting a grievance review:
1. The president of the Faculty Senate, in a non-voting capacity, shall chair the committee in cases
of termination for cause, financial exigency, or program discontinuance or reduction. In all
other cases, the committee shall select a chairperson, who also serves as a voting member.
2. The chairperson shall hold a meeting of the committee to discuss the standards and policies
against which the complaint is to be judged. The chairperson shall arrange that an adequate
record be kept regarding the hearing, its proceedings, findings, and recommendations. The
committee shall determine its jurisdiction over the case, as well as the procedural posture of
the case. The parties shall be promptly informed in writing if the committee determines that it
lacks jurisdiction over the matter. (See Article X.A.)
3. In cases in which the committee has jurisdiction, the committee chair shall call a pre-hearing
of the committee and parties to conduct a brief orientation to the hearing process and to clear
schedules for the proceedings. Each of the parties is allowed to bring to the grievance
proceedings one peer from within UIW to act as an observer but to take no active part in the
proceedings. The parties to the grievance shall be given the opportunity to make initial
statements regarding the allegations.
4. The chair shall advise those involved in the process that the hearing before the committee shall
be private and no public statements should be made about the case.
5. Under the direction of the chair, the committee shall conduct the grievance hearing, call
witnesses and question them as to the facts supporting each of the allegations.
6. The committee shall make explicit findings by clear and convincing evidence, give in writing
its reasoned opinion and recommendations to the parties involved, and inform the Senate
Executive Committee to the extent appropriate.
7. The Faculty Senate president shall send a written final report to the provost. The provost shall
review all recommendations and communicate a final decision to the parties.
8. No further appeal within UIW is available. F. If a dispute cannot be resolved by this grievance process, the parties may consult dispute resolution
documents on the Human Resources website, http://www.uiw.edu/hr/Policies.html, for other
alternatives.
Article XI - Undergraduate Council
A. The Undergraduate Council is responsible for the analysis and evaluation of existing undergraduate
curricula at UIW; the review of new course and degree offerings for relevancy and standards; the
study of national, regional and state trends in undergraduate education; the monitoring of policies
and standards for undergraduate admissions; the compliance with SACS criteria for implementation
of curricula; and the formulation and presentation to the Faculty Senate of such recommendations
affecting practice or policy as deemed necessary.
B. The committee is charged with maintaining communication with the undergraduate program
coordinators and the Graduate Council.
C. The voting membership shall be composed of one member elected by the voting faculty in each
college/school with an undergraduate program, voting in the interest of their college/school, and at
least one student selected by the Student Government Association. Half of the faculty members
shall be elected for two-year terms in even-numbered years and half of the faculty members shall
be elected for two-year terms in odd-numbered years. When there are an odd number of
colleges/schools, the extra member shall be elected in odd-numbered years.
D. The provost and the registrar shall be ex-officio non-voting members of the committee for purposes
of communication. Additional administrative members of the committee are non-voting and may
include the dean of library services and the dean of enrollment.
E. The chair of the committee shall be elected by the faculty as a whole in even-numbered years. The
chair serves in the interest of UIW and does not represent a college/school. The chair does not vote
except to break a tie.
F. The chair shall serve as a voting member of the Senate Executive Committee, Faculty Senate, and
the Academic Dean’s Council. The chair shall submit a monthly report of progress and goals to the
Faculty Senate and a full report at the end of each semester.
G. A simple majority of voting members must be present at each meeting to achieve a quorum.
Article XII - Graduate Council
A. The Graduate Council is responsible for the analysis and evaluation of existing graduate and
professional school curricula at UIW; the review of new course and degree offerings for relevancy
and standards; the study of national, regional, and state trends in graduate and professional school
education; the monitoring of policies and standards for admissions to graduate and professional
school programs; the compliance with SACS criteria for implementation of curricula; and the
formulation and presentation to the Faculty Senate of such recommendations affecting practice or
policy as deemed necessary.
B. The committee is charged with maintaining communication with the graduate and professional
school program coordinators and the Undergraduate Council.
C. The Graduate Council is charged with collaborating with the dean of graduate studies and research
on the formulation of annual goals; receiving a monthly update from the dean of graduate studies
and research on the current state of the Graduate School; and advising the dean of graduate studies
and research on the implementation of academic policy.
D. The voting members of the committee shall be composed of one member elected by the voting
faculty of each college/school that has a graduate program and shall vote in the interest of their
college/school. Nominees shall be from disciplines connected to graduate programs. Half of the
faculty members shall be elected for two-year terms in even-numbered years and half of the faculty
members shall be elected for two-year terms in odd-numbered years. When there are an odd number
of colleges/schools, the extra member shall be elected in odd-numbered years.
E. The dean of graduate studies and research and the registrar shall be ex-officio non-voting members
of the committee for purposes of communication. Additional administrative members of the
committee are non-voting and may include the dean of library services and the dean of enrollment.
F. The chair of the committee shall be elected by the faculty as a whole in even-numbered years. The
chair serves in the interest of UIW and does not represent a college/school. The chair does not vote
except to break a tie.
G. The chair shall serve as a voting member of the Senate Executive Committee, Faculty Senate, and
the Academic Dean’s Council. The chair shall submit a monthly report of progress and goals to the
Faculty Senate and a full report at the end of each semester.
H. A simple majority of voting members must be present at each meeting to achieve a quorum.
Article XIII - Faculty Affairs Committee
A. The Faculty Affairs Committee is responsible for the study of all matters dealing with the
professional and economic welfare of the faculty as a group and as individuals and reporting on
them to the Faculty Senate with recommendations for action. The committee is concerned with
matters affecting the total faculty, such as recommendations for procedure on promotion and tenure,
teaching load, salary scale and fringe benefits, working conditions, and other such relevant matters.
28
29
B. The committee shall review faculty applications for sabbatical and make recommendations to the
provost.
C. The committee shall be composed of one member elected by the voting faculty of each
college/school and shall vote in the interest of UIW. Half of the members shall be elected for two-
year terms in even-numbered years and half of the members shall be elected in odd- numbered
years. When there are an odd number of colleges/schools, the extra member shall be elected in the
odd-numbered years.
D. The chair is elected by the faculty as a whole in odd-numbered years. The chair serves in the interest
of UIW and does not represent a college/school. The chair does not vote except to break a tie.
E. The chair shall serve as a voting member of the Senate Executive Committee, Faculty Senate, and
the Academic Dean’s Council. The chair shall submit a monthly report of progress and goals to the
Faculty Senate and a full report at the end of each semester.
F. A simple majority of voting members must be present at each meeting to achieve a quorum.
Article XIV - Rank and Tenure Committee
A. The Rank and Tenure Committee is responsible for the evaluation of applications of faculty
members desiring promotion and/or tenure. Recommendations of the committee are forwarded to
the provost for action and communicated to the individual applicants.
B. The committee shall be composed of one member elected by the voting faculty of each
college/school from a list of all full-time faculty members with tenure or multi-year renewable-
term appointments who have taught at UIW for at least three years prior to the time of election.
Committee members vote in the interest of UIW. Half of the members shall be elected for two-year
terms in even-numbered years and half of the members shall be elected for two-year terms in odd-
numbered years. When there are an odd number of colleges/schools, the extra member shall be
elected in the odd-numbered years.
C. Faculty members are not eligible to serve on the committee if they expect to apply for promotion
during the term of office.
D. The chair is elected by the faculty as a whole in odd-numbered years. The chair serves in the interest
of UIW and does not represent a college/school. The chair does not vote except to break a tie.
E. The chair shall submit a summary report to Faculty Senate at the end of each year.
F. A simple majority of voting members must be present at each meeting to achieve a quorum.
Article XV - Faculty Development Fund Review Committee
A. The Faculty Development Fund Review Committee is responsible for the evaluation of faculty
applications for funding from the Faculty Development Funds and with awarding funds to the
applicants. Award decisions are forwarded directly to the provost. (See “FDFR Guidelines”.) The
committee shall administer these funds equitably, keep adequate records of actions taken and funds
spent, and make recommendations to Faculty Senate on changes to policy or procedure involving
Faculty Development Funds.
B. The committee shall be composed of one member elected by the voting faculty of each
college/school and shall vote in the interest of UIW. Half of the members shall be elected for two-
year terms in even-numbered years, and half of the members shall be elected for two-year terms in
odd-numbered years. When there are an odd number of colleges/schools, the extra member shall
be elected in the odd-numbered years. No member shall serve two consecutive terms.
C. The chair is elected by the faculty as a whole in odd-numbered years. The chair serves in the interest
of UIW and does not represent a college/school. The chair does not vote except to break a tie.
30
D. The chair shall submit a monthly report to the Faculty Senate in cooperation with the Treasurer
and a full report at the end of each semester.
E. A simple majority of voting members must be present at each meeting to achieve a quorum.
Article XVI - Amendments
A. Proposed amendments to this Constitution and Bylaws must be presented in writing to the Faculty
Senate during a regular meeting. At the next regular meeting, a majority of the Faculty Senate shall
vote to designate the amendment as a simple amendment or determine that an amendment must be
presented to the faculty as a whole.
B. Following the approval for presentation of an amendment by the Faculty Senate to the faculty as a
whole, the president shall select a date for a secret ballot by the voting membership of the faculty
as a whole. The date should occur in the same academic year and not more than one month after
the approval by the Faculty Senate.
C. Not less than five days prior to the balloting, a copy of the amendment and a notice of the time and
place or method of balloting shall be sent to each voting member of the faculty as a whole.
D. A simple amendment shall be ratified by the Faculty Senate. If sent to the voting membership of
the faculty as a whole, ratification shall be by a two-thirds majority of those members voting.
E. An amendment shall be in effect immediately upon ratification.
Article XVII - Ratification
A. This Constitution and Bylaws was ratified by the Faculty Association on November 21, 1997, and
approved by the Board of Trustees on December 11, 1997.
B. The Faculty Senate shall be responsible for evaluating the faculty governance system established
by this Constitution and Bylaws every two-years in the fall of odd-numbered years.
31
Faculty Governance Representation Chart
Every college/school has a right to representation as described below. They may, if preferred, choose to
combine their representation with another college/school. Each committee member has a single vote.
Number of members Elected Represents
President At large, limited to 2 consecutive terms
university
Vice President At large university Secretary At large university Treasurer At large university
Senators 2 for each college/school By college/school college/school At Large senators 4 At large university
Chairs of all standing
committees
At large Non-voting
except to break a
tie
Standing Committees
Faculty Affairs 1 for each college/school By college/school university
Nominations 1 for each college/school By college/school university
Faculty Development Funds
1 for each college/school At large university
Rank and Tenure 1 for each college/school By college/school university
Undergraduate Council 1 for each college/school with an undergraduate program
By college/school college/school
Graduate Council 1 for each college/school with an graduate program
By college/school college/school
Grievance 1 for each college/school By college/school university
Administrative Committees Included in the Faculty Senate Election Process
IRB 1 for each college/school By college/school university
Faculty Research Awards 1 for each college/school By college/school,
2-year term, limited
to 2 consecutive terms
university
32
CHAPTER 4: POLICIES AND PROCEDURES GOVERNING FULL-TIME FACULTY
EMPLOYMENT
General Statement on Policies Concerning Faculty
The University of the Incarnate Word (UIW) is dedicated to the free pursuit of truth and the responsible
dissemination of knowledge. Involved in the achievement of these goals is a community of scholars made
up of students, faculty, staff, and administrators. As members of this community, faculty have the freedom
and the responsibility to pursue the truth and to present it effectively. They are expected to improve their
teaching effectiveness and scholarly competence continually and to demonstrate such development; to
contribute service to the university, their professions, and the larger community; to act always in a manner
consistent with the stated Mission of the university.
Faculty employment is subject to all rights, privileges, and duties delineated in the Faculty Handbook and
handbook supplements.
Although many of the policies and procedures specified in this document are similar to those recommended
by the American Association of University Professors (AAUP) and other organizations, the university
declares that its policies are independent of those or any other agency and that it cannot be bound by
interpretations of its policies suggested by such an agency.
Faculty Membership
General Faculty
The General Faculty of UIW consists of persons who hold full or limited faculty status.
Full faculty status is accorded by the Board to members of the teaching faculty and administration who hold
full-time appointments and have academic rank. "Academic rank" is defined as the rank of professor,
associate professor, assistant professor, or instructor. Persons holding full faculty status are eligible for
promotion in academic rank and for faculty tenure. Exception: Faculty are not eligible for tenure at the rank
of Instructor or in circumstances as otherwise defined in handbook supplements.
Limited faculty status is held by full-time employees of the university who teach part-time and/or have
special titles instead of rank. This may include members of the teaching faculty, librarians, and
administration. Persons holding limited faculty status are not eligible for promotion in academic rank or for
faculty tenure.
Graduate Faculty
The graduate faculty consists of faculty designated by the college/school dean to teach in programs in that
college/school. (See APPENDIX 20: GRADUATE FACULTY APPOINTMENT PROCEDURE
An effective graduate program is nurtured by the scholarly stimulation of a group of faculty whose
specialties are complementary. The number of faculty required in a graduate program varies with the
discipline(s) and the breadth of the program.
33
Policies on Academic Freedom
The University of the Incarnate Word believes that:
A. Faculty members are entitled to full freedom in research and in the publication of results, subject
to the adequate performance of their other academic duties; but research for pecuniary return must
be discussed with the provost.
B. Faculty members are entitled to full freedom in the classroom in discussing their subjects, but
should not introduce into their teaching controversial matters which have no relation to their
subjects nor which are contrary to the Mission.
C. Faculty members are entitled to full freedom in the UIW community to address any matter of
institutional policy or action. They are encouraged, but not limited to, working within the existing
governance structure of UIW.
D. Faculty members are participants in the broader community, members of learned professions, and
officers of an educational institution. When they speak or write as individuals or private citizens,
they should be free from institutional censorship or discipline, but their position in the community
imposes special obligations. Hence, in all cases of public extramural utterances, faculty members
and UIW-associated groups are responsible for accuracy, restraint, intellectual tolerance, and
institutional disassociation. (See Appendix 11: Declaration of Affiliation Policy)
Faculty Personnel Policies
General Duties and Responsibilities
(See Ch. 5 on General Standards for Faculty Performance for Faculty
Performance)
Official duties and responsibilities of faculty members at the university include:
1. Teaching
2. Scholarship
3. University and Community Service 4. Professional Activities 5. Respectful support of overall goals and the Christian ideals and philosophy expressed in the
Mission Statement.
Workload
The normative full-time instructional load is twelve credit hours per semester or as defined in Handbook
supplements. Full-time instructional load may vary according to such factors as: nine or twelve month
assignments, enrollment per class; type and level (graduate/professional/undergraduate) of instruction;
clinical assignments or rotations; engagement in assigned administrative, research, program development,
faculty development, or other assigned activities. A faculty member may also be given the opportunity to
distribute the instructional load unevenly between the fall and spring semesters or over the summer.
Workload for summer courses (which includes any May mini-terms) is limited to three courses (nine credit
hours) per person. Instructional load assignments and goals for scholarship, service, and professional
activities will be worked out by the faculty member together with the college/school dean on an annual
basis.
34
1. Professional Ethics
Faculty members are expected to maintain the highest standards of professional ethics in all aspects of their
jobs, as teachers, scholars, colleagues, members of the university and of the larger community. This sense
of ethical responsibility is manifest in ways of acting that demonstrate institutional fit with the Mission of
UIW.
Guidelines for Evidence of Institutional Fit with the Mission of UIW
(Approved by the Provost, 3/7/12)
Introduction
The goal of better articulating what is meant by institutional fit at UIW is to encourage each of us to reflect
on the broad range of behaviors consistent with the Mission Statement. We are challenged to model in our
professional lives the kinds of behaviors we believe can continue to build a quality learning community.
The supervising deans may ultimately refer to these examples during faculty evaluations in order to
recognize individual contributions or to address specific problems. Colleagues may do the same at critical
points such as 3rd year review or for tenure. At other times, specific problems can be addressed by contacting
the appropriate dean or the provost (see Appendix 10: Professional Ethics Complaint Procedures)
Below is a set of behaviors to evidence fit and it is not meant to be a checklist. The main purpose is to
encourage us to establish a pattern of professional practice in line with the mission and values of the UIW
community.
Definition of Institutional Fit with the Mission of UIW—Focus on Faculty
Institutional fit relates to the way in which an individual embodies the Mission, the cultural values, the
educational philosophy, and the sense of social justice of the University of the Incarnate Word; fit is a way
of acting in an ethical manner in the work environment that shows respect for the dignity of each person
and promotes the good of the UIW community. Institutional fit may be evidenced when an individual
demonstrates:
A. A basic philosophy of education inspired by the faith-based mission of the Sisters of Charity of
the Incarnate Word—behaviors may include:
1. Promoting life-long learning and the development of the whole person.
2. Collaborating with other faculty and students in searching for the truth.
3. Encouraging dialogue and looking at all sides of an argument; modeling the importance of
free inquiry and civil debate.
4. Engaging students in quality research and artistic expression.
5. Respecting the integration of liberal arts and professional studies.
6. Valuing thoughtful innovation and global perspective.
7. Valuing social justice and service in the larger community.
B. An ability to work collegially and productively within the university community—behaviors may
include:
1. Being regularly available, accessible, respectful, and responsive to colleagues.
2. Taking the initiative to orient new employees to the university.
3. Willing to be a mentor and to help others improve performance.
4. Cooperating with others in accomplishing the work of the university.
5. Fair and impartial judging of the work and opinion of others.
6. Discouraging all forms of prejudice, bias, bigotry, discrimination, and intimidation.
35
7. Consideration of others who might be affected by actions or decisions.
8. Following the rules and procedures of the university.
9. Suggesting ways to improve the overall quality of the university.
10. Staying informed about developments in the university.
11. Willing to engage in constructive dialogue in the growth and development of the university.
C. Responsiveness to demands for service in the university environment—behaviors may include: 1. Willing to teach where and when needed according to their abilities.
2. Being regularly available, accessible, respectful, and responsive to students and colleagues.
3. Taking the initiative to orient new employees to the university.
4. Volunteering to meet the needs of the university and following through as necessary to
complete tasks.
5. Attending meetings/functions not required but that support university operations and
image.
2. Availability
All members of the faculty shall be available from the beginning of the contract period until the end of the
contract period for academic activities that involve instruction, assigned and informal meetings with
students, and for those initiatives that involve collaboration with colleagues and administration. Any
exceptions are to be arranged with the college/school dean. Some faculty standing committees and ad hoc
committee work will require participation beyond faculty contract dates; any such work will be coordinated
with the dean to either offset within the faculty member’s contracted workload and service expectations or
compensated separately. Unless excused by the provost, all members of the full-time faculty must
participate in the commencement exercises, in faculty workshops opening each semester, and in other
official academic convocations. Academic garb is to be worn by all faculty members during commencement
exercises and academic convocations.
3. Consultantships and Any Employment Beyond Contract Duties
Faculty may engage in consultantships, professional services, or other employment outside the university
with the understanding that these activities will not interfere with their contractual obligations to the
university and will be reported to the appropriate dean. The same constraints apply to overload
assignments, and requests to teach for multiple UIW schools or divisions, which must first be approved
by the dean.
4. Scholarship Products
Publications, lectures, artistic works or performances, patentable scientific research and inventions, or
marketable commodities are covered by the “Intellectual Property Policy” (in the Employee Handbook).
Appointment
Statement of Terms of Appointment
The terms and conditions of every appointment to the faculty will be stated in the signed letter of offer the
terms of which are incorporated by intent in the initial and subsequent contracts. Copies of contracts will
be supplied to the faculty member. Any subsequent extensions or modifications of an appointment, special
understandings, or notices incumbent upon either party to provide, will be stated in a letter of
36
understanding signed by the provost and kept in the faculty personnel file. A copy will be given to the
faculty member.
All full-time appointments to the rank of instructor, or assistant professor or higher are of four kinds: (1)
appointments designated as non-tenure which do not lead to tenure, but may lead to continuous eligibility
for re-appointment (and promotion in the case of multi-year renewable faculty appointments—see
Appendix 24); (2) appointments that may lead to tenure with attainment of a terminal degree; (3)
appointments with probation on the tenure track; (4) appointments with continuous tenure.
Initial Appointments
In the case of initial appointments to the full-time faculty, the appointment, and the designation of
responsibilities and of rank shall be made by the provost subject to approval by the president. The action of
the president shall be based upon the recommendation of the provost in consultation with the college/school
dean. If the proposed rank is different from that previously held or rank was not previously held, the Rank
and Tenure Committee shall be consulted.
The initial assignment of rank includes consideration of academic credentials and professional experience.
The rank of professor, associate professor, and assistant professor require the terminal degree. In some
cases, faculty within the discipline concerned will be asked to evaluate professional experience before the
college/school dean sends a recommendation to the Rank and Tenure Committee.
All teaching faculty who are instructors of record for credit-bearing courses are expected to meet the
credential guidelines published by SACSCOC (www.sacscoc.org/policies.asp#guidelines). In rare
occasions, limited exceptions to the guidelines may be justified (see APPENDIX 23: FACULTY
CREDENTIALS FOR TEACHING).
Contracts for Services
The agreement for services between the university and an individual member of the faculty is set forth in a
standard formal contract. An individual member of the faculty is bound by the terms of the contract only
for the duration specified in the contract. The university recognizes the prerogative of an individual to seek
and secure another position, and in no way will interfere with this prerogative. Faculty members whose
contracts are to be renewed receive a written contract prepared by the administration in a timely fashion
after the March meeting of the Board of Trustees. The contract states position, rank, salary, and any special
conditions of employment to be operative during the contract period. Contracts are signed by faculty
members accepting employment and returned to the president within thirty days after issuance. The
university reserves the right to withdraw a contract which is not signed and returned within this period.
Contracts for part-time may be canceled and faculty notified as soon as possible prior to the beginning of
a course. (See CHAPTER 8: PART-CHAPTER 8: PART-TIME FACULTY—RIGHTS AND
RESPONSIBILITIES
Faculty Titles
1. Ranked Faculty (Titles may vary in individual schools. See Handbook supplements.)
a. Instructor: The rank of Instructor requires the master's degree appropriate to the discipline (or the equivalent). The initial appointment of Instructor is not available to faculty holding the terminal degree (see c. below). This rank is for persons on one-year, renewable, full-time contracts. Faculty are not eligible for tenure while holding the rank of instructor. There is no
37
limit to the number of years a person may hold the rank of instructor. Should the instructor
obtain the requisite terminal degree and be placed on the tenure track, one year spent as an
Instructor may also be credited toward tenure upon review of credentials and recommendation
of the provost.
b. Senior Instructor: This rank requires the master’s degree appropriate to the discipline and five years of experience as a UIW instructor. Senior instructors remain eligible for continuous reappointment as long as there is continuous and productive service and the needs of the university remain the same.
c. Other Non-Tenured Faculty: In exceptional cases, faculty with the terminal degree may be hired at the rank of assistant professor, associate professor or professor (see Handbook
supplements for clarification). This status and eligibility for promotion will be established in writing at the point of hire. Faculty with special duties may be designated with special titles such as assistant/associate research professor or clinical professor, etc.
d. Assistant Professor: The rank of assistant professor requires the terminal degree appropriate to the discipline. (See APPENDIX 2: UIW EXCEPTIONS TO THE TERMINAL DEGREE)
e. Associate Professor: The rank of associate professor requires the earned terminal degree appropriate to the discipline. In addition, the candidate must have completed five years of
successful teaching experience as an assistant professor.
f. Professor: The rank of professor requires the earned terminal degree appropriate to the discipline, as determined in the same manner as for promotion to associate professor, and five years of successful teaching experience at the rank of associate professor.
2. Full-Time Faculty with Special Titles
a. Distinguished Professor: This is an honorary designation awarded to recognize any faculty
member regardless of academic rank or standing whose contribution and standing in the field
is outstanding or for whom the evidence of scholarly production is significant. For this
appointment the Rank and Tenure Committee shall be consulted by the provost.
b. Professors Holding Endowed Chairs: These titles recognize distinguished teachers, scholars or
artists with appointments that vary in length depending on the terms of the funding endowment.
If a person is hired as an Endowed Chair, eligibility for promotion and tenure will be
determined at the point of hire.
c. Other Special Titles: These titles are used in special circumstances for short-term appointments,
e.g., visiting faculty, or artist--, scholar--, or executive in residence.
3. Professor Emeritus/Emerita
Retired faculty shall have served ten tenured years at the university or at least fifteen years total.
Upon retirement the college/school faculty will send a request to the provost to award this title. The
decision to award this title will be forwarded by the provost for information to the Rank and
Tenure Committee. The following benefits are intended to encourage retired faculty to continue to
participate actively in the life of the university community: listed in bulletins; use of email address
and web access (including receipt of The Word Today and The Word); UIW ID card; parking
privileges at no cost; faculty discounts, where available, at bookstore, athletic events,
performances/exhibitions; access to library facilities and services; access to wellness center at
38
faculty rates; option of participating in academic convocation and commencement exercises;
retained on all mailing lists that contain information of general interest to UIW faculty; if available,
shared office space; preference in part-time teaching opportunities, if requested, available, and
dean approved; participation in UIW seminars, colloquia, lectures, exhibitions, and other scholarly
pursuits; eligibility to serve as PI or Co-PI on research grants or projects, or supervise doctoral,
masters or undergraduate students, or be on graduate committees, if dean approved; opportunity to
audit courses tuition free, contingent upon available space and instructor approval; other options
available at the discretion of the president or provost.
4. Part-Time Faculty
Lecturer and Senior Lecturer: Persons whose only contractual responsibility to the University of
the Incarnate Word is teaching on a part-time basis (see CHAPTER 8: PART-TIME FACULTY—
RIGHTS AND RESPONSIBILITIES).
Reappointment, Promotion, and Tenure
General Criteria
To qualify for reappointment, promotion, or tenure, a faculty member must show competence and growth
in teaching, research and other scholarly pursuits, production and artistic performance, and service to the
university, profession, and larger community. Institutional fit is also considered in re-appointment,
promotion, and tenuring of faculty.
In the first four areas below, the percentage in brackets indicates the relative weights of faculty effort in
development activities and achievement. For example, teaching counts as 40%, scholarship as 20%. An
additional discretionary 20% must be distributed among the four areas as agreed upon by the faculty
member and college/school dean. For example, one faculty member may focus more on teaching one year
so it is weighted 50% (instead of 40), and 25% on university and community service (instead of 15). Areas
2 and 4 would remain at 20% and 5% accordingly. Faculty must show evidence of satisfactory growth in
all four areas (see Handbook supplements for other descriptions of faculty workload):
Teaching (40%)
Scholarship (20%)
Service (15%)
Professional Activities (5%)
Discretionary (20%)
Promotion in Rank
Academic Preparation and Years in Rank
The following criteria must be met before full-time faculty are eligible to apply for promotion in rank
(exceptions are described in Handbook supplements):
39
1. Instructor to Senior Instructor—faculty must have completed five years of successful teaching
experience at the instructor level at UIW.
2. Instructor to Assistant Professor—faculty hired as an instructor with the possibility of conversion
to the tenure track must have earned the terminal degree before they are recommended by the
dean for promotion and approved by the provost to be on the tenure track.
3. Assistant to Associate Professor—faculty must possess as a minimum the earned terminal degree
appropriate to the discipline, and have completed five years of successful teaching experience as
an assistant professor. At least one year of successful teaching must be completed at UIW.
Promotion to associate professor is normally accompanied by tenure.
4. Associate to Full Professor—faculty must possess as a minimum the earned terminal degree
appropriate to the discipline, and have completed five years of successful teaching experience as
an associate professor. At least one year of successful teaching must be completed at UIW.
Procedures for Promotion in Rank to Senior Instructor
In the matter of granting promotion in rank to senior instructor, the president shall receive recommendations
from the provost. Normally, advancement in rank becomes effective at the beginning of the next academic
year.
The provost will survey the faculty annually and inform all faculty members who meet the minimum
number of years in rank for promotion that they are eligible to be considered for promotion and will provide
the list to the college/school deans. All who are eligible must declare in writing by September 1 to their
college/school dean their intention to begin the review process. All persons under consideration will be
asked to provide supporting evidence, which, when assembled, will constitute part of the promotion file.
These documents will be given to their college/school dean.
College/School Rank and Tenure Advisory Committee Guidelines
A. Each college/school shall have a Rank and Tenure Advisory Committees (RTAC) that is
responsible for evaluating all progress to promotion and tenure in the college/school in accordance
with the timeline and procedures defined in the Faculty Handbook concerning the Third Year
Review, Promotion to Senior Instructor and Promotion to Associate Professor, Full Professor and
Tenure.
B. RTAC shall be composed of only full-time faculty members in each college/school who:
a) have tenure or the rank of Associate Professor and above in schools without tenure,
b) have taught at UIW for at least three years prior to the time of service,
c) are not members of the Rank and Tenure Committee.
C. RTAC shall have a sufficient number of members to adequately represent different
programs/disciplines within each college/school. The precise number of faculty on RTAC shall be
determined by the full-time faculty of each college/school, but shall adhere to the following
guidelines. A college/school may elect to have a RTAC that is inclusive of all faculty that meet the
criteria identified above or form a smaller committee elected by the full-time faculty of the
college/school. RTAC shall consist of no fewer than three members including the chair. When there
are fewer than three faculty in a college/school that are eligible for service on RTAC, the committee
may be composed of faculty from more than one college/school. When there are no faculty in the
college/school eligible to serve on RTAC, all rank and tenure applications will be
40
referred to the university Rank and Tenure committee. A member of the Rank and Tenure
Committee will call a meeting of college/school faculty to guide them in composition of a letter
from the school faculty for submission to the Rank and Tenure Committee.
D. Each college/school will have bylaws that specify the make-up of their RTAC, the electoral process,
and other procedures necessary for fulfilling the responsibilities of this committee defined by the
Faculty Handbook. College/school bylaws, and any changes to existing bylaws, must be approved
by the faculty in the college/school, the Faculty Senate and the provost.
E. One faculty person shall be elected by faculty as the chair of RTAC.
F. A simple majority of voting members must be present at each meeting to achieve a quorum.
G. The chair of RTAC is responsible for keeping a “Record of Meeting” for each session of the
committee. Such record shall include an agenda of committee business and minutes from the
previous meeting (including a clear indication of actions taken). The “Record of Meeting” is not to
be distributed outside the committee. The chair submits all such records to the provost at the end
of the academic year for permanent keeping.
Application Timeline for Promotion to Senior Instructor
1. By the first week of April, the provost shall contact the deans of each college/school to get lists of
faculty who have served five years as instructors and are eligible for promotion to Senior Instructor
during the coming academic year.
2. By the last week of April, the provost shall send out notification letters to all faculty who are newly
eligible for promotion to Senior Instructor during the coming academic year.
3. By October 1, the faculty member shall submit documentation of performance including a current
CV and the Self Evaluation Form Checklists for Teaching, Service, and Professional Activities to
the College/School Rank and Tenure Advisory Committee (RTAC) and the dean.
4. By November 1, RTAC shall submit a written recommendation for or against promotion to Senior
Instructor to the dean.
5. By January 15, the dean shall consult with the faculty member and share the assessment letter
which will then be submitted to the provost.
6. Recommendations by the deans are due to the provost by February 1.
Procedures for Promotion in Rank to Assistant Professor
Based on satisfactory teaching and the needs of the department, deans may recommend faculty who have
earned the terminal degree be promoted to assistant professor on the tenure track. Recommendations must
be approved by the provost.
41
Promotion in Rank to Associate Professor and Tenure
1. The Probationary Period
To be recognized for tenure/promotion the faculty member must have earned the terminal degree
appropriate to the discipline. Faculty members shall be tenured/promoted on the basis of approved terminal
degrees at the time tenure is to be granted. Determining institutional needs is an essential part of the
probationary period. If institutional need is a concern in a particular case, the dean will document this in
the annual evaluation process for probationary faculty.
Beginning with appointment to the rank of full-time assistant professor or a higher rank in the tenure track
at the university, the probationary period should not ordinarily exceed six years. The length of the
probationary period will be specified in the original letter of agreement from the provost. Note three kinds
of situations:
a. Faculty who begin their careers at the university must complete five years of full-time service at
the university, be reviewed for tenure/promotion in the sixth year, and, if approved by the Board in
March, tenure/promotion becomes effective immediately and is designated in the contract for the
next academic year;
b. Faculty who come to the university after a term of probationary service in one or more other
institutions may, if agreed to in writing, receive credit for up to three years of service, complete
two more years of full-time service at the university (to equal 5 years of service), be reviewed the
following year, and, if approved by the Board in March, tenure/promotion becomes effective
immediately and is designated in the contract for the next academic year;
c. Faculty who were tenured at another institution may be reviewed at the earliest in the fall semester
of their second year of service at the university, and, if approved by the Board in June, receive a
contract in August with tenure for their third year.
In special circumstances, a faculty person may petition the provost for an extension of the probationary
period up to a maximum of two years beyond the contractually agreed upon pre-tenure/promotion period.
Such an extension will be considered in cases in which significant personal or professional circumstances
have impeded progress toward tenure/promotion. At the completion of the extension period, the faculty
must apply for tenure/promotion that fall or be terminated at the end of the same academic year.
The faculty person begins the process of requesting an extension by consulting with the dean, who may in
turn seek guidance from the members of the faculty’s department. After consulting with the dean, the faculty
presents the request in writing to the provost before June 1 of the year of eligibility, normally year six. The
provost will consult with the dean and the Rank and Tenure Committee. If approved by the provost, the
terms of the extension will be put in writing, signed by the faculty person and the provost, and placed in the
person’s file.
Academic administrators holding the rank of assistant professor or above who have completed at least a
three-year probationary period teaching full-time in another institution will be reviewed for
tenure/promotion only after completing a minimum of three years of service at the university. (See the
policy for Administrators with Faculty Status)
2. Third-Year Review
42
For faculty on the tenure track, in the third year the dean’s annual evaluation anticipates the kind of review
done by the Rank and Tenure Committee for promotion to associate professor and tenure.
Application Timeline for Third-Year Review
1. By October 1, the College/School Rank and Tenure Advisory Committee (RTAC), in consultation
with the dean, shall identify faculty members who are eligible for third-year review for promotion
and tenure.
2. During the fall semester, the faculty member shall select a colleague who will observe a class and
evaluate teaching materials. The written assessment shall be submitted to the faculty member for
inclusion in the portfolio.
3. The dean shall observe a different class. The written assessment shall be submitted to the faculty
member for inclusion in the portfolio.
4. By January 15, the faculty member shall submit to the dean and RTAC a portfolio assembled in
the same manner as shall be done in applying for promotion and tenure. The introductory section
shall include statements on teaching philosophy and institutional fit. Individual letters of
recommendation are not solicited for this review.
5. By February 15, RTAC shall review the materials, consult as needed with other members of the
faculty, and write an assessment of the faculty’s progress toward promotion and tenure with
recommendations for strengthening the application in the sixth year; this recommendation is
submitted to the dean and faculty member.
6. Using a three-year holistic view of faculty performance in the categories of instruction, scholarship,
service, professional activity, and institutional fit, the dean shall write a third-year assessment of
the faculty member’s likelihood of readiness to apply successfully for tenure in year six.
7. By March 15, the dean shall consult with the faculty member and share the assessment letter which
will then be submitted to the provost.
8. Faculty on an abbreviated schedule for tenure consideration, because of credit for previous
experience, will be evaluated midway in their schedule.
Procedures for Tenure/Promotion to Associate Professor
1. Criteria for Tenure/Promotion to Associate Professor
To qualify for tenure/promotion, a faculty member must show competence and growth in teaching, research
and other scholarly pursuits, production and artistic performance, and service to the university, profession,
and larger community. Institutional fit is also considered in determining whether the faculty member is to
be granted or denied tenure/promotion.
Since tenure involves a long-term commitment between the individual and the institution, questions
regarding institutional fit and institutional need are especially important considerations in the tenure
process.
43
2. Procedures for Tenure/Promotion to Associate Professor
A faculty member must be evaluated by the Rank and Tenure Committee for tenure/promotion
recommendation during the sixth year of full-time faculty service at the university level, so that, if approved
by the Board, they receive a contract with tenure/promotion for the seventh year. Summer employment does
NOT satisfy the time requirement unless negotiated as a part of the academic year workload.
The provost shall provide the Rank and Tenure Committee with a list of potential candidates for
tenure/promotion stating the date of initial appointment and noting any approved extensions of the
probationary period. By September 15, the chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee makes public a final
list of those who will be reviewed for tenure/promotion. Interested faculty may forward an unsolicited
signed letter of recommendation to the Rank and Tenure Committee.
Written recommendations concerning tenure/promotion will be provided to the Rank and Tenure
Committee by the respective college/school dean and faculty. The dean invites a senior tenured professor
in the candidate’s college/school to call the tenured faculty together during September for discussion and
closed ballot vote regarding those to be reviewed. Members of the Rank and Tenure Committee do not
attend any of these meetings. By October 1, the senior professor will forward to the Rank and Tenure
Committee a summary of the discussion and vote and a list of faculty participating in the recommendation.
After the final Board decision, the provost will return the entire file to the candidate, excluding letters of
recommendation. The provost will keep letters of recommendation in the files of the Rank and Tenure
proceedings. Files will be purged after five years.
The Rank and Tenure Committee may recommend the awarding of tenure/promotion or denial. Before the
committee reaches a final decision of “non-recommendation,” a letter will be sent to the candidate offering
the opportunity for a personal interview with the Rank and Tenure Committee to support the application.
Prior to the interview, the candidate may request to examine all materials upon which the rank and tenure
decision will be made, including letters of recommendation.
In case of denial of recommendation for tenure/promotion, the Rank and Tenure Committee will send a
letter of specific explanation to the individual. Recommendations for tenure/promotion from the Rank and
Tenure Committee are forwarded to the provost. The recommendations of the Rank and Tenure Committee
and of the provost are forwarded to the president for recommendation to the Board of Trustees for a final
decision.
If the president and Board of Trustees approve tenure/promotion, it becomes effective immediately and
appears in the contract for the next academic year. Tenure is held in the institution and not in a program or
specialty.
If the faculty member fails to receive a favorable recommendation regarding tenure, the appointment shall
not be continued beyond the following academic year.
Grounds for appeal of denial of recommendation for tenure/promotion and procedures are described below
in the Non-Reappointment of Probationary Faculty section.
Although tenure is not an unconditional guarantee of employment, it does assure the tenured faculty
member that he or she will not be dismissed without an explicit statement of the cause and a fair hearing to
establish whether the cause is valid, pertinent, and sufficient to justify such an action.
See below for the Application Timeline for Promotion to Associate Professor/Tenure and Full Professor.
44
Procedures for Promotion in Rank to Full Professor
1. Criteria for Promotion to Full Professor
To qualify for promotion to full professor, a faculty member must show competence and growth in teaching,
increased research and other scholarly pursuits, production and artistic performance, and service to the
university, profession, and larger community. Institutional fit is also considered in determining whether the
faculty member is to be granted or denied promotion.
Since this promotion presumes a long-term commitment between the individual and the institution,
questions regarding institutional fit continue to be an important consideration for this promotion.
2. Procedures for Promotion to Full Professor
In the matter of granting promotion in rank to full professor, the president shall receive recommendations
from the Rank and Tenure Committee and the provost. The action of the president in granting promotion
in rank is subject to approval by the Board of Trustees. Normally, advancement in rank becomes effective
at the beginning of the next academic year.
The provost will survey the faculty annually and inform all faculty members who meet the minimum
number of years in rank for promotion that they are eligible to be considered for promotion and will provide
the list to the Rank and Tenure Committee. All who are newly eligible must declare in writing by September
1 to their college/school dean their intention either to begin or postpone the review process. Only those who
do so can submit materials to be reviewed by the committee. By September 15, the Chair of the Committee
makes public a final list of those who will be reviewed for promotion. This enables any interested faculty
to forward an unsolicited signed letter of recommendation to the Rank and Tenure Committee.
All persons under consideration will be asked to provide supporting evidence, which, when assembled, will
constitute part of the promotion file. These documents will be given to the Rank and Tenure Committee.
Letters of recommendation will be sent under separate cover to the Rank and Tenure Committee from: the
college/school dean; the college/school meeting of tenured faculty; and individual colleagues, solicited and
unsolicited.
Before a final decision of "non-recommendation" is reached by the Rank and Tenure Committee, a letter
will be sent to the faculty applicant offering the opportunity for a personal interview with the Committee.
In the case of a final decision of denial of recommendation for promotion, the Rank and Tenure Committee
will send a letter of specific explanation to the individual.
To appeal a recommendation of the Rank and Tenure Committee allegedly based on inadequate
consideration, violation of academic freedom, or discrimination, see procedures outlined in D. in the non-
reappointment section below.
Application Timeline for Tenure/Promotion to Associate Professor and Full Professor
1. During the spring semester
The provost shall contact the deans of each college/school to get lists of faculty who will be
eligible the following academic year for promotion and/or tenure.
45
The provost shall send notification letters to all faculty who are newly eligible for promotion and/or
tenure consideration in the coming academic year and to the chair of the Rank and Tenure
Committee.
2. By the end of the spring semester The faculty member eligible for promotion and/or tenure shall consult with the dean about readiness
for promotion and/or tenure. If a decision is made not to apply for the rank of Associate Professor
and/or tenure, a request for extension must be submitted to the provost by June 1.
The Rank and Tenure Committee members and the chairs of the College/School Rank and Tenure
Advisory Committees (RTAC) shall meet with the provost to review committee responsibilities
and duties, particularly as they pertain to issues of confidentiality and the record keeping of
committee meetings.
The chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee shall send a letter informing eligible faculty of the
timeline for submission of materials and the dates for orientation meetings
3. By the beginning of the fall semester
Orientation meetings for faculty submitting applications for promotion and/or tenure shall be
offered by the Rank and Tenure Committee chair by the end of the spring semester and the
beginning of the fall semester. In the case that the chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee is newly
elected, the orientation meetings will be conducted by both the outgoing and incoming chairs.
4. By September 1
The candidate shall have a meeting with his/her dean to review the portfolio. At this meeting, the
candidate should discuss with the dean the relative weight to assign to each of the four areas.
The chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee shall send an email to the entire faculty announcing
the names of those faculty who will be undergoing promotion and/or tenure review.
5. By September 15 Portfolios for promotion and tenure shall be electronically submitted to the dean and the
college/school RTAC.
Upon receipt of the application materials for tenure and/or promotion, the chair of RTAC shall
make the applicant’s portfolio available to all tenured faculty (or faculty with rank of Associate or
Full Professor in schools without tenure) in the college/school. Each college/school may choose to
make something less than the full portfolio available to the tenured faculty in matters of promotion
only. College/school bylaws shall specify the content of the portfolio that is to be made available
when promotion alone is being considered.
6. By October 1 The RTAC chair shall invite all tenured faculty (or faculty with rank of Associate or Full Professor
in schools without tenure) of the college/school to a meeting to gather input on candidates up for
promotion and/or tenure. After the meeting, RTAC shall meet to write a letter of opinion on the
application taking into consideration the full portfolio and input from the faculty meeting. A
separate letter shall be written for each candidate reporting: those present at the meeting, results
of the ballot, and a summary of strengths and concerns. Any additional
46
procedures or details shall be included in the bylaws of each college/school. The letter shall be
delivered to the Rank and Tenure Committee by the deadline specified (2 above).
7. Before the dean’s letter is submitted to the Rank and Tenure Committee, the dean is required to
indicate to the candidate in person the reasons for the dean’s expected recommendation to the Rank
and Tenure Committee. A separate letter shall be written for each candidate. Additionally, the dean
is required to provide the candidate with a copy of the dean’s recommendation letter to the Rank
and Tenure Committee prior to submission by the Monday after fall break.
8. By Monday after Fall Break in October Portfolios are to be electronically available to the Rank and Tenure Committee. The chair of the
Rank and Tenure Committee is responsible for keeping a “Record of Meeting” for each session of
the committee. Such record will include an agenda of committee business and minutes from the
previous meeting (including a clear indication of actions taken). The “Record of Meeting” is not to
be distributed outside the committee. The chair submits all such records to the provost at the end
of the academic year for permanent keeping.
9. By February 1
Recommendations of the Rank and Tenure Committee shall be submitted to the provost.
Portfolio Instructions to Faculty from the Chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee
April day, year Professor
UIW P.O. Box #
Dear Professor :
The Rank and Tenure Committee is charged with evaluating the faculty who are to be reviewed for
promotion and/or tenure. After the Rank and Tenure Committee reviews a candidate’s supporting materials,
a recommendation is made to the provost, and the president. We expect to forward our recommendations
by February 1. The Board of Trustees makes the final decision on promotion/tenure at its March meeting.
The primary source for the committee’s evaluation is the promotion/tenure portfolio that you will put
together and submit to the committee. The attached checklists should be used in putting together your
notebook. Here are some suggestions for preparing the materials:
1. Two orientation sessions will be held to assist candidates going through the promotion/tenure
process. These sessions will take place in on the following dates: note here a date for May and
a date for August. If you want to attend one of these sessions, please let me know as soon as
possible. The attached checklists will be explained at these meetings.
2. Please prepare your materials electronically. If the committee needs additional material from you,
you will be notified later.
3. Gather your materials together as soon as possible. You are required to meet with your dean. This
meeting should take place in advance of Sept. 15 when your portfolio needs to be available to the
college/school Rank and Tenure Advisory Committee. (Check with your college/school bylaws for
the specific content of your portfolio that should be made available at this time). In this meeting
with your Dean, you will want to discuss with the dean the relative weight you assign to each of
the four areas (see Designation of Relative Weight of Faculty Work). At this meeting or prior to
the deadline for portfolio submission, the dean is required to indicate to you in person the
47
reasons for his/her expected recommendation to the Rank and Tenure Committee. Additionally,
the dean is required to provide you with a copy of the recommendation letter he/she writes to the
Rank and Tenure Committee prior to the deadline for submission of the portfolio.
4. It is recommended that you limit the number of solicited letters of recommendation to five. The
Rank and Tenure Committee suggests that the majority of your letters of recommendation should
be internal to UIW. Further we suggest that you request letters from senior, tenured faculty
preferably in your discipline or college/school or with whom you have served on major committees.
Letters that address different aspects of your professional performance are most helpful. Letters
supporting tenure applications should address the issue of institutional fit (Definition of
Institutional Fit with the Mission of UIW—Focus on Faculty). All letters should be sent directly
to me as chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee and should be received no later than the Monday
after Fall Break in October, year. Note: Letters of recommendation from non- supervising
administrators or from a dean other than the supervising dean are not to be requested by the faculty
member and/or included in the materials presented to the Rank and Tenure Committee except in
the case of scholarly collaboration with the non-supervising dean. A faculty member may request
a letter from another dean who has conducted a research project or grant activity with the faculty
as long as there is a clear distinction that the letter addresses the conduct of the research and/or
grant activity, and does not infringe, overlap, or override the authority of the supervising dean.
5. You should submit a brief summary of the quantitative data and the qualitative data (i.e., the written
evaluations of teaching by students) for each different course for the past two years of teaching in
the section of your portfolio on teaching.
6. Please refer to the Faculty Handbook (Chapter 5) for examples of activities and supporting
documentation in each area. Please include discipline specific criteria for evaluation of scholarship
when appropriate.
7. Remember that the Rank and Tenure Committee looks for evidence of activity and sustained
progress in each of the four areas and in fit. The amount and quality of activity in all four areas
increases with each successive promotion in rank (see Faculty Handbook, Chapter 5 CHAPTER 5:
FACULTY EVALUATION SYSTEM).
8. Before the committee reaches a final decision of “non-recommendation,” a letter will be sent to the
candidate offering the opportunity for a personal interview with the Rank and Tenure Committee
to support the application. Prior to the interview, the candidate may request to examine all materials
upon which the rank and tenure decision will be made, including letters of recommendation.
9. When the Rank and Tenure Committee has completed its review, I will notify you in writing as to
the recommendation.
10. Your materials are to be sent to my office, , no later than 5:00pm, on Monday after Fall
Break in October, year.
11. If I can answer questions as you prepare your portfolio, please contact me at: telephone number,
email address.
Sincerely,
Dr.
Chair, Rank and Tenure Committee
48
Format for Tenure/Promotion Portfolio and Checklists
Current Vita (updated to be current in Sedona)
Letters of Recommendation (are sent directly to Chair of Rank and Tenure Committee)
Teaching Philosophy (1-2 page statement)
Institutional Fit (1-2 page statement)
Instructional Activities CHECKLIST include 1-2 pages of brief
descriptions (see Teaching Activities and Section 7 below for
documentation)
Instructional Activities Documentation: A summary of student evaluations for the last
two years for each different course (both quantitative data and student comments), copies
of peer evaluations, course development, etc. These can be a separate tab of content; they
can also be described and attached in the body of your CV.
Scholarship CHECKLIST include 1-2 pages of brief descriptions
(see Scholarship and Section 8 for documentation)
Scholarship Documentation: Copies of publications, reviews of creative productions,
progress reports on grants, information on presentations, etc. These can be a separate tab
of content; they can also be described and attached in the body of your CV.
University and Community Service CHECKLIST include 1-2 pages of brief descriptions
(see University and Community Service and Section 9 for documentation)
University and Community Service Documentation: Letters and other accounts
attesting to service, etc. These can be a separate tab of content; they can also be
described and attached in the body of your CV.
Professional Activities CHECKLIST include 1-2 pages of brief descriptions
(see Professional Activities and Section 10 for documentation)
Professional Activities Documentation: Copies of programs for conferences,
workshops, seminars, etc. These can be a separate tab of content; they can also be
described and attached in the body of your CV.
49
Designation of Relative Weight of Faculty Work
To qualify for reappointment, promotion, or tenure, a faculty member must show competence and growth
in teaching. Research and other scholarly pursuits, production and artistic performance, and service to the
university, profession, and larger community are complementary to teaching and are also considered in
re-appointing, promoting, and tenuring faculty.
In discussion with the dean about preparing their portfolio, faculty will indicate how they perceive their
workload distributed beyond the minimum guidelines for the four areas: teaching (40%), scholarship (20%),
service (15%), and professional activities (5%). Here is one example of faculty using the discretionary 20%:
more emphasis on teaching so it is weighted 50% (instead of 40), and 25% on university and community
service (instead of 15). Service and professional activities would remain at 20% and 5%. Differences from
year to year shall be documented in the annual evaluations. Overall, faculty must show evidence of
satisfactory competence and growth in all four areas.
50
Self Evaluation Form Checklists
NAME
DATE
SELF EVALUATION FORM CHECKLIST
Teaching Activities
Please review Ch. 5 on Evaluating Teaching Effectiveness and then check those areas in which you have
demonstrated activity. Attach a one-to-two page description of what these specific activities include.
Content Expertise
A. Working on an advanced degree/post doc
B. Attendance or leadership at discipline-specific conferences
C. Mentoring students in research projects; chairing or serving on thesis/dissertation committee
Instructional Design
D. Course/curriculum revision development
E. Use of innovative technology
F. Facilitating best practice discussion with other faculty
Instructional Delivery
G. Student evaluations of teaching
H. Peer evaluation of your classroom teaching
I. Peer evaluation of your teaching materials J. Mid-course improvements to address student problems or after attending a teaching
workshop
Student Engagement
K. Collaborative research projects or mentoring activities
L. Developmental advising
M. Service-learning or study abroad projects
51
NAME
DATE
SELF EVALUATION FORM CHECKLIST
Scholarship
(See Faculty Handbook Chapter 5)
Please review Chapter 5 on Guidelines and Principles for Determining Minimal Scholarship Expectations
for Promotion and Tenure and then circle items on the next page which show scholarship activities in which
you have engaged. Attach a narrative that clearly explains why you consider an activity should be evaluated
at a certain level and reference supplementary discipline criteria approved by your department and
college/school.
Scholarship Activity Checklist Guidelines Name Senior Instructor: Total 8 (from any level) Associate (last 4 yrs): 2 Level-3s(= 6 pts) 1 L-2(=2) 8 L-1s(=8) Total 16 Adjustments**
Tenure (last 5 yrs): 2 Level-3s(= 6 pts) 1 L-2(=2) 8 L-1s(=8) Total 16 Adjustments** Full*: 3 Level-3s(= 9 pts) 1 L-2(=2) 12 L-1s(=12) Total 23 Adjustments**
*(at least 5 yrs since promotion to associate) **(E.g., an extra L-3 could count for 3 L-1s in reaching the needed total # of pts; but L-1s and 2s cannot add up to a substitute for a L-3.)
Year
Category Level 3 (3 points) (Peer Reviewed)
Level 2 (2 points) (Peer Reviewed)
Level 1 (1 point) (Non-Peer &Peer Reviewed [PR])
Publications/Productions Monograph or book published or officially accepted
A book/monograph chapter may equal a paper
published
Paper published or accepted
Paper published in conf. proceedings
Editor of book or journal
Creative performance in music or theater
Exhibit/production in the arts
Learning aids published
Web-based presentations/publications
Revisions to book Anything in level 3 not peer reviewed
Abstract published [PR]
Book review published [PR]
Encyclopedia entry published [PR]
Editorial in discipline published
Manuscript submitted for publication
Clinical guidelines or critical pathways published
In-house publication/performance/creative work
Creative work submitted for exhibit [PR]
Column published in professional journal
Presentations Podium or poster presentation at
state/regional/national/international professional
org. meeting
Research/scholarship at other institutions, industry
or government that contribute to the field
Contribution to state and regional accreditation
meeting
Corporate sponsored presentation that contains
original scholarship
Anything from Level 2 not peer reviewed
Presentation/poster at local or UIW meeting
Organizing/chairing/on panel in sessions at
professional meeting
Grants External grant proposal accepted for funding Anything in level 3 not peer reviewed
Internal research/scholarship grant proposal
accepted for funding
Submission of external grant proposal
External reports on grant activities
Application/Practice External reports related to conducting contract
research, consultation, technical assistance, policy
analysis, external program evaluation, compiling and
analyzing client or health service outcomes, meta-
analysis related to practice problems, clinical
demonstration projects, compiling and analyzing
student results, etc.
Development/organization/delivery of workshops/
seminars/symposia for professionals at national level
Products for sale, patents, license copyrights
Contribution to licensing or certification exams for
professionals in the field
Development of professional certification and
accreditations
Development/organization/delivery of
workshops/seminars/symposia for professionals at a
regional/state level
Authorship of accreditation or other internal
comprehensive program reports
Selected as consultant to organizations related to
one’s discipline (no report done for review)
Written reviews of manuscripts, abstracts or
proposals
Development/organization/delivery of
workshops/seminars/symposia for professionals
at a local level
52
53
NAME
DATE
SELF EVALUATION FORM CHECKLIST
University and Community Service
(Based on the Faculty Handbook, Chapter 5)
Please check those areas in which you have demonstrated activity. Attach a one-to-two page description
of what these specific activities include.
University
A. Active participation in university committees
B. Program chair/coordinator/director
C. Administration of a grant
D. Mentoring colleagues to the institution
E. Sponsor of a student organization
F. Recruitment, or securing scholarships or funds
G. Assisting in university activities such as orientation, Incarnate Word Day, fairs, etc.
H. Self-initiated contributions to discipline, college/school growth
I. Overloads and non-paid independent studies in time of need
J. Promoting the spirit or Mission of the university
K. Tutoring students
L. Conducting peer evaluations, participating in discipline/program group evaluations
Community
M. Participation in a community organization
N. Lectures, addresses, publications, or other creative contributions to a general audience on a
topic in one’s professional area of competency
O. Organization of workshops/seminars/symposia for a general audience and related to one’s
professional interests
P. Civic achievements or recognition for one’s professional interests
Other discipline criteria approved by the college/school
54
NAME
DATE
SELF EVALUATION FORM CHECKLIST
Professional Activities
(Based on the Faculty Handbook, Chapter 5)
Please check those areas in which you have demonstrated activity. Attach a one-to-two page description
of what these specific activities include.
Participation in a Professional Organization (note whether local, regional, national, international)
A. Membership in a professional organization
B. Attendance at meetings
C. Election to office or other committee responsibility
D. Panelist, chairperson, or commentator for sessions at annual meeting
E. Recognition for academic and/or professional achievement
Faculty Development
F. Participation in workshops, seminars, and symposia in areas of professional competence G. Primary author of faculty development plan (e.g., a proposal for a series of workshops for
faculty on teaching, testing, etc.)
H. Certification in clinical/practice area
I. Continuation of academic studies or postdoctoral work
Other Activities
J. Book review
K. Referee for a professional journal
L. Professional practice
M. Coordinates/conducts continuing education for community professionals
N. Consultant to community organization
Other discipline criteria approved by the college/school
55
Administrators with Faculty Status
Normally, administrators are not considered full-time teaching faculty and, therefore, not affected by the
policies in this Faculty Handbook. However, it is not uncommon that certain individuals perform both
administrative and faculty service at the University of the Incarnate Word. Such persons may be appointed
either with or without eligibility for promotion in the awarding of academic rank and faculty tenure, and
with either full or limited faculty status, as defined in this chapter. The president, provost, the dean of library
services if holding the rank of assistant professor or above, the dean of the school of graduate studies and
research, college/school deans, and other designated administrators have full faculty status with respect to
eligibility for promotion and tenure.
Since academic rank involves recognition of a person's qualifications to function as a teaching officer of
the university, persons who have held faculty rank at the university and who are appointed to administrative
or library positions shall retain their rank but will be appointed with either full or limited faculty status.
Persons without prior faculty status at the university who are appointed to administrative positions which
require some teaching may or may not be awarded full faculty status at the discretion of the provost in
consultation with the Rank and Tenure Committee, subject to the provisions of the section on appointment
in this chapter. Such determination will be made at the time of initial appointment.
Administrators with full faculty status and who are eligible for promotion in rank and the granting of faculty
tenure shall be evaluated for such purposes on their teaching and scholarship, their educational preparation
and advancement, and their administrative service. Standards for promotion and tenure established for
regular full-time faculty shall apply. The years of service in administration may fulfill the requirements of
time in teaching, if such service is an integral part of the academic process. Otherwise, the time requirements
may be extended to allow adequate evaluation of the person as a faculty member.
A general definition of “integral part of the academic process” is sustained substantial activity that supports
the essential faculty functions of teaching, curriculum development, and research. Such activity may
include: supervision/evaluation of faculty (FT or PT); involvement in curriculum
development/implementation (responsibility for overseeing or facilitation/coordination of
development/implementation); supervision/instruction related to faculty development; assistance with
research methodology and technology; and supervising educational assessment.
The burden is on the administrator to make the case for his/her work as integral. Other relevant information
is whether UIW has an existing program(s) or home base from which to evaluate the person’s prior faculty
work and then a possible place for such a person after leaving administration.
Normally, there are two paths to tenure for faculty/administrators who come to the university to be academic
administrators.
1) Faculty who come to the university to be academic administrators after a term of probationary
teaching service in one or more other institutions, or successful full-time teaching not on the tenure
track, may, if agreed to in writing, receive credit for up to three years of prior service, complete
two more years of full-time administrative service at the university (to equal 5 years of service), be
reviewed the following year, and, if approved by the Board in March, then receive a contract with
tenure for the seventh year;
2) Faculty or administrators who come to the university to be academic administrators and who
were tenured at another institution may be reviewed at the earliest in the fall semester of their
56
second year of administrative service at the university, and, if approved by the Board in March,
receive a contract with tenure for their third year.
Administrators who are awarded faculty tenure shall enjoy the privileges and protections of tenure only in
their capacities as faculty members, not in their capacities as administrators. Administrative appointments
are continued at the pleasure of the president (or in the case of the president, at the pleasure of the Board of
Trustees), and are subject to termination at any time with 30 days notice. Administrators with tenure who
wish to assume or return to full-time teaching will be offered positions if there is a need for their teaching
services not adequately met by other tenured faculty members senior to them in years of service to the
university.
Administrators who are awarded promotion in academic rank shall enjoy the honors and privileges of the
higher rank only in their capacities as faculty members. Promotion in academic rank shall not imply any
change in administrative responsibilities or in compensation for administrative services.
Guidelines for Academic Administrators Seeking Tenure
(Approved by VPASA, 10/10/07)
Application materials are to be assembled in the following order:
1. Administrative Experience Narrative (see below).
2. Current Vita.
3. Letters of Recommendation (see below).
4. College/school Faculty Recommendation (see below).
5. Dean Recommendation (see below). 6. Self-Evaluation Checklist Forms and Summary Narratives for: Instructional Activities (do include any
current teaching and at previous institutions), Scholarship, University and Community Service, and
Professional Activities. The Rank and Tenure Committee will review an individual’s career from the
point of receiving the rank of assistant professor to the present.
7. Documentation for the four categories above.
Administrative Experience Narrative
a. Include current job title and describe duties and responsibilities that are “an integral part of the
academic process”, and any part-time teaching.
b. Describe administrative duties and responsibilities at previous institutions.
c. Summarize that part of your scholarship that could be called scholarship of administration (a
subheading under scholarship of application according to Ernest L. Boyer—Scholarship Revisited,
1990, p. 37; reference to the Scholarship of Administration is not explicitly spelled out in the
Faculty Handbook but is implied in the Boyer model which is in the Handbook).
1) Definition of Scholarship of Administration: activities that require applying current
professional knowledge and creativity to consequential administrative problems or new
situations.
2) Criteria (based on Boyer): a) The importance and visibility of the activity to the teaching and learning environment of
the university;
b) The research and strategic planning necessary for the successful implementation of major
academic initiatives;
c) The writing and communication inherent in any successful academic initiative;
57
d) Peer review and evaluation necessary so that faculty and administrators understand and
commit to the usefulness and appropriateness of academic policies, changes or initiatives.
3) Examples of Scholarship of Administration: activities related to accreditation, certification of
program or school, grants, curriculum or program development, or other substantive projects
related to the academic process.
d. Explain why you believe you are a strong institutional fit with UIW.
Letters of Recommendation
Solicited letters of recommendation should be limited to five. The letters all together should speak to
the four categories: instruction, scholarship, university and community service, and professional
activities. Fit should also be addressed. Some but not all letters may relate to experience at previous
institutions or have been solicited for application for an administrative position at UIW. Such letters
should be less than five years old with current phone contact information also provided. Those
candidates in dean-related positions may solicit UIW letters from other deans or faculty in other
college/schools but not from faculty they supervise in any capacity.
College/School Faculty Recommendation
a. Tenured faculty (or faculty with rank of Associate or Full Professor in schools without tenure) in
the college/school where the teaching discipline of the administrator is housed will be consulted
for a recommendation, which is current operating procedure.
b. In the case of a new school that does not yet have tenured faculty, the provost may ask the dean a)
to ask a senior professor (associate or full) to call a meeting of all associate and full professors in
the new school to give a recommendation, or b) the provost may ask the dean(s) with disciplines
most closely related to that of the administrator to ask a senior tenured faculty to call a meeting of
faculty with tenure and/or multi-year renewable-term appointments from those disciplines to give
a recommendation if possible.
In both situations the recommendations are forwarded directly to the chair of the Rank and Tenure
Committee, as required by the Faculty Handbook.
Dean Recommendation
1. Associate and assistant deans submit their portfolio to their dean and the dean reviews and prepares
a letter of recommendation and sends it to the chair of rank and tenure with a copy to the candidate.
Then the candidate delivers the portfolio to the chair of rank and tenure.
2. Deans do not request letters of recommendation from the provost but send their portfolios directly
to the chair of the Rank and Tenure Committee.
58
Non-Reappointment of Probationary Faculty or Faculty Not on the Tenure Track
A. Probationary faculty are full-time faculty appointed to the tenure track. Non-reappointment or
non-renewal is the decision not to offer a further contract of employment prior to
tenure/promotion to associate professor, or not to award tenure/promotion itself; it is not a form
of dismissal. Non-reappointment does not involve bringing charges nor is it dismissal for "cause".
It involves the application of the criteria and standards stated above, leading to a judgment that it
is not desirable for the institution to offer another term appointment or to confer academic
tenure/promotion. At the University of the Incarnate Word, however, the reasons for non-
reappointment, whether for probationary faculty or faculty not on the tenure track, must meet the
following tests:
1. They must not violate the faculty member's academic freedom or punish the faculty member for exercising academic freedom, either in the performance of duties or outside the institution, provided reasonable means were taken to disassociate one's personal views from those of the institution.
2. They must not violate the faculty member's constitutional rights or punish the faculty member for exercising them.
3. They must not be arbitrary or capricious.
4. They must represent the deliberate exercise of professional judgment in the particular institutional circumstances.
5. They must follow a probationary period during which the college/school dean has evaluated the faculty member and provided him/her with appropriate feedback and opportunity for improvement.
B. Written notice that a probationary appointment is not to be renewed will be given the faculty member in advance of the expiration of the appointment. Whether on a 12 or 9-month contract, the university will normally notify faculty members of the terms and conditions of their renewals in a timely fashion before the contract expires:
1. No less than three months notice before the end of the first full year of contract service (normally March 1) if the contract will not be renewed for a second year. If hired at some time effective other than June 1 or August 15, see note below;
2. No less than six months notice before the end of the second full year of contract service
(normally December 15 of year 2) if the contract will not be renewed for a third year;
3. No less than twelve months notice before the end of the third full year of contract service (normally May 31 of year 2) if the contract will not be renewed for a fourth year.
C. Written notice that a non-tenure track appointment is not to be renewed will be given the faculty member in advance of the expiration of the appointment. Whether on a 12 or 9-month contract, the university will normally notify faculty members of the terms and conditions of their renewals in a
timely fashion before the contract expires:
59
1. No less than three months notice before the end of the first full year of contract service
(normally March 1) if the contract will not be renewed for a second year. If hired at some time
effective other than June 1 or August 15, see note below;
2. No less than six months notice before the end of the second or subsequent full year of contract
service (normally December 15 of that year) if the contract will not be renewed for another
year.
3. No less than one year for faculty who have taught more than five years.
Note: When the first contract is effective on a date other than June 1 or August 15, for example
January 15, notice of nonrenewal in the above cases is based on that alternative beginning date and
is so stated in the first and subsequent contracts. Consequently, in the case of a January 15
beginning date of service, notice in the first year by October 15 would result in the cancellation of
the contract effective January 14; in the second year, notice could be given by July 15; notice could
be given by January 15 in the third year of service for cancellation of the contract by January 15 of
what would have been the beginning of the fourth year of service.
D. When a decision not to renew a probationary appointment has been reached, the dean will inform
the faculty member involved of that decision verbally and in writing. Upon request, the dean will
advise the faculty member verbally of the reasons that contributed to the decision by the dean. If
the faculty member so requests, the reasons given in explanation of the non-renewal will be
confirmed in writing by the provost.
E. Supplements for schools may include procedures unique to their circumstances as long as those
additional procedures do not deny rights articulated in the university Faculty Handbook and assure due process.
Non-Tenure Track Non-Reappointment Appeal Process
Within 30 days of receiving written notice of non-reappointment, a faculty member who is not on
the tenure-track may request reconsideration by the university through an appeal to the provost for
decisions allegedly based on inadequate consideration or reasons that violate academic freedom.
The faculty member will present a written complaint to the provost stating the reasons for
requesting a review of the decision. The provost will, if the appeal is considered warranted, convene
an ad hoc committee of up to four faculty and/or administrators familiar with the issues of non-
tenure track faculty to review the decision and procedure used to make the decision not to reappoint
the faculty member. This committee will make its recommendations to the provost, after
interviewing the relevant parties to the decision and any relevant documentation. The provost will
notify the faculty member of the final determination of the appeal. No further review at the
university is available.
Tenure Track and Denial of Recommendation for Promotion Appeal Process
The following procedures apply to cases of appeal concerning non-reappointment, denial of
recommendation for tenure/promotion, or for full professor.
Inadequate Consideration or Violation of Academic Freedom
60
Within 30 days of receiving this written notice, the faculty member may request reconsideration by
the university through the Grievance Committee for decisions allegedly based on inadequate
consideration or reasons that violate academic freedom. The faculty member will present a written
complaint to the Faculty Senate president who convenes the Grievance Committee and notifies the
provost that a grievance is underway.
Insofar as the faculty member alleges that the decision against renewal of contract was based on 1) inadequate consideration or 2) reasons which violate academic freedom, the Grievance
Committee will hold a hearing to review the faculty member's allegation. The faculty member
making the allegation is responsible for stating the ground upon which the allegation is based, and
the burden of proof shall rest upon the faculty member.
1. The Grievance Committee will determine whether the decision was the result of adequate
consideration in terms of the common practice of the university. The Grievance Committee
will not substitute its judgments for that of the appropriate faculty committee or individual.
If the Grievance Committee believes that adequate consideration was not given to the
faculty member's qualifications, it will recommend in writing to the provost
reconsideration by the Rank and Tenure Committee, college/school committee or dean
making the initial recommendation, indicating the respect in which it believes the
consideration may have been inadequate. The provost will consider the findings of the
Grievance Committee and may forward a request for reconsideration to the Rank and
Tenure Committee, college/school committee or dean and receives their response in
writing. The provost reviews the response and communicates a final decision to the
faculty member in writing. No further appeal at the university is available.
2. If the Grievance Committee concludes that a prima facie case for violation of academic
freedom has been established, it will conduct hearings to determine whether the decision
not to reappoint was adequately based on the reasons given. The Grievance Committee will
communicate findings in writing to the faculty member, to the college/school committee
or dean making the recommendation, and to the provost. The provost reviews the
Grievance Committee report of findings and communicates a final decision to the faculty
member in writing. No further appeal at the university is available.
Sexual Harassment, National Origin Harassment, and Other Forms of Prohibited Behavior
Within 30 days of receiving the written notice, the faculty member, whether probationary or non- tenure
track, may request reconsideration by the university by contacting the Office of Human Resources, and not
the Grievance Committee, insofar as the faculty member alleges that the decision against renewal of contract
was due to harassment, bias or prejudice on the basis of an individual’s race, color, national origin, citizenship
status, creed, religion, religious affiliation, age, sex, marital status, sexual orientation, gender identity,
disability, veteran status, or any other protected status under applicable law. The Office of Human Resources
will investigate the matter and make a final determination and notify the faculty member and the provost in
writing. Based on this determination, the provost and the director of Human Resources will decide whether
the university will take further action or not regarding non-reappointment and communicate a final decision
to the faculty member in writing. This decision regarding non- reappointment is final and no further appeal
at the university is possible.
Termination of Appointment by the Faculty Member
A faculty member may terminate an appointment effective at the end of an academic year, provided notice
is given in writing at the earliest possible opportunity, but not later than May 15, or 30 days after receiving
61
notification of the terms of his/her appointment for the coming year, whichever date occurs later. The
faculty member may properly request a waiver of this requirement of notice in the case of personal necessity
or opportunity for substantial professional advancement, but the university is not obligated to grant the
waiver.
Termination of Appointments by the University
Termination of an appointment with continuous tenure, or of a probationary or special appointment before
the end of the specified term, may be effected by the institution for adequate cause. Forms of adequate
cause include dismissal for cause, physical or mental disability, financial exigency, program or department
discontinuance or reduction not mandated by financial exigency.
Dismissal for Adequate Cause
1. Definition
Adequate cause for dismissal will be related, directly and substantially, to the performance of faculty
members in their professional capacities as teachers or researchers and is defined as:
a. Demonstrable incompetence or dishonesty in teaching or research, or
b. Personal conduct which substantially impairs the faculty member’s fulfillment of his/her
institutional responsibilities, or
c. Substantial neglect of faculty duties and responsibilities. (For what may lead to a
determination of substantial neglect, see Unsatisfactory Performance.
2. Procedure
a. Informal Efforts to Resolve Difficulties
Termination for cause will be preceded by discussions between the faculty member and appropriate
administrative officers looking toward a mutual settlement
b. Charges
If the informal efforts described in the preceding paragraph fail to resolve the difficulty, the provost
shall provide the faculty member a written intention to terminate, along with a statement of the
charge or charges, expressed with reasonable particularity, upon which the decision to terminate is
based.
c. Hearings
Within 30 days of receiving this written intention to terminate, the faculty member may request a review
of the case by the Grievance Committee. The faculty member will present a written complaint to the
Faculty Senate president who convenes the Committee and notifies the provost that a grievance is
underway. In this situation, the Faculty Grievance Committee is chaired by the president of the Faculty
Senate who does not have a right to vote. Members of the Grievance Committee deeming themselves
disqualified for bias or interest shall remove themselves from the case, either at the request of the
provost or the complainant or on their own initiative. The provost and the complainant being charged
shall each have the opportunity to remove, without stated cause, any two members of the committee. In
any case, where an elected member of the committee is removed from participation, the chairperson
62
may appoint a replacement, giving consideration to any of the five faculty members who received the
next highest number of votes in the last election. At least five faculty shall hear each case. The vice-
president of the Faculty Senate is responsible for keeping the results of the original vote.
d. Suspension During Hearings
Pending a final decision by the Grievance Committee, the faculty member will be suspended or assigned
to other duties in lieu of suspension, only if immediate harm to himself/herself or others is threatened
by his/her continuance. Before suspending a faculty member, pending an ultimate determination of
his/her status through the university's hearing procedures, the provost and dean will consult with the
chair of the Grievance Committee concerning the propriety, the length, and the other conditions of the
suspension. Salary will continue during the period of suspension.
e. Pre-Hearing Meetings
The Grievance Committee may, with the consent of the parties concerned, hold joint pre-hearing
meetings with the parties in order to (1) simplify the issues, (2) effect stipulations of facts, (3) provide
for the exchange of documentary or other information, and (4) achieve such other appropriate pre-
hearing objectives as will make the hearing fair, effective, and expeditious.
f. Notice of Hearing and Waiver of Hearing
Service of notice of hearing with specific charges in writing will be made at least twenty days prior to
the hearing. The faculty member may waive a hearing or respond to the charges in writing at any time
before the hearing. If the faculty member waives a hearing, but denies the charge against him/her or
asserts that the charges do not support a finding of adequate cause, the Grievance Committee will
evaluate all available evidence and rest its recommendation upon the evidence in the record.
g. Privacy of Hearing
The Grievance Committee, in consultation with the provost and the faculty member, will exercise its
judgment as to whether the hearing should be public or private.
h. Counsel
During the proceedings the faculty member may invite a UIW faculty member to be present for support
and advice.
i. Record of Hearings
A taped record of the hearing or hearings will be taken and will be made available to the faculty member
without cost. If a typewritten copy is requested, it will be made available to the faculty member at cost.
j. Burden of Proof
The burden of proof that adequate cause exists rests with the institution and shall be satisfied only by
clear and convincing evidence in the record considered as a whole.
k. Adjournments
The Grievance Committee will grant adjournments to enable either party to investigate evidence as to
63
which a valid claim of surprise is made.
l. Witnesses and Other Evidence
The faculty member will be afforded an opportunity to obtain necessary witnesses and documentary or
other evidence. The administration will cooperate with the Grievance Committee in securing witnesses
and making available documentary and other evidence.
m. Cross-Examination of Witnesses
The faculty member and the administration will have the right to confront and cross-examine all
witnesses. Where the witnesses cannot or will not appear, but the Grievance Committee determines that
the interests of justice require admission of their statements, the Committee will identify the witnesses,
disclose their statements, and if possible provide for formal questions or inquiries.
n. Charges of Incompetence
In the hearing of charges of incompetence, the testimony shall include that of qualified faculty members
from this or other institutions of higher education.
o. Rules of Evidence
The Grievance Committee will not be bound by strict rules of legal evidence, and may admit any
evidence that is of probative value in determining the issues involved. Every possible effort will be
made to obtain the most reliable information available.
p. Basis for Decision
The findings of fact and the decision will be based solely on the hearing record.
q. Public Statements
Except for such simple announcements as may be required, covering the time of the hearing and similar
matters, public statements and publicity about the case by either the faculty member or administrative
officers will be avoided so far as possible until the proceedings have been completed, including
consideration by the Board of Trustees.
r. Report of the Committee
The provost and the faculty member will be notified of the decision in writing and will be given a copy
of the record of the hearing.
If the Grievance Committee concludes that adequate cause for dismissal has been established it reports
this to the provost. If the committee determines that an academic penalty less than dismissal would be
more appropriate, it will so recommend to the provost, with supporting reasons. If the Grievance
Committee concludes that the evidence has not established adequate cause for dismissal in the record,
it will so report to the provost. If the provost rejects the report, he/she will state his/her reasons for
doing so in writing to the Grievance Committee and to the faculty member, and provide an opportunity
for response before transmitting the case to the president.
s. Action by the Board of Trustees
64
If dismissal or other severe sanction is recommended, the provost will, on request of the faculty
member, transmit to the president who forwards to the Board of Trustees the record of the case.
The Board of Trustees review will be based on the record of the committee hearing, and it will
provide opportunity for argument, oral or written or both, by the principals at the hearings or by
their representatives. The decision of the Grievance Committee will either be sustained, or the
proceeding returned to the committee with specific objections. The committee will then reconsider,
taking into account the stated objections and receiving new evidence if necessary. The Board of
Trustees will make a final decision only after study of the committee's reconsideration.
t. Procedures for Imposition of Sanctions other than Dismissal
If the administration believes that the conduct of the faculty member, although not constituting
adequate cause for dismissal, is sufficiently grave to justify the imposition of a severe sanction,
such as suspension from service for a stated period, the administration may institute a proceeding
to impose such a severe sanction; the procedures outlined in Section A. 2. above shall govern such
a proceeding.
If the administration believes that the conduct of a faculty member justifies imposition of a minor
sanction, such as reprimand, it shall notify the faculty member of the basis of the proposed sanction
and provide him/her with an opportunity to persuade the administration that the proposed sanction
should not be imposed. A faculty member who believes that a major sanction has been incorrectly
imposed, may petition the Grievance Committee for such action as may be appropriate.
u. Terminal Salary or Notice
If the appointment is terminated, the faculty member will receive salary or notice in accordance
with the following schedule: at least three months, if the final decision is reached by March 1 (or
three months prior to the expiration) of the first year of probationary service; at least six months, if
the decision is reached by December 15 of the second year (or after nine months but prior to
eighteen months) of probationary service; at least one year, if the decision is reached after eighteen
months of probationary service or if the faculty member has tenure. The provision for terminal
notice or salary need not apply in the event that there has been a finding that the conduct that
justified dismissal involved moral turpitude.
On the recommendation of the Grievance Committee or the president, the Board of Trustees, in
determining what, if any, payments will be made beyond the effective date of dismissal, may take
into account the length and quality of service of the faculty member.
Termination Because of Physical or Mental Disability
Termination of an appointment with tenure or a probationary or provisional or special appointment before
the end of the period of appointment, because of physical or mental disability, will be based upon clear and
convincing medical evidence that the faculty member, even with reasonable accommodation, is no longer
able to perform the essential duties of the position. The decision to terminate will be reached only
65
after there has been appropriate consultation and after the faculty member concerned, or someone
representing the faculty member, has been informed of the basis of the proposed action and has been
afforded an opportunity to present the faculty member's position and to respond to the evidence. If the
faculty member so requests, the evidence will be reviewed by the Grievance Committee before a final
decision is made by the Board of Trustees on the recommendation of the president. The faculty member
will be given severance salary not less than as prescribed for dismissal for adequate cause (see Section u.
above).
Termination Because of Financial Exigency
1. Definition
"Financial exigency" shall refer to the imminent financial crisis which threatens the survival of the
institution as a whole and which cannot be alleviated by less drastic means than terminations of
appointments.
2. Procedure
a. Declaration of Condition
Prior to a final determination of financial exigency, the president shall meet with the Faculty Senate
and the faculty as a whole to discuss the current financial situation. Then the final judgment that a
state of financial exigency exists shall be made by the president, who shall then direct the executive
administrators to prepare proposals for specified budget adjustments designed to avoid financial
damage to the university.
b. Designation of Faculty Members to Be Terminated
If the provost’s proposals include the termination of any appointments with tenure, or a
probationary appointment, or special appointment before the end of its specified term, he/she shall
first consult with the Faculty Senate before developing a final proposal on which appointments are
to be terminated. The Faculty Senate reports shall comment upon:
(1) the existence and extent of the condition of financial exigency,
(2) whether all feasible alternatives to termination of appointments have been pursued, (3) where within the overall academic program of the university termination of appointments
may occur, and
(4) the services that must be discontinued or reduced if proposed terminations of
appointments are made.
c. Notification
If the president approves the provost’s proposal, the president shall issue notice to the particular
faculty of the intention to terminate their appointments because of financial exigency in accordance
with the guidelines specified under Section A. 2.
d. Appeal
Faculty members notified of termination will have the right to a full hearing before the Grievance
Committee as described in Section A. 2. The issues in this hearing may include:
66
1) The existence and extent of the condition of financial exigency. The burden will rest on the
administration to prove the existence and extent of the condition. The findings of the
Faculty Senate in a previous proceeding involving the same issues may be introduced.
2) The validity of the educational judgments and the criteria for identification for termination;
but the recommendations of the Faculty Senate on these matters will be considered
presumptively valid.
3) Whether the criteria are being properly applied in the individual case.
e. Restrictions on New Appointment; Rights of Tenured Faculty over Non-Tenured Faculty
If the institution, because of financial exigency, terminates appointments, it will not at the same
time make new appointments except in extraordinary circumstances where a serious distortion in
the academic program would otherwise result. The appointment of a faculty member with tenure
will not be terminated in favor of retaining a faculty member without tenure, except in extraordinary
circumstances where a serious distortion of the academic program would otherwise result.
f. Rights to Re-assignment
Before terminating an appointment because of financial exigency, the university may, at its own
discretion, make an effort to place the faculty member concerned in another available university
position for which the faculty member is qualified and, where possible, without loss of salary or
financial benefits.
g. Rights to Notice and Severance Salary
In all cases of termination of appointment because of financial exigency, the faculty member
concerned will be given notice or severance salary not less than as prescribed in Section u.
h. Rights of Reappointment
If the university terminates appointments because of financial exigency, the terminated faculty
member's position will not be filled by a replacement within three years, unless the terminated
faculty member has been offered reappointment and a fifteen-day period within which to accept or
decline it.
Termination Because of Program or Department Discontinuance or Reduction Not Mandated by Financial
Exigency
1. Definition
The term "program" shall refer to: (1) a degree, a major, or a minor, a discipline, or an endorsement
or certification specialty; (2) any research or training project supported by a grant, a contract, or
gift from a government agency, a foundation, a corporation, or a private individual.
A decision to discontinue or reduce a program must be based essentially upon educational
considerations determined primarily by an appropriate committee of the faculty as described in
2.a. below. Educational considerations must reflect long-range judgments that the educational
mission of the institution as a whole will be enhanced by the discontinuance. As such,
67
educational considerations do not include cyclical or temporary variations in enrollment.
Educational considerations may include but are not limited to long-term declines in enrollment such
that the enrollment in courses within the program falls below a number reasonably judged necessary
to warrant offering enough courses to constitute full-time teaching loads for all the tenured faculty
qualified to teach in that program.
In the case of a program supported by funds from a grant, contract, or gift, cessation of funding
shall constitute sufficient cause to discontinue the program. However, in dealing with tenured
faculty associated with such a program, it must be remembered that tenure is held with the
institution and not in one's program or specialty. The university's obligation is not discharged unless
it has considered placing the displaced faculty member in other programs within the university.
2. Procedure
a. Declaration of Condition
The provost shall make the initial judgment that the need to discontinue or reduce a program exists
or is imminent. The provost shall first confer with all faculty qualified to teach in that program and
with the dean of the college/school in which the program is housed, in an effort to develop mutually
acceptable alternatives to termination of tenured faculty.
b. Affirmation of Condition
Failing to develop such alternatives, the provost shall report his/her judgment, along with
supporting data and a recommendation as to the amount of staff reduction necessary to the Faculty
Senate. The Faculty Senate may agree with the recommendation or suggest an alternative course
of action. The provost recommendation and that of the Faculty Senate will be forwarded to the
president by the provost. The president may request the Faculty Senate to develop a proposal for
staff reduction to the extent the president shall stipulate.
c. Designation of Faculty Members to Be Terminated
The Faculty Senate shall recommend to the provost which faculty members shall be terminated or
reduced to part-time, taking into account only the following considerations: (1) the relative
qualifications of respective faculty members to teach the courses necessary to the program, and
(2) the relative seniority of respective faculty members in terms of the following and in the
following order of importance: tenure, years of service to the university, rank, years in rank. The
provost’s final recommendation for faculty to be terminated is sent to the president.
d. Notification
Upon receipt of a recommendation from the provost, the president shall notify whatever faculty
member(s) are to be terminated, along with the date of termination in accordance with guidelines
specified under Section A. 2.
e. Appeal
Upon receipt of notice of impending termination because of program discontinuance or reduction,
a faculty member shall be entitled at his/her request, to a hearing by the Grievance Committee in
the manner described above in Section A. 2. The issues in this hearing may include:
68
1) The existence and extent of the condition of insufficient need for services. The burden will
rest on the administration to prove the existence and extent of the condition. The findings of
the Faculty Senate in a previous proceeding involving the same issue may be introduced.
2) The validity of the educational judgments and the criteria for identification for termination;
but the recommendations of the Faculty Senate on these matters will be considered
presumptively valid.
3) Whether the criteria are being properly applied in the individual case.
f. Rights to Reappointment
If the university terminates appointments because of program discontinuance or reduction, the place
of the faculty member concerned will not be filled by a replacement within three years, unless the
released faculty member has been offered reinstatement and a fifteen-day period within which to
accept or decline it.
g. Rights to Reassignment
Before notice of intention to terminate an appointment because of program reduction or
discontinuance is issued to a faculty member, the university:
1) In the case of a non-tenured member, may, at its own discretion, make an effort to place
the faculty member concerned in another available position for which the faculty member
is qualified, but the university shall not be bound to make such an effort, and
2) In the case of a tenured member, the university shall be bound to make a reasonable effort
to place the faculty member concerned in another available position for which the faculty
member is qualified.
h. Terminal Salary or Notice
In all cases of termination of appointment because of insufficient need for services, the faculty
member concerned will be given notice or severance salary not less than as prescribed above in
Section u.
A. Review
In all cases of termination of appointment, the Board of Trustees will be available for ultimate review.
Leave Policies
Leaves of Absence
Leaves of absence are a means by which a full-time tenured faculty member's teaching effectiveness may
be enhanced, his/her scholarly usefulness enlarged, and the university's academic program strengthened
and developed.
69
The major purpose of granting leaves of absence is to provide to faculty the opportunity for continued
professional growth and new, or renewed, intellectual achievement through study, research, writing, and
travel. Occasionally, leaves are granted for projects of direct benefit to the institution and for public or
private service outside the university. Ordinarily, the university grants leaves of absence without pay for
periods of up to one year.
All evidence that the leave will increase individual effectiveness or produce academically or socially useful
results shall be considered in evaluating and approving applications.
Even though the faculty member on leave is expected to return to the university, should he/she resign while
on leave, he/she should give notice according to accepted standards (not later than May 15 or 30 days after
receiving notice of reappointment for the next year).
Requests for leaves of absence shall be made to the provost after consultation with the college/school dean.
The request will be forwarded to the president for action. The precise terms of the leave of absence shall be
in writing and shall be given to the faculty member prior to the commencement of the leave.
To avoid difficulty in adjustment of programs, faculty members should file all requests for leave not later
than December 20 of the preceding academic year, and by October 15 in the case of sabbatical leave.
9-Month Faculty Family and Medical Leave Policy
(Approved by the Board, 3/9/12)
This UIW Faculty Family and Medical Leave Policy applies to full-time faculty members who are on a
nine-month contract whose duties are primarily instructional and whose work hours may vary from day to
day with the academic calendar and with their individual teaching/advising/professional development
schedules. Further, this Policy applies to full-time faculty members during the effective dates of the 9-
month contract. Full-time professional school faculty members who are on a 12-month contract are
subject to the 12-month Professional School Faculty Leave Policy that follows the 9-month policy below.
Leave of Three Days or Less: Faculty members are not required to submit documentation of occasional
absences due to sickness or emergencies of three days or less. They are, however, expected to report their
absence to their dean and negotiate arrangements with their dean for coverage of their classes and other
duties when they are absent.
Extended Absence: It is UIW’s policy to work closely with full-time faculty members and their families
when qualifying Family and Medical Leave Act (FMLA) events occur. Helpful information about
FMLA, including descriptions of qualifying events may be found at:
http://www.dol.gov/whd/regs/compliance/posters/fmlaen.pdf. When serious illness or injury occurs, or for
other reasons as defined by the FMLA, requiring absence in excess of three days, faculty must contact the
UIW Office of Human Resources to determine eligibility for coverage under FMLA. When the leave is
foreseeable, thirty days advance notice of the need for leave and certification supporting the request is
required from faculty. If a faculty member is certified as eligible for FMLA benefits by the Office of
Human Resources, he or she is entitled to paid leave during the FMLA-approved leave according to the
following schedule:
Up to the equivalent of:
Less than 1 completed year of service No Paid Leave Benefit
1 to 2 completed years of full-time service fifteen days (three work weeks)
3 to 5 completed years of full-time service twenty days (four work weeks)
6 or more completed years of full-time service thirty days (six work weeks)
70
At the end of the paid leave period, if a faculty member requires additional leave, the remainder of the
leave will be unpaid and the time provided as paid leave will be applied against the maximum leave
entitlement available under FMLA. Faculty members shall not be paid or otherwise credited for unused
leave.
FMLA leave entitlement permits eligible employees to take up to 12 weeks of leave in a rolling 12 month
period measured backward from the date of any FMLA leave usage. FMLA also includes a special
military family leave entitlement that permits up to 26 weeks of leave to care for a covered service
member during a rolling 12 month period.
Personal Unpaid Leave: For situations that do not fall under the FMLA, faculty members may request an
unpaid leave of absence for up to thirty (30) calendar days. The request must be in writing and submitted
to the dean and approved by the provost.
Extension of Leave after FMLA-Approved Leave Ends: UIW will evaluate timely requests submitted by
an employee on an individual basis and grant reasonable extensions of leave in compliance with the
ADA, ADAAA and other applicable laws. (General information about the ADA and ADAAA may be
found at: http://www.ada.gov/.) If all of the above benefits are exhausted, the University of the Incarnate
Word is committed to working with the faculty member to assist in the transition to long-term disability
or to retirement.
12-month Professional School Faculty Leave Policy
(Approved by the Executive Council, 5/24/12)
This Leave Policy applies to full-time faculty members assigned to the Feik School of Pharmacy, the
Rosenberg School of Optometry, and the School of Physical Therapy, who are on a 12-month contract.
Planned Absences: When planned absences arise, such as Vacation Leave, the faculty members are
expected to report their scheduled absence in advance to their dean and negotiate arrangements with their
dean for coverage of their classes, or make up the absence with an alternative learning experience, or
other duties as assigned by the dean. In the case of an absence from a scheduled clinic, the director of the
clinic must also be notified in a timely manner.
Unplanned and/or Emergency Absences: Unplanned and/or emergency absences for which no advance
notice is feasible and where advance arrangements were not possible should be reported as soon as
practicable to the dean and/or the dean’s designee. In the case of an absence from a scheduled clinic, the
director of the clinic must also be notified as soon as practicable.
Absence in Excess of Three Days and the Family and Medical Leave Act: When serious illness or injury
occurs, or for other reasons as defined by the Family and Medical Leave Act (FMLA), requiring absence
in excess of three days, faculty must contact the UIW Office of Human Resources to determine eligibility
for coverage under FMLA. When the leave is foreseeable, thirty days advance notice of the need for
leave and certification supporting the request is required from faculty. FMLA leave entitlement permits
eligible employees to take up to 12 weeks of leave in a rolling 12 month period measured backward from
the date of any FMLA leave usage. FMLA also includes a special military family leave entitlement that
permits up to 26 weeks of leave to care for a covered service member during a rolling 12 month period.
Helpful information about FMLA, including descriptions of qualifying events may be found at:
http://www.dol.gov/whd/regs/compliance/posters/fmlaen.pdf.
Professional Development Leave: Faculty members are provided up to ten days of paid Professional
Development Leave per fiscal year to pursue professional interests outside of the university context that
71
are not otherwise being remunerated. Professional Development Leave may include, but is not limited to,
undertakings that will enhance professional traits and/or is in furtherance of the mission of the university
and the professional school, such as conferences, classes, special training opportunities, etc. Professional
Development Leave must but be requested in advance and must be approved by the department chair and
the dean. The department chair and dean will consider, among other factors, potential conflict with direct
service to the school such as school or university events, regular assignments, student interactions,
classroom teaching, or clinical rotations. If approved, appropriate coverage for these activities must be
arranged and approved in advance by the department chair. Professional Development Leave does not
accrue.
There are circumstances where faculty members may pursue an undertaking within the scope of the
professional context that provides remuneration. In such instances, while the Professional Development
Leave time may be approved, the dean maintains discretion in deciding whether the leave will be
Professional Development Leave or Vacation Leave. The dean will consider, among other factors, potential
conflict with direct service to the school, the amount of remuneration, and the goodwill to be gained by the
school.
Vacation Leave: Faculty members accrue 13.33 hours per month of paid vacation per fiscal year; the
equivalent of 160.00 hours or 20 days. However, a maximum of 40 hours (five days) may carry over from
year to year. Thus, faculty members will not accrue over 200 hours or five weeks at any time during the
fiscal year. For example, if a faculty member has 200 hours on May 31, then on June 1, his/her balance will
remain at 200 hours and the monthly accrual will not be added to the balance.
Faculty members are permitted to use (completely or incrementally) all allotted 160 vacation leave hours
at the start of each fiscal year (June 1). If the faculty member terminates employment during the fiscal year,
vacation leave earned will be compared with the vacation leave hours already used by the faculty member.
If the number of vacation leave hours earned exceeds the amount used, the faculty member will be paid
accordingly. If the number of vacation leave hours used exceeds the amount earned, an appropriate
deduction will be made to the faculty member's final paycheck.
Sick Leave: Faculty members are provided eight hours per month of sick leave. A maximum of up to 480
hours may accrue.
Holidays: Faculty members are provided the following UIW holidays (specific dates are published annually
by UIW Office of Human Resources), unless it is determined by the dean that it is not feasible for the
faculty member to take leave on the particular holiday. This may occur, for example, if a faculty member
is scheduled in a clinic that will have operating hours on the particular holiday. In such instance, the faculty
member will be provided an alternative date by the dean on which he/she may take the holiday leave.
U.S. Independence Day
Labor Day
Thanksgiving Day
Friday following Thanksgiving Day
Christmas Eve through New Year’s Day
Martin Luther King, Jr.
Good Friday
½ Day Battle of Flowers
Memorial Day
72
Sabbatical Leave
The University of the Incarnate Word, recognizing the necessity for full-time tenured faculty members to
acquire new experiences to enrich their teaching or professional competency, or to secure uninterrupted
time for research, writing, and creative activity, supports the principle of sabbatical leave. The university
desires to encourage professional growth and increased competence and productivity among faculty
members by subsidizing significant research, creative work, or a program which is judged to be of
equivalent value, such as some other program of study, an organized experiential program, or an exchange
in teaching responsibilities with a faculty member at another college or university. Sabbatical leave cannot
be used to work on a doctorate except in exceptional circumstances.
Eligibility
Full-time tenured faculty members are eligible to apply for sabbatical leave in their seventh year of
consecutive service at the university. If approved, the leave will be effective in the eighth year.
Consideration for subsequent sabbaticals can occur in the seventh year following the academic year in
which a sabbatical occurred.
Number of Leaves
Regardless of the length of the leave granted to an individual faculty member, the university will normally
grant sabbatical leaves in any given academic year to no more than three percent of the total full-time
teaching faculty.
Stipend
Stipends for sabbatical leaves are one semester at full salary or one academic year at one-half of full salary.
Normal raises and benefits will not be withheld by reason of the sabbatical leave. Moreover, while the
faculty member is on sabbatical leave, both he/she and the university will continue to pay their share toward
retirement, group life, health insurance, and social security.
Application Policies and Procedures
Sabbatical leaves are not granted automatically upon the completion of the necessary period of service. The
faculty member must demonstrate in writing, as part of his/her application, evidence of sound research,
creative activity, or other academic achievement to support the program of work which he/she plans for the
sabbatical period and indicate how this work will benefit the institution. He/she must show that the proposed
program will accomplish one or more of the general purposes set forth in the opening paragraph of this
section. It also must be evident that the proposed program will help meet the projected needs of the
university.
The faculty member must make a formal application for sabbatical leave by October 15 of the preceding
year using the application template on the next page.
The university will be expected to absorb all or part of the teaching load of the individual on leave; therefore,
the college/school dean, after consultation with the members of the discipline/program, will propose a plan
for meeting the staffing needs of the college/school during the sabbatical period.
The original and two copies of the application, the college/school dean's evaluation and recommendation,
and the statement of divisional plans referred to above will be submitted to the provost, who will forward
73
two copies of all the applications received to the chairperson of the Faculty Affairs Committee; the originals
will be retained by the provost.
Normally, within two weeks of receipt of the documents, the Faculty Affairs Committee will return one
copy of each application, together with its written recommendations, to the provost; the second copy will
be retained by the Committee for its use during the remainder of the process and for eventual forwarding
to the Committee on Rank and Tenure for inclusion in its confidential files.
In all cases, the Faculty Affairs Committee has the responsibility for rejecting any applications that do not
meet the criteria set forth in this section and of rank ordering the remainder in terms of precedence. In
general, the order of selection will be determined by the following priority: years of teaching at the
university, years since last sabbatical, and academic rank. However, the committee may, for good reasons
stated in writing, recommend one applicant over another in spite of seniority.
The provost, after consultation with the chairperson of the Faculty Affairs Committee and two other
members of the committee who are elected by the committee for this purpose, will make a final
recommendation to the president.
Faculty may not defer the timing of an awarded sabbatical or receive special consideration in the following
year’s review of applications. To be considered again, the faculty must re-apply for a sabbatical.
Obligations of Sabbatical Recipients
The recipient of a sabbatical leave incurs three obligations:
a. To make every reasonable effort to fulfill the terms of his/her sabbatical;
b. To return to the university for a minimum of three years following the completion of the
sabbatical leave;
c. To complete the “Faculty Award Reporting Form” (Appendix 5) and submit to the dean of graduate
studies and research at the beginning of the semester following the sabbatical leave. At the request
of the Faculty Affairs Committee, such reports may be made orally to a group of interested faculty
and students;
4. Not to defer the timing of the sabbatical. If a faculty member cannot take the sabbatical at the
time awarded, re-application should be made at the next available opportunity.
Additional Information
Time toward each new sabbatical begins immediately upon return to full-time service regardless of the
semester of return. Time on sabbatical leave counts toward promotion in rank and/or tenure, unless the
faculty member and the university agree in writing to waive this provision at the time the leave is granted.
Sabbatical Application Template
Name, college/school, rank, years since last sabbatical, time period of sabbatical
A. Purpose of the sabbatical
1. Describe the specific goals and anticipated outcomes of your sabbatical.
74
2. Provide a detailed description of your proposed program of work including a timeline to
accomplish your goals.
B. Preparation and Qualifications
1. Identify preliminary research, publications, training, and/or background that qualify you for this
work.
2. Describe any special circumstances that make this the appropriate time to begin this work.
C. Benefits
1. Describe how the sabbatical will help you acquire new experiences to enrich your teaching or
professional competency and/or to secure uninterrupted time for research, writing, or creative
activity.
2. Describe how this program of work will help meet the projected needs of the university.
3. Describe how this program of work will align with the mission and values of the university.
D. Impact
1. Describe what measures, if any, will need to be taken by your department, college/school should
you receive a sabbatical.
E. Other information specific to your proposal.
75
CHAPTER 5: FACULTY EVALUATION SYSTEM With Focus on the Annual Evaluation
(Approved by the Provost, 10/2012)
The Philosophy of Evaluation at the University of the Incarnate Word
The University of the Incarnate Word (UIW) is committed to a continuous improvement system of
performance for all members of the faculty, administration, and staff. The system's objectives include
challenging, realistic, measurable, and integrated review and development practices. Regular evaluations
of performance are essential for responsible and accountable actions aimed at continuous improvement of
a university employee’s performance and achievement of professional goals. Theoretically, this continuous
improvement process should lead to personal satisfaction and a higher degree of achievement of faculty
performance at the university.
A new faculty member is hired after a search process that includes consultation with faculty members in
and beyond the discipline, administrators, and members of the Office of Campus Mission and Ministry.
Given this process, it is assumed that when the university formally offers an employment contract to an
individual that he or she will succeed, and university resources are available for continuous improvement
in performance.
The deans have a central role to play in the process of evaluating faculty and overseeing mentoring for their
success. In certain cases, when approved by the provost, assistant deans or chairs may assist in the
evaluation process.
The voluntary mentoring program is one resource available to new faculty in preparing for evaluations. The
deans work with the coordinators of the First-Year Mentoring Program to identify seasoned faculty who
volunteer to assist new faculty in adjusting to the mission and culture of UIW, and to provide opportunities
for socializing with other new faculty and their mentors. For the second year, deans seek mentors, for
example, who will focus specifically on helping new faculty on the tenure track prepare for the third-year
evaluation as a bridge to successful application for promotion and tenure in the sixth year.
Reward and Pay Policy Statement
The University of the Incarnate Word’s compensation and benefits programs are aligned with the university
Mission, goals, and objectives. At the same time, these programs will recognize and affirm the dignity of
all employees, ensure equity, compare favorably with the marketplace, and enhance the university’s ability
to recruit and retain competent employees.
Policy
Annual increases to salary are based on performance achievement, equity adjustments when approved in
the yearly budget, and rewards for exceptional performance identified by the provost or president. There is
an additional increase for faculty approved for promotion in rank.
Process
In the fall, the president, provost and vice presidents develop the budget for the coming year to be approved
by the Board. This includes an amount that specifies a possible percentage of increase available for the
contracts of all employees. The president, provost and vice presidents decide how much is allotted for merit
awards for performance achievement and any equity. Faculty prepare their Faculty Self Inventories to be
submitted to their deans by the Friday after grades are due in December. In early January, the deans evaluate
faculty performance and recommend merit raises to the provost. If equity is budgeted, the provost and the
vice president for business and finance review the National Faculty Survey published by the College and
76
university Professional Association for Human Resources, and provide a summary report for the deans and
the Faculty Senate. The provost consults with the deans on any proposed equity adjustments and then
submits merit and equity recommendations to the president for final approval. After the Board meets in
March, faculty contracts are issued that reflect increases to faculty salaries. This will also include an
additional increase for those approved for promotion in rank.
The Faculty Evaluation System (FES)
This system is the strategy to achieve continuous improvement for a faculty member at the university. It
requires a partnership between faculty and administration for implementation and assessment. The FES
applies to pre-, post-, and non-tenure track full-time faculty. The FES enables a faculty member to set goals
for his/her professional career, and is guided by the objectives for the discipline, college/school, and the
university, in collaboration with the dean. It is a flexible system, responsive to new opportunities that may
emerge for both the faculty member and his/her discipline, college/school.
The Faculty Evaluation System consists of the following components:
Standards of Performance (general university and specific discipline, college/school standards)
Evaluations
Dean Evaluation of First-Year Faculty
Dean Annual Evaluation of Faculty
Third-Year Review of Tenure-Track Faculty
Promotion and Tenure Evaluation for Tenure-Track Faculty
Promotion Evaluation for Instructors
Reward and Pay Policy
Evaluation Materials
General Standards for Faculty Performance
Introduction
The objective of the university General Standards is to provide a current statement of duties and
responsibilities applicable to all university faculty. These standards should serve as a foundation for the
development of specific standards per rank, and per discipline in each college/school. The standards are
used as a guide when documenting faculty performance of duties and responsibilities.
The Mission of the University of the Incarnate Word has historically emphasized the education of the whole
person and the primary role of faculty as teacher. Other roles that involve research and service support and
extend the teaching function. Consequently UIW has always defined scholarship broadly and identifies
itself with the 4-part Boyer model. While faculty have been involved in the traditional scholarship of
discovery, more common are examples of the scholarship of teaching, integration, and application. As a
doctorate-granting university, UIW values a diversity of approaches to scholarship while maintaining its
historical focus on the scholarship of teaching. Productivity in the area of scholarship must be evaluated in
the context of the breadth of activities in which UIW faculty engage. Scholarly efforts at UIW are balanced
with a heavy teaching load and significant service obligation.
These standards for faculty performance also have to be flexible enough to accommodate the specialized
needs of disciplines, the university's growing expectations of faculty as they progress in rank, and the talents
and interests of individuals. Any standards developed with disciplines, college/schools grow out of these
General Standards and customize rather than supersede them. Standards of performance in externally
accredited programs must be in alignment with the accreditation body. For a given academic year, faculty
members are evaluated on the basis of performance standards approved by the end of the previous academic
77
year.
The following procedures must be observed in formulating and amending any discipline or college/school-
specific standards. 1. A working draft of the standards or amendments to the standards must be circulated
among faculty affected at least two weeks prior to discussion. 2. The standards or amendments must be
discussed at a meeting of the entire discipline, college/school. 3. To be adopted, the standards must be
approved by a majority of the full-time faculty in the discipline, college/school. 4. The new standards must
be publicly disseminated in the minutes of the discipline, college/school and to the Faculty Affairs
Committee (FAC). The FAC will review the standards or amendments for consistency with university
standards, and if no suggestions for revisions are made, they will be forwarded to Faculty Senate for
endorsement.
On an annual basis faculty members and deans agree on faculty goals in all areas for the upcoming year
(teaching, scholarship, service, professional activities), and identify the means to be used in evaluating
related activities. They will also consider workload distribution beyond the minimum guidelines for the
four areas: teaching (40%), scholarship (20%), service (15%), and professional activities (5%). Here is
one example of faculty using the discretionary 20%: more emphasis on teaching so it is weighted 50%
(instead of 40), and 25% on university and community service (instead of 15). Service and professional
activities would remain at 20% and 5%. Overall, faculty must show evidence of satisfactory competence
and growth in all four areas.
The information below also helps guide preparations for portfolios used in applications for promotion and
tenure. The following lists of standards and clarifications include teaching and scholarship checklist grids
to be used for the annual evaluation; a separate scholarship checklist for promotion and tenure review is
found in Chapter 4.
Teaching
1. Prepare course syllabi/outlines that define course objectives that are clear, realistic, measurable,
and achievable, and which identify important questions in the field of study.
2. Apply the necessary knowledge, skills, resources, and understanding of current scholarship in
order to achieve the course objectives.
3. Employ methods appropriate to course objectives and be able to modify procedures in response to
unforeseen change when necessary.
4. Utilize a suitable style and effective organization to communicate the course information with
clarity and integrity.
5. Create an environment that will enable the student to achieve the course objectives.
6. Critique his/her own work, using evaluations to improve the quality of future work.
7. Prepare, correct and return tests and assignments within a reasonable time.
8. Properly evaluate student achievement according to criteria communicated to students at the
beginning of each course.
9. Conduct respectful relationships with students both in and outside the classroom.
10. Advise assigned students (and others within their discipline when necessary) regarding degree
requirements, course sequencing, classroom performance, and registration.
11. Provide appropriate counsel to students regarding career opportunities, university policies,
campus interaction, etc.
12. Inform the library personnel of desired and necessary additions to the library resources.
13. Other requirements specific to the discipline, college/school.
78
Teaching Effectiveness: A Holistic Evaluation
(Approved by the Provost, 4/18/12)
Teaching at UIW: A Reflective Practice Teaching is the primary focus of the faculty role at University of the Incarnate Word and a significant
portion of the faculty workload. We believe that effective teaching is an evolving process that must be
supported through effective hiring, mentoring, and on-going faculty development. Included in faculty
development is the regular evaluation of teaching effectiveness. Evaluation of teaching effectiveness is a
complex activity that should not be reduced to a set of numbers. Checklists of behaviors, if used, are simply
examples of behaviors that might demonstrate effective teaching. Evaluation requires the input of many
individuals: the teacher, peers, students and alumni, administrators. The outcome sought is growth in
teaching practice for both tenured and untenured faculty. The primary responsibility for describing efforts
at teaching improvement rests with the individual faculty member and requires on-going reflection and
documentation about instructional quality and activities designed to improve teaching practice. Faculty
members begin this reflection from the first day they are hired at UIW, through the annual Faculty Self-
Inventory, and at periodic milestones in the tenure and promotion process. The New Faculty Mentoring
Program, the Center for Teaching and Learning, peers in the discipline and colleges/schools, and academic
deans are sources of assistance in thinking about the many ways that teaching excellence can be developed
and documented. This proposed model is intended as a guide for faculty in thinking about their teaching
and ways to document teaching improvement over time.
Holistic Model of Teaching Effectiveness
Effective teaching results from several interacting elements. Effective teachers have a philosophy of
teaching—a set of beliefs about the nature of the learner, how and where learning occurs, how learning is
measured, and the instructor’s role in helping learning take place. These beliefs inform the decisions a
teacher makes in the process of designing and delivering a course and interacting with learners. In brief, a
teacher needs to possess subject matter expertise, be able to plan ways to facilitate learning of the
specific content, be able to effectively deliver content and actively engage students in the learning process.
While student engagement will be demonstrated to a great extent in thoughtful instructional design and
delivery, there is value in faculty members reflecting on the relational aspects of the learning environment.
For purposes of evaluating teaching effectiveness, the four elements of the model are not equally weighted,
nor do they have a numerical scale. The elements are interacting parts of a whole. We believe that
intentional reflection about each area will help faculty improve their teaching practice over time. The model
does not assume a difference by faculty rank or by level of teaching as effective teachers will show evidence
in each of the elements of the model. The elements of effective teaching apply to all kinds of learning
environments, for example, face-to-face classroom teaching; on-line teaching; lab and studio teaching; or
field-based teaching. The rest of this document describes each element and the range of data and evaluation
sources that could be gathered and documented regarding teaching.
Annually, faculty will document this evidence on the Faculty Self-Inventory (FSI). At the time of third year
and tenure/promotion reviews faculty will include a reflective narrative that demonstrates a commitment to
continued growth in the practice of teaching. Included in both annual and tenure/promotion evaluations will
be a description of the relative weight that teaching per se has in an individual faculty’s assigned workload,
that is, what percentage of the workload is assigned to teaching.
79
Evaluation Questions and Examples of Evidence
Content Expertise. We seek to hire faculty who are discipline experts and who can convey the
discipline to students. In evaluating content expertise we want to know if the faculty member is keeping
up with the discipline and is able to design a course that fosters learning about the language, theories,
and best practices of the discipline. Data regarding content expertise will come from the faculty
member’s CV, from peers in the discipline and faculty colleagues in the department.
Examples of Evidence. Faculty may demonstrate content expertise in a number of ways. Regular
attendance at discipline-specific conferences is a way of keeping up with the latest knowledge in
the discipline. Working on an advanced degree is another way. Certainly an active scholarly
agenda related to one’s discipline would indicate currency in the field as would continuing
professional practice or specialty certification. Mentoring students in research projects or
80
serving as a content expert on a thesis/dissertation committee could demonstrate content expertise.
Leadership in curriculum development is an additional way to show evidence of content expertise.
Instructional Design. A person who is a content expert must be able to design learning activities and
course materials that are appropriate for the content and will help students master the course objectives.
Effective design includes creating a challenging intellectual environment and incorporating activities
and evaluation strategies that help students develop higher-level thinking. Instructional design skills
are best evaluated by peers—both within and outside the faculty member’s department.
Examples of Evidence. Course outlines are a source of information that indicate a faculty
member’s understanding of human learning and best practices for facilitating and evaluating
learning in a specific discipline. Course materials could include assignment sheets, rubrics,
checklists or other materials to guide student performance. Evaluation criteria will be clearly stated
and fairly implemented. Faculty might describe how a course was revised based on feedback or
new research on teaching in the discipline. A faculty member might be a leader in designing
blended courses or otherwise using technology effectively. Facilitating a series of brown-bag
lunch discussions on best practices in teaching the discipline could demonstrate instructional
design expertise. Collaborating across disciplines to develop new or innovative courses might
indicate thoughtful design. Service-learning projects could be evidence of thoughtful instructional
design.
Instructional Delivery. The faculty member must be able to teach the course effectively. Effective
teachers demonstrate enthusiasm for their work; they are prepared for class, communicate clearly, and
provide timely feedback. Effective teachers are able to modify instructional strategies as they evaluate
students’ progress in the course. Effective teachers will use a variety of strategies including the creative
use of technology appropriate to the course and the discipline. Students are one source of data about
instructional delivery skills; to some degree students can provide reliable information about design
skills. Faculty peers are a good source of evaluation about instructional delivery.
Examples of Evidence. Student evaluations are a source of evidence about instructional delivery
and will include evidence about enthusiasm, communication, preparation, feedback to students.
Peer and dean observations can also provide evidence of these aspects of teaching effectiveness.
The faculty member could describe cases in which instructional strategies were altered to address
student problems during a course or following student/peer feedback. The faculty could describe
changes to a course that came about because of attending a workshop on effective teaching.
Student Engagement. Actively engaging students in the learning process is a powerful strategy for
facilitating academic success. While student engagement will be demonstrated to a great extent in
thoughtful advising and instructional design and delivery, there is value in faculty members reflecting
on the relational aspects of the learning environment. Students, alumni, and peers are good sources of
information about student engagement. Faculty who approach advising from a developmental
perspective demonstrate evidence of concern for student engagement.
Examples of Evidence. The faculty member will set high standards and include support systems
such as early and frequent feedback so that dedicated students have a reasonable chance for
success. Faculty will be able to demonstrate the multiple ways and opportunities planned for
students to participate in the learning environment. For example, a faculty member might describe
using technology to hold exam review sessions or virtual office hours. Descriptions of
81
service-learning projects, collaborative research, or study abroad courses could be evidence of
student engagement. Student evaluations will report that faculty are respectful and available.
Faculty might describe collaborative research projects or mentoring activities that encourage
student participation or enriching educational experiences such as study-abroad or service learning
projects. Examples of effective advising demonstrate student engagement.
Examples of Teaching Effectiveness Tools Below is an example of how a dean’s Annual Evaluation of Teaching Effectiveness might be summarized
in response to the annual Faculty Self-Inventory (FSI). Below that example is a table listing some of the
above information in a form that some faculty will find helpful in reflecting on their teaching. The table
includes examples of teaching behaviors/evidence but is not exhaustive. The relative weight given to each
area will be based on the faculty members’ teaching goals for the year, experience, workload assignment.
Example of an Annual Dean’s Evaluation of Teaching Effectiveness that is Excellent.
Teaching / Instructional Activities: Excellent (Exceeds Expectations)
Content Expertise. Attended 1 national history conferences with peer-reviewed podium
presentation at one conference (“The Immigrant Experience in South Texas”); leadership
role in revising history curriculum in response to program review.
Instructional Design. Worked with faculty colleagues to design a hybrid course.
Implemented course in spring and revised to address issues identified by students.
Instructional Delivery. Strong student comments. Students comment that teacher is
challenging, always supportive, available. Attended two workshops on pedagogy
sponsored by the Center for Teaching and Learning.
Student Engagement. Students comment that classroom is interactive; professor is
willing to tutor outside of class. Peer observation reports highly interactive classroom and
Blackboard site (for hybrid course).
Annual Evaluation of Teaching Effectiveness: Examples
A faculty member’s teaching may indicate a Need for
Improvement if there is a lack of evidence or behaviors such as the following in 3 of the 4 areas of teaching effectiveness:
A faculty member will Meet Expectations and receive a rating of Very Good through a sample of the following behaviors in 3 of the 4 areas of teaching effectiveness; a rating of Excellent will show evidence in all 4 areas of teaching effectiveness.
Content Expertise
(Question to be answered: does the course content foster learning about the language, theories, and best practices of the discipline? Is the faculty member keeping up with the discipline?)
No evidence of discipline-specific development activity or No discipline-related scholarship
No professional practice or
Does not update courses or participate in curriculum development
Advanced coursework Attends discipline specific workshops
Professional practice
Updates courses to reflect changes in discipline
Participates in curriculum development
Willing to serve on thesis or dissertation committee in area of expertise
Recognized content expert in the discipline
Leads program curriculum revision efforts
Leads development activities for faculty or practice colleagues in the discipline
Instructional Design
(Question to be answered: are the course materials appropriate for the content?)
Course outline does not appear to use knowledge about human learning
Course materials contain few if any assignment sheets, rubrics, checklist or other materials to guide student performance
Courses not revised/updated when feedback or discipline changes suggest a need
Not open to guidance in course development
Open to guidance in course design Designs courses specific to desired course outcomes, learning theory, best practices in the discipline
Revises courses (assignments, exams, projects, grading schemas) based on feedback / learning theory
Consultant in instructional design/best practices in teaching the discipline
Funding for teaching improvement project
Instructional Delivery
(Question to be answered: is the course delivered in a way that is appropriate to the content; does the faculty member work to develop teaching skills?)
Student evaluations below standard or trending low Rarely varies instructional strategies
Oral delivery is unclear
No participation in teaching workshops
Unwilling to use technology as instructional tool
Acceptable student evaluations Satisfactory classroom observations (peer/dean)
Attends workshops on teaching effectiveness
Uses technology in ways that increase student interaction with peers, the material and/or the instructor
Leads workshops on pedagogy in discipline
Funding for teaching improvement project
Student Engagement
(Question to be answered: does the faculty member develop a learner- centered focus, set high academic standards, show respect for students?)
Instructional strategies encourage passivity on part of students
Rude or disrespectful of students
Rarely responds helpfully to student questions
Student complaints about availability
Creates an active, challenging and safe intellectual environment Plans course activities that help students develop higher-level thinking
Effective advising
Maintains office hours/willing to tutor as needed
Develops enriching educational experiences such as study abroad, service-learning projects or field experiences
Engages in collaborative research projects with students
81
82
Scholarship
(Boyer Model)
Scholarship of Teaching
1. Developing new teaching materials, evaluating and documenting new methods of instruction, and
developing and documenting techniques to evaluate the effectiveness of the instruction
2. Documenting activities regarding pedagogy and/or teaching techniques, written evaluation of
teaching materials, and development of outcomes assessment tools
3. Developing, applying, documenting service-learning activities which enhance student learning
outcomes and contribute to the university’s mission and/or
4. Contributing to the discipline, college/school by participating in documenting such tasks as
program reviews, feasibility studies, assessment, bulletin/brochure development and revision, new
course or curriculum development
5. Other scholarship of teaching approved by the discipline, college/school
Scholarship of Discovery
1. Authoring, creating, publishing, or having accepted for publication, appropriate pieces of new
creative work
2. Conducting on-going research activities
3. Grant awards in support of research or scholarly activities
4. Creation of original works or activities for performance
5. Other scholarship of discovery approved by the discipline, college/school
Scholarship of Integration
1. Preparing comprehensive articles, monographs, etc., participating in curricular innovation,
conducting interdisciplinary seminars, integrating performance activities, writing textbooks/case
studies
2. Grant awards in support of interdisciplinary projects
3. Interdisciplinary collaborations on projects, programs, or service-learning
4. Other scholarship of integration approved by the discipline, college/school
Scholarship of Application/Practice/Engagement 1. Applying one’s technical and professional knowledge in such activities as: contract research,
consultation, technical assistance, policy analysis, and program evaluation
2. Performance or exhibition of creative work
3. Securing scholarship or other funds for students from external sources
4. Organization of workshops, seminars, or symposia in one's area of professional competency for a
group of professionals
5. Presentations of in-service or continuing education programs
6. Creation of products, patents, license copyright activities
7. Other scholarship of application approved by the discipline, college/school
Guidelines and Principles for Determining Minimal Scholarship Expectations For Promotion and
Tenure
(Approved by the Provost, 3/25/09)
Consistent Scholarship Progress
The general expectation of all full-time faculty is that they engage every year in scholarship activities
aimed at contributing to one’s discipline, profession, clinical practice, or interdisciplinary area of interest,
83
and which build toward promotion and tenure. In consultation with colleagues and the dean, faculty are
urged to map out a program of research that requires developing a specific area of expertise and sharing
that expertise in the broader professional community.
Categories and Levels of Scholarship Activities
The scholarship annual evaluation grid below organizes the most common scholarship activities into a
checklist consisting of four categories: Publications/Productions, Presentations, Grants,
Application/Practice, and three levels. This list is illustrative not exhaustive. Disciplines may suggest
supplemental lists to reflect the most relevant activities in their area. Individuals in consultation with
colleagues also may document a particular activity with an explanation, for example, of why a listed level
activity should be upgraded to the next level.
Guidelines for Minimum Scholarship Activities Needed for Promotion and Tenure
For Promotion from Assistant to Associate & Tenure (no less than 5 years are evaluated):
2 Level-3 activities* (6 pts), 1 Level-2 (2 pts) and 8 Level-1s (8 pts) = 16 pts Total**
-----------------------------------
For Promotion from Associate to Full (the period since promotion to associate and no less than 5
years are evaluated):
3 Level-3 activities (9 pts), 1 Level-2 (2 pts) and 12 Level-1s (12 pts) = 23 pts Total
*This refers generally to activities that take on more permanence and can be experienced more than once
or can have influence over time. Some examples that clearly illustrate this distinction are published papers,
written reports or policy analyses, external grants, paintings, recordings, design projects; certain
performances in the arts would be the equivalent. In contrast, a podium presentation in and of itself
ordinarily would not fit this classification, even though peer-reviewed, but the publication of the
presentation in proceedings could if inclusion is peer-reviewed.
**Combinations of points can vary as long as the overall total is arrived at. For example, extra L-3s can
replace L-2s and 1s, or extra L-2s can replace 1, but extra L-2s and 1-s cannot replace L-3s. Overall, an
agenda that focuses on L-3s is the best policy.
Peer Review Definition
Peer review (= refereed) is a process by which scholarly work is made public and impartially evaluated by
experts in the field as contributing to the field and can be built on by others to advance the field. “Field”
covers disciplinary and interdisciplinary areas of interest as well as more direct forms of engagement in
addressing pressing social issues.
Documenting Quantity and Quality of Scholarship Progress
At various stages of evaluation for promotion and tenure, including annual and third-year as well,
individuals in consultation with their dean and colleagues (and any developed discipline-specific criteria)
document scholarship progress. Documentation will include reference to numbers of activities as in the
Guidelines above but also explanations as needed to clarify the quality of the scholarship activities. Such
explanations may point to the level of peer review, type of audience, whether invited, impact, or other
factors bearing on the quality of the scholarship.
Role of the Rank and Tenure Committee
R&T review is the last step in institutional peer review of an individual’s scholarship progress for promotion
and tenure. R&T C considers the individual’s notebook and self-evaluation as well as the evaluations of the
dean and colleagues. It uses the guidelines above in exercising its combined professional judgment to
confirm the overall value in an individual faculty’s pattern of continuous
84
progress in the scholarship area. If questions arise about scholarship activities (or teaching, service, and
professional activities), R&T C may request a meeting with the individual to seek further clarification.
Provide a Narrative with the Application for Promotion and Tenure
Consult with colleagues and the dean in preparing a narrative that clearly explains why you consider an
activity should be evaluated at a certain level.
Co-authorship
Co-authorship counts the same as single authorship. You may want to call attention to primary authorship
if you feel that your effort was especially significant in a particular collaborative project.
Proceedings
Be able to document the level of competitive peer-review involved and type of product included: abstract,
paper, PowerPoint.
Online Publications
Online publications count, but you may want to address the status/reputation of the online journal in your
field or interdisciplinary area. Creating or participating in blogs ordinarily would not count as scholarship.
Counting Activities Under Different Levels
For example, an oral presentation at a state conference with a published refereed abstract would count as a
Level-1 activity. If the same basic presentation is invited for a national professional organizational meeting,
then this also could be counted as a Level-2 activity. On the other hand, automatic (i.e., non peer-reviewed)
publication in proceedings of a paper presented at a conference ordinarily would not count as two activities,
even if the paper originally was peer-reviewed.
Presenting at State/Regional vs. National Conferences
A distinction between these levels of conferences may depend on the discipline or the prestige of a particular
conference. You may want to explain the status of a conference if you want to count a state or regional
presentation as a Level-2 activity.
Consultant Work that May Involve Confidentiality Agreements
When a report produced cannot be shared with the Rank & Tenure Committee, see if there are other ways
to document such work. For example, this may be satisfied by a letter from the client or employing agency
that states that work was done without specifically identifying what it was but that it met expectations and
was a quality product.
Paid Activities
The guideline for scholarship, as distinct from service, is whether the activity is a high-level application of
one’s expertise and contributes to the field or area of practice. Obvious Level-3 examples include writing a
book, significant consulting work, a major design project or music performance. These activities may be
compensated, but the quality of the activity determines its scholarship value, not the pay.
Authorship of Accreditation Documents
Primary authorship of accreditation documents may count as scholarship. Participation in department
program review is service.
85
Internal Grants Can Include Improvement of Teaching Projects as well as Research
Such projects must be aimed at scholarship of teaching. There is a difference between good teaching,
scholarly teaching, and scholarship of teaching and learning. Good teaching “is that which promotes
student learning and other positive student outcomes.” (McKinney in Analyzing Faculty Work and
Rewards: Using Boyer’s Four Domains of Scholarship, 2006, p. 38.) Positive student evaluations would be
one indicator of teaching success. Scholarly teaching is more. “Scholarly teachers, for example, reflect
on their teaching, use classroom assessment techniques, discuss teaching with colleagues, and read and
apply the literature on teaching and learning.” Scholarship of teaching and learning, in addition, “involves
systematic study of teaching and learning and the public sharing and review of such work through live or
virtual presentations, performances, or publications. It shares accepted criteria of scholarship in general,
such as that it is made public, can be reviewed critically by members of the appropriate community, and
can be built on by others to advance the field.” An internal grant that lays out a project of research intended
to produce results related to teaching and learning that can, for example, be written up and presented or
published, is what counts under scholarship.
Development of New Teaching Materials
See above—development of such materials goes beyond teaching effectiveness if it is subjected to the peer
review process and presented or published.
Scholarship of Engagement
In one of his last articles, “The Scholarship of Engagement,” Ernest Boyer stressed the importance of his 4th
category of scholarship of application: “[T]he scholarship of engagement means connecting the rich
resources of the university to our most pressing social, civic, and ethical problems, to our children, to our
schools, to our teachers, and to our cities, just to name the ones I am personally in touch with most
frequently. You could name others. Campuses would be viewed by both students and professors not only as
isolated islands, but as staging grounds for action.” (Journal of Public Service and Outreach, Vol. 1,
#1, pp. 11-20, 1996) The focus on engaging in the community resonates well with scholarship opportunities
connected to UIW’s service requirement for graduation and the goals of the Center for Teaching and
Learning and the Ettling Center for Civic Leadership.
SCHOLARSHIP: Annual Evaluation Instructor: Very Good = 2 points; Excellent = 3 or more points (may be Level 1 activities each year) Assistant Professor: Very Good = 3 points; Excellent = 4 or more points (minimum of 16 points with at least two level 3 activities will be needed for promotion to associate professor and tenure)
Associate Professor: Very Good = 4 points; Excellent = 5 or more points (minimum of 23 points with at least three level 3 activities will be needed for promotion to full professor)
Full Professor: Very Good = 4 points; Excellent = 5 or more
Category Level 3 (3 points) (Peer Reviewed)
Level 2 (2 points) (Peer Reviewed)
Level 1 (1 point) (Non-Peer &Peer Reviewed [PR])
Publications/Productions Monograph or book published or officially accepted
A book/monograph chapter may equal a paper
published
Paper published or accepted
Paper published in conf. proceedings
Editor of book or journal
Creative performance in music or theater
Exhibit/production in the arts
Learning aids published
Web-based presentations/publications
Revisions to book Anything in level 3 not peer reviewed
Abstract published [PR]
Book review published [PR]
Encyclopedia entry published [PR]
Editorial in discipline published
Manuscript submitted for publication
Clinical guidelines or critical pathways published
In-house publication/performance/creative work
Creative work submitted for exhibit [PR]
Column published in professional journal
Presentations Podium or poster presentation at
state/regional/national/international professional
org. meeting
Research/scholarship at other institutions, industry
or government that contribute to the field
Contribution to state and regional accreditation
meeting
Corporate sponsored presentation that contains
original scholarship
Anything from Level 2 not peer reviewed
Presentation/poster at local or UIW meeting
Organizing/chairing/on panel in sessions at
professional meeting
Grants External grant proposal accepted for funding Anything in level 3 not peer reviewed
Internal research/scholarship grant proposal
accepted for funding
Submission of external grant proposal
External reports on grant activities
Application/Practice External reports related to conducting contract
research, consultation, technical assistance, policy
analysis, external program evaluation, compiling and
analyzing client or health service outcomes, meta-
analysis related to practice problems, clinical
demonstration projects, compiling and analyzing
student results, etc.
Development/organization/delivery of workshops/
seminars/symposia for professionals at national level
Products for sale, patents, license copyrights
Contribution to licensing or certification exams for
professionals in the field
Development of professional certification and
accreditations
Development/organization/delivery of
workshops/seminars/symposia for professionals at a
regional/state level
Authorship of accreditation or other internal comprehensive program reports
Selected as consultant to organizations related to
one’s discipline (no report done for review)
Written reviews of manuscripts, abstracts or
proposals
Development/organization/delivery of
workshops/seminars/symposia for professionals
at a local level
86
87
University and Community Service
1. University
a. Active participation in university committees
b. Program chair/coordinator/director
c. Administration of a grant
d. Mentoring colleagues to the institution
e. Sponsor of a student organization
f. Recruitment, or securing scholarships or funds
g. Assisting in university activities such as orientation, Incarnate Word Day, fairs, etc.
h. Self-initiated contributions to discipline, college/school growth
i. Overloads and non-paid independent studies in time of need
j. Promoting the spirit or Mission of the university
k. Tutoring students
l. Conducting peer evaluations, participating in discipline/program group evaluations
2. Community
a. Participation in a community organization b. Lectures, addresses, publications, or other creative contributions to a general audience on
a topic in one’s professional area of competency
c. Organization of workshops/seminars/symposia for a general audience and related to one’s
professional interests
d. Civic achievements or recognition for one’s professional interests
Other discipline criteria approved by the college/school
Professional Activities
1. Participation in a Professional Organization (note whether local, regional, national, international)
a. Membership in a professional organization
b. Attendance at meetings
c. Election to office or other committee responsibility
d. Panelist, chairperson, or commentator for sessions at annual meeting
e. Recognition for academic and/or professional achievement
2. Faculty Development
a. Participation in workshops, seminars, and symposia in areas of professional competence b. Primary author of faculty development plan (e.g., a proposal for a series of workshops for
faculty on teaching, testing, etc.)
c. Certification in clinical/practice area
d. Continuation of academic studies or postdoctoral work
3. Other Activities
a. Book review b. Referee for a professional journal
c. Professional practice
d. Coordinates/conducts continuing education for community professionals
e. Consultant to community organization
Other discipline criteria approved by the college/school
88
Faculty Evaluation Procedures
Dean Evaluation of First-Year Faculty
The first-year experience for new faculty is critical for identifying expectations that will lead to success at
UIW culture. Steps in the evaluation process are as follows:
1. At the beginning of the fall semester the dean a) meets with first-year faculty and emphasizes the
importance of teaching, the challenges of teaching at UIW, and the constraints of the first-year
probationary period (short time period for evaluation), and 2) observes (or the dean’s designee) at least
one class each of all first-year facultyCriteria for Dean or Peer Review of Teaching Form the dean
observes again soon if there are problems.
2. By the end of the fall semester, the dean (or designee) sits down with the instructor and explains how to
do the FSI including an updated vita and requires a draft be submitted by December 31. The dean also
indicates that a philosophy of teaching is to be developed and attendance during the year at two
development activities on effective teaching is required. College/schools may require attendance at other
faculty development activities. The philosophy and activities can be added later with the final FSI
submission.
3. By February 15, if reappointment has been decided by the dean, a new contract is authorized to be
received by the faculty after the March Board Meeting. The contract includes the full budget- approved
merit increase (subject to change by the end of the semester based on the dean’s evaluation of the final
FSI submission).
4. By April 15, new faculty submit to the dean their final FSI including updated vita and philosophy of
teaching statement.
5. By May 1, the dean (or designee) meets with new faculty and goes over the FSI and explains the dean’s
final evaluation and merit increase decision.
6. By May 15, the dean notifies the provost of any first-year faculty contracts to be revised with a different
merit increase.
Dean Annual Evaluation of Faculty
The annual dean evaluation of faculty is different than, but should be related to, the process of evaluating
faculty for promotion and tenure. This evaluation provides a review of performance, progress toward major
career goals, and recommendations for compensation, including merit pay. This process should assist the
faculty member in assessing progress toward tenure, promotion, or other professional goals, as well as
identify actions that will likely lead to professional success. Deans, therefore, must use the annual evaluation
as a tool to foster the professional development and enhance the prospects for success of each faculty member
in the college/school. Colleagues have a duty to provide meaningful peer evaluations. It is the dean’s duty
and responsibility to provide the written evaluation of performance. The faculty member and the dean work
in partnership to discuss and revise matters of concern in these documents. Steps in the evaluation process
are as follows:
By the Friday after grades are due in December, the faculty member is required to submit to the dean
his/her Faculty Self Inventory summarizing activities for this calendar year, including goals for the
upcoming calendar year, and update the CV in Sedona.
On or before February 1, the dean provides the faculty member with a written assessment of
89
professional performance conducted during the preceding calendar year.
On or before March 1, the faculty member and the dean agree to the duties and responsibilities for the
current calendar year.
Resolutions of any informal or formal appeals will occur by April 15.
In most cases, the dean's written annual evaluation will provide necessary and sufficient documentation;
formal meetings to discuss the FSI, and/or the evaluation are typically at the discretion of the faculty member.
Deans will meet individually for a formal discussion of the annual evaluation with any faculty member
who falls in one of these categories:
first-year faculty members,
third-year faculty members,
any faculty member receiving a less than satisfactory rating by the dean in any category of
performance,
any faculty member scheduled for review for tenure in the following academic year,
any faculty member newly eligible to apply for promotion,
any faculty member who has drafted goals on the FSI that the dean wishes to negotiate.
When feasible, deans are encouraged to meet with all faculty members in the college/school. The purpose of
such meetings is to orient new faculty to the evaluation system, identify areas for development, provide for
timely counseling from the dean, and to strengthen the congruence of individual faculty goals with those of
the college/school. In addition, memos, emails, and/or other written materials are expected to foster and
document communication between the faculty member and his or her dean.
Directions for the FSI, the process for resolving disputes about the FSI, addressing unsatisfactory
performance, the evaluation of teaching schedule, and other evaluation tools are in the section in this
chapter titled Evaluation Materials (Evaluation Materials).
Third-Year Review of Tenure-Track Faculty
In the third year, the dean’s annual evaluation anticipates the kind of review done by Rank and Tenure as
described below. The dean takes a three-year holistic view of faculty, their fit and their performance in the
four categories and refers to the minimum percentages described below as guidelines. In arriving at this
evaluation, the dean will consult with other faculty in the discipline as a group and other senior faculty in
the college/school as appropriate and solicits from them written feedback regarding a faculty’s progress
toward promotion and tenure. This feedback should be summarized in third-year letters of recommendation
prepared by the dean for faculty regarding the likelihood of their readiness to apply successfully for tenure
in year six. The letters will also identify any aspects of performance that put faculty at risk for promotion
and tenure. Such individuals also may receive a final contract. The deans provide the provost with copies of
all third-year letters sent to faculty. The dean also completes the “Annual Evaluation of Faculty by Dean
Form” used for determinations of merit. See Chapter 4 for details on the third-year review process and
timeline.
Promotion and Tenure Evaluation for Tenure-Track Faculty
Review for promotion and tenure by the Rank and Tenure Committee, following the Faculty Handbook,
Chapter 4, places more weight on the categories of instruction, scholarship, and institutional fit than on
service and professional activities. The degree of importance UIW currently places on the different categories
is as follows: teaching—40%, scholarship—20%, service—15%, and professional activities— 5%, with 20%
90
to distribute among these categories in consultation with the dean. The committee also has the responsibility
of evaluating the pattern of growth in these areas over a number of years. The committee’s responsibility is
to form a holistic view of faculty performance by synthesizing data from various sources: the dean’s letter
of recommendation, that of other faculty, and the committee’s review of materials submitted by the faculty
member. As a consequence, the Annual Evaluation by the dean is a reasonable predictor of success in the
promotion and tenure process to the extent that very good and excellent ratings are achieved in instruction
and scholarship over a period of time, and, in addition, the judgment is made by the dean that there is
institutional fit or progress in that direction. In tenure review, fit, that is, the quality of relationship the faculty
establishes in the UIW community, is a critical factor in evaluating overall faculty performance. For tenure,
the Rank and Tenure Committee must add its own evaluation to that of the dean and other faculty in forming
a recommendation to be submitted to the provost. See Chapter 4 for details on the promotion and tenure
process and timeline.
Promotion Evaluation for Instructors to Senior Instructors
See Chapter 4 for details on the promotion and tenure process and timeline
Evaluation Materials and Processes
The Schedule of Dean and Peer Evaluations of Teaching
The deans oversee evaluation of teaching and course materials. They identify and submit names of all faculty
who will have student evaluations of teaching conducted for all classes each semester. By the sixth week of
each semester, the dean will identify and notify all faculty members requiring dean and/or peer evaluations
of teaching. The following schedule is required for minimal documentation of teaching/course materials
evaluations by a peer and/or dean or the dean’s appointed designee (see evaluation forms,):
Tenured: as determined by the dean
Tenure-Track, Years 4-6 1 class per year
Tenure-Track (regular time or early), Years 1-3 2 classes every year
Non-tenure Track as determined by the dean
For dean evaluation of teaching
1. The above timeline allows the dean to evaluate the teaching capability of all full-time faculty.
Additional evaluations may be needed in preparation for tenure, promotion, or other performance
review considerations.
2. Deans solicit possible dates from faculty for class observations and notify faculty of a selected date.
3. Faculty may request dean visitation at any time. 4. When the dean evaluates teaching, then the dean should complete the evaluation of teaching form
(see Criteria for Dean or Peer Review of Teaching Form (supplied by the Dean); a complementary
approach can be used for the same class: (Dean Observing a Class Option), and provide the faculty
with timely discussion about his or her observations based on the classroom visit.
For Peer evaluation of teaching/course materials: 1. Peer evaluation will be conducted as per the above schedule or upon request of the dean. Completed,
signed forms will be provided by the peer evaluator to the faculty member, and to the dean for
purposes of tracking performance patterns.
2. Faculty may request informal peer visitation to address specific issues. Feedback in this case is
formative only and not reported to the dean.
At the first college/school meeting each semester, the dean will inform all full-time faculty of the schedule
of dean/peer review of teaching/course materials.
By the end of the eighth week of the semester, the dean will consult with faculty about possible peer
91
evaluators. Upon faculty request, chairs of all committees with faculty representatives will complete Peer
Evaluation of University Committee Service forms and return to the appropriate dean.
By the end of each semester, student evaluations will be completed. Faculty will receive analysis/student
comments as soon as all final grades are processed by the registrar.
Criteria for Dean or Peer Review of Teaching Form (supplied by the Dean)
Name of Person being Evaluated # Present
Class Observed # Enrolled
Length of Class Length of Observation
Date Evaluator
Type of Class: quantitative/conceptual; theory/application; survey/advanced; lecture/discussion/performance.
EACH RANKING MUST HAVE A COMMENT AND A SUMMARY PARAGRAPH AT THE END MUST BE
INCLUDED. INSTRUCTOR’S RESPONSE WILL BE APPENDED.
1. Objectives for the session were clear and appropriate.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
2. Material was presented clearly.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
3. The instructor encouraged interaction/student contributions.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
4. Time in the class session was managed effectively.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
5. The instructor spoke distinctly and audibly.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
6. The instructor distinguished between the presentation of factual material and personal opinion.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
7. The instructor provided for the presentation of other opinions or interpretations where appropriate.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
8. The instructor prompted critical thinking and/or creative expression.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
9. Assignments or plans for the next session(s) were made clearly.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
10. The instructor provided closure to the class.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
11. For clinical, studio or laboratory classes: the faculty member was organized, provided attention and guidance to
the students. The faculty member encouraged application of knowledge and integrated as appropriate.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
SUMMARY: OVERALL EVALUATION
93
Dean Observing a Class Option
The Process
At the beginning of the class, the instructor introduces the dean and says why present.
During the class, the dean (or designee) takes notes and/or begins to fill out the “Criteria for Dean or Peer
Review of Teaching” above.
In the last 15 minutes of class, the instructor leaves and the dean you tells the class that this is a regular part
of the evaluation of teachers which also includes the Student Assessment of Teaching form distributed
nearer the end of the semester. But this visit to class has the advantage of identifying some aspects of the
class that might be improved before the semester is over. The dean will get back with the instructor and
discuss what was observed and share a written summary of student responses.
Dean hands out a half-page response sheet and asks the students to spend about 5 minutes writing down
their individual responses to the questions:
--Name one thing the instructor does that helps you learn.
--Name one thing the instructor does that makes it hard for you to learn.
--Name one thing you would change in this class to make it better.
In the meantime, the dean writes the 3 questions on the board. Then the dean takes one question at a time
(sometimes #s 2 and 3 naturally blend together), and asks students to share their comments. After each
comment, check to see if the response represents consensus in the class. If it does, then summarize this on
the board. Dean asks a student in front to write down on a blank sheet what dean is putting on the board. If
this takes too much time, just keep notes and don’t write on board.
At the end, the dean collects the summary response sheet from the student helper if summarized on the
board and the individual responses from the class; dean says to the class that the individual responses also
will be looked at before a report is given back to the instructor.
After class, the dean meets with the instructor and gives him/her a copy of the completed “Criteria for Dean
or Peer Review of Teaching” form and also a written report summarizing the 15” with the students See
below for a short example of this report:
Instructor:
Facilitator:
Class:
Date:
Re: [An example of a] Summary of student perceptions
There was consensus from the class on the following points.
Name one thing the instructor does that helps you learn.
--encourages discussion --excited in what she is teaching and this rubs off on us
Name one thing the instructor does that makes it hard for you to learn.
--goes a little fast sometimes
94
Name one thing you would change in this class to make it better.
--more review for tests
--less busywork
One student or a few mentioned the following in writing.
--more discussion, class activity, interaction (6)
--would like a little more of your point of view (4)
Criteria for Peer Review of Teaching Materials Form (supplied by the Dean)
(Review of materials should be completed by the instructor and the evaluator PRIOR to any classroom observation
whenever possible.)
Instructor Evaluated:
Evaluator
Date:
Position
Each ranking must have a comment and a summary paragraph must be included.
1. Texts selected by the instructor are appropriate to subject, level of course, and current research in the
discipline.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
2. Other materials are appropriate (as above).
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
3. Assigned readings and other activities provide a variety of perspectives on the subject.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
4. Readings include primary sources.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
5. Course activities have been planned and/or sequenced to help students reach the objectives of the course.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
6. Some course activities/assignments develop student research skills.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
7. Some course activities/assignments develop student creativity.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
8. Students’ academic standing/progress is evaluated regularly and feedback is provided.
95
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
9. The syllabus provides a variety of approaches.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
10. Evaluations are consistent with the goals of the courses.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
11. Items on the tests or other means of evaluation are appropriate.
GOOD SATISFACTORY NEEDS IMPROVEMENT NOT APPLICABLE
Comments:
SUMMARY: OVERALL EVALUATION
INSTRUCTOR’S RESPONSE:
Student Evaluation of Teaching Form
The online form consists of the following questions which are used each semester for each class. The survey
is in two parts: 1) quantitative and 2) qualitative. The first consists of 9 questions and the second of 3.
Quantitative (scale: Not at All, Rarely, About half the time, Frequently, Always)
1. The instructor was enthusiastic about the subject matter.
2. The instructor encouraged active participation in class.
3. The instructor communicated the subject matter clearly.
4. The instructor was well prepared for class.
5. The instructor was available outside of class.
6. The instructor was clear about the assignments in this course.
7. The instructor provided timely feedback.
8. The instructor’s evaluation methods were fair.
9. The instructor treated you with respect.
96
Qualitative
10. Please comment on anything about the instructor’s teaching that was particularly helpful to your
learning.
11. Please comment on anything about the instructor’s teaching that made it hard for you to learn.
12. Additional comments.
Peer Evaluation of University Committee Service Form
As one who has served on a committee or task force with the person named below, please rate his/her
participation as you personally experienced it. If you served with this person on more than one committee
or task force, please fill out one form for each. Thank you.
Person being evaluated:
Committee/Task Force:
Chair of Committee:
Date of Service:
1. This person attended meetings.
Rarely Sometimes Almost always/Always
2. This person prepared for meetings.
Rarely Sometimes Almost always/Always
3. This person was willing to accept, or volunteer for, extra work assignments.
Rarely Sometimes Almost always/Always
4. This person’s attendance and work helped the committee complete its work in a timely manner.
Rarely Sometimes Almost always/Always
5. I would be happy to serve on another committee or task force with this person.
Rarely Sometimes Almost always/Always
Comments:
Name Printed:
Signature:
97
Faculty Self-Evaluation: The Faculty Self Inventory (FSI)
Faculty update their CVs in Sedona and complete the FSI form that is found on the Faculty Senate
Blackboard site. The FSI consists of eight parts. In the first seven, faculty document activities in the last
year with comments; dean comments are optional in each case:
1. Teaching Effectiveness
2. Scholarship
3. University and Community Service
4. Professional Activities
5. Faculty Self-Assessment Overall
6. General Goals/Plans for Next Year
7. Institutional Fit
The dean completes part eight:
8. Annual Evaluation of Faculty By Dean
Unsatisfactory Performance
For tenured or non-tenured faculty, annual evaluations provide for continuous review of performance, and
ensure timely developmental measures to support professional success. Ongoing annual evaluations of
tenured faculty serve as the post-tenure review process at UIW. Satisfactory performance consists of
adequate professional conduct in faculty duties and responsibilities. Unsatisfactory performance is a
pattern of inadequacy in carrying out faculty duties and responsibilities. Unsatisfactory performance for
tenured faculty, then, is defined as two consecutive years of:
1. Overall Needs Improvement performance in the areas of teaching, scholarship, service, and
professional activities, or
2. Needs Improvement evaluation in teaching and scholarship.
The philosophy of continuous improvement and evaluation assumes that development will occur to
support success in professional performance, and that university resources are sufficient to ensure this
success. For tenured faculty whose performance has seriously declined (as defined above as Needs
Improvement performance), the strategy to support renewed success in performance and/or development
is the Action Plan. This plan is initiated at the time of the first annual evaluation of needs improvement. If
a faculty member contests either the evaluation and/or Action Plan, the procedures for resolving disputes
outlined above will be followed. The provost will receive a copy of the final version of the Action Plan.
The essential elements of any Action Plan include:
Developmental action linked to specific performance areas as per discipline, college/school, and/or
university standards of performance,
Timeline for action/evaluation (and adjustment, if needed) throughout the action plan period, and
Specific budget and/or university resources appropriate to support the faculty member in the
attainment of goals.
After two years* of documented unsatisfactory performance (defined above) in which development
specified in the Action Plan failed to improve performance to a satisfactory level, the university may use
such documentation to determine the need to bring formal proceedings for dismissal for cause. (See
Chapter 4) However, it is important to emphasize that successive Needs Improvement evaluations do not
in any way diminish the obligation of the institution to bear the burden of proof and demonstrate to a
hearing body of faculty peers that the factual evidence is adequate cause for dismissal of a tenured faculty.
Other actions short of termination for cause may be considered: reassignment of teaching or other
98
contractual duties, or initiation of informal proceedings for pre-retirement options.
*The overall process could take four years:
Year 1 Needs Improvement performance; at end of year, Action Plan A developed for Year 2 Year 2 Needs Improvement; at end of year, Action Plan B developed for Year 3
Year 3 Needs Improvement; termination procedures may be initiated at the end of the year (if so, a terminal contract for Year 4 may be the outcome)
Year 4 if due process led to issuance of a terminal contract, then year 4 is the last year of
employment
Procedures for Resolving Disputes Concerning the FSI
If the evaluation by the dean of the FSI is contested by a faculty member, the faculty member may resolve
disagreements through the following actions:
1. Informal discussions between the faculty member and his/her dean.
2. If informal discussions between the faculty member and his/her dean are not successful in resolving
disputes, the faculty member will submit a written appeal to a Peer Review Oversight (PRO)
Committee. Membership of the PRO will include two faculty selected from the pool of past Rank
and Tenure members outside the college/school in question. One is chosen by the faculty person
and the other by the dean. Two additional members will consist of one faculty member at large
chosen by the faculty person, and one chosen by the dean. The process for resolution consists of
the following actions:
a. The faculty person and the dean will put in writing the differences that they have not yet
resolved to the provost and the Senate president. The president arranges for the membership
above to be chosen and a date for the first meeting.
b. The PRO Committee must interview both the faculty person and the dean, and may request
copies of any relevant materials.
c. The PRO Committee attempts to reach consensus on an opinion on the issue brought before it.
A summary of this opinion is communicated in writing to the faculty person and the dean, and
copied to the provost and the Senate president.
d. In light of this opinion, the faculty person and the dean will again attempt to settle the issue. e. If the faculty person and the dean cannot resolve the issue, the faculty person may use the
Grievance Committee for a final level of appeal.
f. The results of the Grievance Committee are forwarded to the Senate Executive Committee for
review and for a recommendation for further action if necessary.
100
CHAPTER 6: POLICIES/PROCEDURES RELATED TO INSTRUCTION
Course Syllabi/Outlines
See handbook supplements for other possible formats to be followed in developing syllabi/outlines.
There is one syllabus for each course offered at UIW. The most current syllabus is kept on file in the
college/school dean’s office. The syllabus includes the bulletin description of the course, course overview,
prerequisites, learning outcomes, and how each outcome will be assessed. The syllabus also includes statements
regarding accommodations for physical and learning disabilities and academic integrity. Avoid using the
language of “contract” in the syllabus and in communicating with students about the syllabus. The syllabus is
approved by the college/school curriculum committee and should not be changed without committee approval.
The course outline will contain more detail than the syllabus and will describe when and how the course will
be taught. The course outline may change from section to section or semester to semester. The course outline
does not require curriculum committee approval.
A Course Description contains the title, number, and brief statement of the scope of the course. Course
descriptions for courses regularly offered are included in the university bulletins whenever possible, but courses
not listed in the bulletin may also be offered.
A Course Syllabus, an expansion of the course description, contains a minimal list of the outcomes sought,
and the topics to be covered whenever the course is offered, along with any other regular and constant element
of the course.
An Outline is a plan of instruction for the offering of a course for a given semester: (1) The topics to be covered
in the semester (including, but not limited to, the topics listed in the course outline); (2) Due dates for
assignments; (3) Student activities and outcomes expected; (4) Means of assessment; (5) Method of
determining the final grade; (6) Required texts; (7) Attendance policy and any other regulations the instructor
has chosen to promulgate (but, see also below); (8) Other relevant material at the discretion of the instructor.
Policy approved in summer 2014 requires that the outline include clarification of credit hours: how many direct
instruction hours and how many home work hours. See Definition of a Credit Hour.
Copies of the course syllabus and outline for every course must be kept on permanent file in the college/school
offices for inspection by students, faculty, and accrediting agencies.
By the end of the second week of every semester, each faculty member shall submit to the college/school dean
a completed outline for every course he/she is offering that semester. Upon request, the college/school dean
shall forward copies of this outline to the provost. Outlines may be changed every semester at the discretion of
the instructor as long as they conform to the minimum requirements stipulated in the course syllabus. Changes
in course descriptions may be made by any faculty member with the approval of the college/school dean,
provided the changes conform to the approved course outline.
Graduate/Undergraduate Courses: A clear distinction between graduate and undergraduate instruction shall be
evident in the level of achievement expected of each student, and students shall be admitted to graduate courses
only upon their admission as graduate students or postgraduate students (See the bulletins for criteria and
procedures for admission). For courses that are open to both graduate and undergraduate students, syllabi shall
clearly indicate that the expectations for graduate students are noticeably more rigorous than those applying to
undergraduate students.
Blended and On-line Courses
To create and implement a blended or on-line course faculty are required to submit a request that is
processed as a level A curriculum change. See policy, request form, and suggested course outline in
100
APPENDIX 22: BLENDED and ONLINE COURSE POLICY.
(Example Syllabus: Essential Sequence and Content)
UNIVERSITY OF THE INCARNATE WORD
School or College DISC XXXX
Course title
Syllabus
Catalog Description:
Context: Prerequisits Degree plan for which the course is appropriate. Audience for which the course is
appropriate. The course may (may not) be repeated for credit. Format in which the course may be
offered (face-to-face, blended, online)
Course Overview: The purpose of this course is to prepare ... Technology to be used … Topics to be included ... Assessment
and/or teaching strategies … Other pertinent information …
Course outcomes: Assessment:
Upon completion of the course, students will be able to
The objectives will be assessed
By
By
By
Include the most current policy statements:
Academic Honesty Statement
Disability Accommodations
Pregnancy Accommodations
Title IX Information
Class Absences for Religious Observances
Approval Date:
101
Course Outline: Suggested Format, Sequence, and Content
A. Name of Institution
B. Number and Name of Course/Prerequisites
C. Term and Year
D. Name of Instructor
E. Office Location and Number
F. Phone Number and/or E-mail Address G. Office Hours
H. Overview of the Course (must incorporate the content of the syllabus for the course)*
1. Brief description of the course including requirements and/or
2. Research tools essential to the course.
3. Outcomes and Assessment of the Course
4. Course Audience
I. Course Texts/Supplies/Materials
J. Class Meeting Schedule/Matrix includes the topics, readings, and/or
K. Assignments for each date the class meets.
SESSION # DATE TOPICS READINGS ASSIGNMENTS
L. Grading Activities Criteria and Guidelines 1. List of all tests, papers, and exams, project or other components that are included in
grading
2. State the criteria for determining the grade for each activity listed above
3. Describe the proportion of the total grade each of the graded activities is worth
M. Participation, Punctuality and Attendance Requirements/Expectations
N. Disability Statement
O. Policy on Academic Integrity P. It is suggested that professors distribute sample formats or guidelines for papers, presentations,
and projects at some point after the first week of class
Q. Bibliography: books, journals, films, etc., that enhance the student’s understanding of the course
material
*The Course Syllabus could be an addendum to the Course Outline
Attendance Policy and Other Regulations
Instructors may impose regulations regarding attendance and other matters of classroom management and
decorum, provided such regulations (along with specification of penalties, if any) are published to students
in the written outline distributed at the beginning of each course and placed on file in the office of the
college/school dean. UIW does allow absence for university sponsored events (for example, athletes
traveling to away games) and for religious observances. See the approved policies in the appropriate catalog
which can be found on the registrar’s website.
102
Reporting Student Absences
Although, as indicated above, faculty members are free to determine the attendance policy for their own
classes, all faculty members are required to submit to the registrar on the confirmation of attendance forms
the names of students who never reported to the class, or who exceed the number of permitted absences, or
who discontinue attending classes without properly withdrawing.
Faculty Concerns about Students
Faculty who have any concerns about student academic success—repeated absences, failure to complete
assignments, bad grades—are encouraged to contact the university Advising Center to request an
intervention. (http://www.uiw.edu/advising/forms.html). This is a simple initial contact and Advising
Center advisors conduct all the follow up and provide appropriate support.
Faculty who observe student behavior that is perceived to be a possible threat to the student or others,
should share their concerns or observations with the Behavioral Intervention Team on campus. Use the
report form at http://www.uiw.edu/campuslife/ReportanIncident.html.
Faculty Absence
Faculty absence from scheduled classes may at times be necessitated by valid reasons such as illness, jury
duty, or attendance at professional meetings. When such circumstances arise, the faculty member is
expected to make suitable arrangements with the college/school dean, in advance whenever possible, for
the absence. Such arrangements should include provision for covering the class or making up for it with an
alternative learning experience. Emergency absence for which no preparation was possible should be
reported to someone who will take responsibility for notifying classes, but as soon as convenient, thereafter,
the college/school dean should be notified.
Faculty Office Hours
Faculty are required to post for their students a schedule of their office hours for each semester (a minimum
of four hours per week, distributed over several days for full-time faculty, and one hour per week per three-
hour course taught for part-time faculty), with notice to the college/school dean. Office hours for the
professional schools should be determined by faculty and the dean.
Student Attendance, Progress, and Grade Processes
After the first week of the semester, faculty will receive notification/instructions from the registrar of the
confirmation of attendance process. To award federal financial aid, we must confirm that students have
attended class and the confirmation of attendance process is in response to that federal requirement.
Student progress should be assessed and graded regularly, both formally and informally, throughout the
semester. At least one formal and graded assessment must be completed by the end of six weeks of class.
The results of such early assessment, if the grade average is a D or F, must be reported to the Director of
Academic Advising by the deadline set for that purpose each semester so that remedial measures may be
taken before the last date for withdrawing with the grade of W: seminars, research, practicum courses,
independent studies, and graduate courses are exceptions to the above requirement.
At the sixth week of the semester, faculty will receive notification/instructions from the registrar of the
midterm grade entry process. UIW requires midterm grades for students attending 1000-2000 level
courses. Faculty teaching other courses can submit midterm grades if they want to provide that feedback to
their students.
103
The week before final exams, faculty will receive notification/instructions from the registrar of the final
grade entry process. All students enrolled in all courses must have a grade recorded by the deadline
provided by the registrar and posted on the academic calendar. Deans will be notified when faculty fail to
provide end of the semester grades.
Instructors are personally responsible for the preparation, supervision, and correction of all examinations in
their courses. Final grades are not official until released by the Registrar's Office. Once the grades are
recorded, grades other than IP cannot be changed, except in the case of error. In no case may a grade other
than IP be changed without the permission of the college/school dean. Graded final examinations not
returned to the student should be kept on file in the instructor's office at least six months after the exam has
been given.
Classroom Scheduling
The classroom scheduling policy can be found on the Registrar’s website. Members of the faculty are not
free to change the room or hour scheduled for their classes or examinations. If such changes are necessary or
desirable, they should be approved by the registrar in consultation with the appropriate college/school dean.
System of Grading and Honor Points
These policies are contained in the appropriate university catalogs.
Privacy Act
(See the "Family Educational Rights and Privacy Act," in the Registrar's Office.)
Duplication Guidelines
(See APPENDIX 12: COPYRIGHT POLICY AND GUIDELINES)
Outside Speakers
(See Public Speakers Policy)
Instructors may schedule off-campus speakers to appear before classes. However, the instructor in charge of
the class is completely responsible for the acceptability of such a speaker and his or her relevance to the
course. If an honorarium is requested, the college/school dean's approval shall be required and the
honorarium will be charged to the college/school budget. The honorarium should be requested in the
Business Office several days in advance.
Cancellation of Course Offerings
Any scheduled course may be canceled because of insufficient enrollment, at the discretion of the provost,
after consultation with the college/school dean. "Sufficient enrollment" shall be determined by the provost
in consultation with the college/school deans prior to each registration.
Policy on Academic Integrity
(See APPENDIX 18: POLICY ON ACADEMIC INTEGRITY)
Student Complaints Related to Faculty Decisions about Student Course Work
(See APPENDIX 19: STUDENT COMPLAINTS)
Classroom Recording Policy
(See APPENDIX 21: CLASSROOM RECORDING POLICY)
CHAPTER 7: CURRICULUM DEVELOPMENT AND REVISION
Check handbook supplements for variations on these procedures.
Abbreviations: UC (Undergraduate Council); CAC (Core Advisory Council); GC
(Graduate Council); C/S CC (College/School Curriculum Committee)
See flow diagram that represents the processes for curriculum change described in this
chapter.
Categories of Curriculum Change (see procedures sections for detailed differentiation of categories)
A. Changes that affect only one discipline or college/school.
B. Changes that affect more than one discipline or college/school, or involves the
granting of course credit in a manner other than described in the catalog.
C. Changes that affect the undergraduate UIW core curriculum; the
creation/elimination of a degree, degree plan, major, minor; or make changes to
institutional academic policies or requirements.
Assumptions
Upon review by a dean, the UC or GC, Faculty Senate, registrar, or the provost, the category of a proposal
may be changed. The proposal will be processed according to the appropriate procedures for that category.
In the current structure of the university, the provost has the authority to veto any curriculum action.
Communication is essential in the curriculum decision-making process. If a proposal is not approved at any
level, the reasons must be communicated by the decision makers to all relevant parties. A proposal may be
subsequently revised and submitted again, starting with step one in the procedures.
Procedures: Category “A” Change
Category “A” changes affect only one discipline or college/school and do not result in the
reation/elimination of a degree, degree plan, major, minor. Examples of “A” changes may include: new
courses, concentrations, modification of existing curriculum.
“A” change proposals can be initiated by any individual/group (initiator). A complete proposal is processed
through the following steps:
1. Initiator develops the written proposal (see the checklist on page 2 of the curriculum processing form for
required proposal components). 2. The completed proposal is submitted for review to all relevant college/school faculty, chairs, or
coordinators with oversight for the discipline, program, or major. The discipline chair/coordinator
signs the proposal form and indicates their approval/disapproval.
3. The proposal is submitted to chair of the college/school curriculum committee (CC) for committee review.
The college/school CC chair signs the proposal form and indicates the committee’s approval/disapproval.
The proposal is then sent to the college/school dean.
4. The college/school dean confirms review by indicating approval/disapproval and signature. The
proposal is submitted to UC/GC.
a. If college/school dean and curriculum committee are in disagreement, the proposal is sent to UC/GC
for a decision with rationales from both college/school dean and the curriculum committee.
5. UC/GC reviews the proposal. Following UC/GC review, the UC/GC chair communicates the proposal
status/approval decision with initiating parties.
6. UC/GC approved proposals are processed as follows:
a. Category “A” approved proposals are reported to Faculty Senate as informational items.
b. Category “A” approved proposals are forwarded to the Registrar’s Office for processing.
7. Approved proposals are sent to the registrar for official university record keeping and appropriate
action. The registrar shall report back to the UC/GC to confirm processing.
8. At any point in the process, if a proposal is not approved, the non-approving party shall report back to
all approving parties.
Procedures: Category “B” Change
Category “B” changes affect more than one discipline or college/school, or involve the granting of course
credit in a manner other than described in the catalog, and do not result in the creation/elimination of a degree,
degree plan, major, minor. Examples of “B” changes may include: new courses, concentrations, modification
of existing curriculum.
“B” change proposals can be initiated by any individual/group (“initiator”). Because the proposal affects
more than one college/school, the initiator of the proposal must coordinate proposal development with the
involved faculty and college/school dean(s). A letter of support written to the UC/GC chair is required from
the non-proposing college/school dean(s). A complete proposal is processed through the following steps:
1. Initiator develops the written proposal (see the checklist on page 2 of the curriculum processing form for
required proposal components).
2. The completed proposal is submitted for review to all relevant college/school faculty, chairs, or
coordinators with oversight for the discipline, program, or major. The discipline chair/coordinator
signs the proposal form and indicates their approval/disapproval.
a. Proposals should demonstrate coordination among the affected parties that deliver/require the same
courses or programs in multiple delivery modes (e.g., main campus and EAP programs) and/or multiple
locations (e.g., international locations).
3. The proposal is submitted to chair of college/school curriculum committee (CC). The college/school CC
chair signs the proposal form and indicates the committee’s approval/disapproval. The proposal is then
sent to the college/school dean.
4. Thecollege/school dean confirms review by indicating approval/disapproval and signature. The proposal
is submitted to UC/GC.
a. If college/school dean and curriculum committee are in disagreement, the proposal is sent to UC/GC
for a decision with rationales from both college/school dean and the curriculum committee.
5. UC/GC reviews the proposals. The UC/GC chair communicates proposal status/approval decision with
initiating parties.
6. UC/GC approved proposals are processed as follows:
a. Category “B” approved proposals are reported to Faculty Senate as informational items.
b. Category “B” approved proposals are forwarded to the Registrar’s Office for processing.
7. Approved proposals are sent to the registrar for official university record keeping and appropriate action.
The registrar shall report back to the UC/GC to confirm processing.
8. At any point in the process, if a proposal is not approved, the non-approving party shall report back to all
approving parties.
Procedure: Category “C” Change
Category “C” changes affect the UIW undergraduate core curriculum; involve the creation/elimination of
a degree, degree plan, major, minor; or make changes to institutional academic policies or requirements.
“C” change proposals can be initiated by any individual/group (“initiator”). A complete proposal is
processed through the following steps:
1. Initiator develops the written proposal (see the checklist on page 2 of the curriculum processing form for
required proposal components).
2. The completed proposal submitted for review to all relevant college/school faculty, chairs, or
coordinators with oversight for discipline, program, major, or minor. The discipline chair/coordinator
signs the proposal form and indicates their approval/disapproval.
a. Proposals should demonstrate coordination among the affected that deliver/require the same courses
or programs in multiple delivery modes (e.g., main campus and EAP programs) and/or multiple
locations (e.g., international locations).
3. The proposal is submitted to chair of college/school curriculum committee (CC). The college/school CC
chair signs the proposal form and indicates the committee’s approval/disapproval. The proposal is then
sent to the college/school dean.
4. The college/school dean confirms review by indicating approval/disapproval and signature. The proposal
is submitted to CAC (if applicable) or UC/GC.
a. CHANGES THAT AFFECT THE UIW UG CORE CURRICULUM: Proposals signed by the
college/school dean are then forwarded to the Core Advisory Committee (CAC) chair for review.
Following a decision from CAC, the proposal is signed and forwarded to UC.
• For proposals affecting more than one college/school, a letter of support is required from the
non-proposing college/school dean(s).
• If college/school dean(s) and college/school CC(s) are in disagreement, the proposal may be
sent to CAC with rationales for decision from college/school dean(s) and college/school CC(s).
• Following CAC review, the proposal is forwarded to UC.
b. If college/school dean(s) and CC(s) are in disagreement, the proposal is sent to UC/GC for a
decision with rationales from college/school dean(s) and CC(s).
5. UC/GC reviews the proposals. The UC/GC chair communicates proposal status/approval decision with
initiating parties.
6. UC/GC approved proposals are forwarded for processing as follows:
a. Category “C” approved proposals are reported to Senate as an upcoming voting item at the
following Senate meeting with a call for a vote at the subsequent meeting. This allows time for
senators to get feedback from their college/school prior to voting.
b. Following the Senate vote, approved proposals are signed by the Senate president and provost and
are forwarded to the Registrar’s Office for processing.
c. “C” change proposals are reported to the president and Board of Trustees as information items as
deemed appropriate by the provost.
d. The provost may determine that approval of the president or Board of Trustees is needed before
rendering a decision; particularly those proposals which require a financial or resource commitment.
7. Approved proposals are sent to registrar for official university record keeping and appropriate action. The
registrar shall report back to the UC/GC to confirm processing.
8. At any point in the process, if a proposal is not approved, the non-approving party shall report back to all
approving parties.
N.B. If the creation of a new program (degree, degree plan, major, minor) is unrelated to an existing UIW
discipline, a college/school dean will “adopt” the proposal because the proposed new program is most
relevant to that college/school. The college/school dean will create an ad hoc feasibility committee
consisting of faculty with relevant expertise. If the proposed new program is determined to be feasible
by the ad hoc feasibility committee, the proposed new program should be processed according to the
procedures outlined above.
N.B. The elimination of an existing degree, degree plan, major, minor must involve faculty in the
development of a proposal. In consultation with directly-involved faculty, the college/school dean
will create an ad hoc committee of faculty to determine the need to eliminate a program and prepare
a proposal. The proposal will follow the “C” change proposal steps.
N.B. In exceptional circumstances, administration may initiate agreements with external parties to create
new programs, delivery systems, or sites. All curriculum aspects of such programs must be
processed according to the procedures outlined in this chapter.
N.B. All proposals should demonstrate coordination among the affected parties that deliver/require the
same courses or programs in multiple delivery modes (e.g., main campus and EAP programs) and/or
multiple locations (e.g., international locations).
N.B. Procedures for New Degree Plans: The College/School Dean should consult with the Provost to
approve a viable proposal for the addition of a new degree plan. Upon approval of the addition of a
new degree plan by the Dean and Provost, documents will be forwarded to the Undergraduate or
Graduate Council for review and approval. See the Curriculum Processing form for documents
required to be submitted the appropriate Council.
College/School Curriculum Committee Guidelines
(Approved by VPASA, Deans, Curriculum Committee, 7/01; Revised by Curriculum Councils 6/17)
1. Each college/school needs to constitute a curriculum committee organized according to its needs, size
and number of programs. (Examples include: the committee may or may not include faculty who
“represent” others; the committee may be elected, volunteer or be appointed; the whole college/school
may be established as the committee.)
2. The faculty of the college/school should approve the organization of its curriculum committee.
3. One faculty person must be identified by faculty as the chair of the college/school curriculum
committee.
4. Each college/school needs to establish its own process for approval of curriculum. The process for
approving curriculum must protect faculty control of curriculum. The process may or may not include
final approval by a vote of the whole faculty of the college/school.
5. The faculty should approve the process by which curricular decisions are made in their college/
school.
6. While the dean of the college/school plays an important role in the process of assigning changes or
suggestions to the college/school CC for consideration, the college/school CC should deliberate and
reach its recommendation independent of the dean.
7. The organization of the college/school CC and the process used to approve curriculum must be
included in the college/school bylaws presented to Faculty Affairs for information. However, it is not
the role of Faculty Affairs to determine the organization or processes used by any college/school.
Their role is to determine that an organized committee is in place to process curriculum in a manner
that will meet the regulations of the Faculty Handbook.
8. Whatever organization or process is established, the dean of the college/school must sign-off on the
actions of the CC before proposals are forwarded for processing. If there is a difference of opinion
between the dean and the CC, both opinions need to be sent forward.
9. The college/school CC reviews all new courses and programs (including degrees, degree plans,
majors, minors, concentrations, specializations, tracks, etc.) to ensure that they have clearly
articulated student outcomes as well as appropriate assessment procedures and syllabi.
10. School/college curriculum committees should refer to current UC/GC forms/templates and
procedures posted on the Curriculum Councils page of the Faculty Senate Blackboard site. Proposals
must be submitted in accordance with posted timelines to allow sufficient time for UC/GC member
review.
Definition of a Credit Hour
(Approved by the Provost, 7/14)
The semester credit hour is a unit by which an institution measures its course work. The value of a credit hour
can be determined by time, the educational experience, and outside preparation by the student.
The following constitutes the definition of a credit hour for various modes of instruction offered at UIW.
1. At least fifteen (15) contact hours, as well as a minimum of thirty (30) hours of student homework
is required for each credit hour.
2. For online and blended courses, credit hours are assigned based on learning outcomes that are
equivalent to those in a traditional course setting: the combination of direct instruction plus outside
work will equal forty-five (45) hours for each hour of credit.
3. Laboratory courses, with little outside work, require a minimum of forty-five (45) contact hours. If
moderate outside work is required, thirty (30) contact hours are required.
4. Art courses follow the recommendations for awarding credit as recommended by The National
Association of Schools of Art and Design (NASAD) and the Texas Association of Schools of Art
(TASA). In lecture courses, like art history, normally one hour of credit represents one 50-minute
session each week of the term. For studio classes, normally a ratio of one hour of credit = two hours
of contact time and one hour of outside work per week.
5. Music courses follow the recommendations for awarding credit as required by The National
Association of Schools of Music (NASM). Normally, a semester hour of credit represents at least
three hours of work each week for each week of the term. In lecture classes, such as music history,
normally one hour of credit is given for one 50-minute session plus two hours of homework each
week of the term. For ensembles, normally one hour of credit is given for two to four 50-minute
rehearsal sessions per week, depending on the ensemble. For applied lessons, two hours of credit
are awarded for each 60-minute lesson per week with the instructor, plus 7-14 hours of individual
practice outside the lesson.
6. Internships, clinical and field experiences award credit based on established standards and precedent
for specific disciplines; in some cases the ratio of clock to credit hours is specified by
regulatory/accreditation agencies. The following table shows some examples of the ratio of clock
hours to credit hour in various disciplines.
Discipline Experience Ratio of
clock to
credit
hours
Number of clock
hours in 15 week
term
Athletic Training
Education
Clinical practicum 20:1 300
Business
concentrations
Internship 3:1 45
Kinesiology Internship 3:1 45
Nursing Clinical Practicum 4:1 60
Nutrition / Dietetics Internship 16:1 71
Rehabilitation
Sciences
Clinical Practicum 3:1 45
Teacher Education Clinical Teaching 66:1 600
7. For professional clinical doctoral programs the definition of a credit hour may vary in accordance
with established precedent and/or national accreditation standards for specific professional
disciplines. The following table shows some examples.
Discipline /
Accrediting Agency Lecture
Lab Clinic
Optometry
Accreditation Council
on Optometric
Education
1 contact
hour/week = 1
credit
2 contact hours/week
= 1 credit
2 contact hours/week =
1 credit
Pharmacy
Accreditation Council
on Pharmacy
Education
1 contact
hour/week = 1
credit
2 contact hours/week
= 1 credit
40 contact hours/week =
1 credit
Physical Therapy
Commission on
Accreditation of
Physical Therapy
Education
1 contact
hour/week = 1
credit
2 contact hours/week
= 1 credit
80 contact hours/2
weeks = 1 credit
(40 contact hours/week
= 0.5 credit)
112
Flow Diagram for Curriculum Proposals to Undergraduate and Graduate Councils
Notes:
At any point, if proposal not approved, the non-approving party shall report back to all approving
parties.
Proposals affecting both UG and G studies require approval by both councils.
UG/G councils meet monthly and as needed. For most proposals an advance of at least 1 month is
requested to allow time for modifications and approval. For “C” changes an advance of at least 2
months is requested.
Initiator develops proposalSubmits to relevent faculty,
chair/coordinator for approval
Chair/Coordinator approves? Send to Chair of College/School
Curriculum Committee
C/School Committee approves? Send to Dean
Dean approves? Send to UG or Graduate Curriculum Council
•If proposal affects Core send to Core Advisory Council
•If CAC approves, send to UG Curriculum Council
UG or G Council approves?
•If "A" or "B" change, send to registrar for record keeping and appropriate action
•If "C" change: send to Senate
Senate approves "C" change? Send to Provost
Provost approves? send to registrar and President / Board
of Trustees if necessary
113
CHAPTER 8: PART-TIME FACULTY—RIGHTS AND RESPONSIBILITIES (Approved by the Provost, 12/12/08; revised 10/12)
Preface
Part-time faculty provide an invaluable service to UIW. As with all faculty, the challenge is to relate to
students in ways that evidence understanding of the Mission of the Sisters of Charity of the Incarnate Word
and the University of the Incarnate Word. We work together to create a faith-filled learning environment
that promotes individual self-realization and respect for the common good.
This chapter identifies rights and responsibilities of part-time faculty with instructional duties. This refers
to those part-time faculty with the title of lecturer or senior lecturer. The rights and responsibilities of other
part-time faculty who mentor UIW students at clinical and practice sites in the community are identified in
policies and procedures maintained in various deans’ offices.
Types of Part-Time Faculty
a. Senior Part-Time Faculty (with the title of Senior Lecturer): those individuals appointed by the
dean to teach and carry out additional academic duties on a contractual basis (usually for one year).
They are not eligible for promotion or tenure, but may retain rank if already obtained. Academic
freedom is protected. Other rights and responsibilities of part-time faculty are designated in this
Appendix.
b. Part-Time Faculty (with the title of Lecturer): those individuals who teach one or more courses on
a term-to-term basis and are paid by course or by the hour. They are not eligible for promotion or
tenure. Academic freedom is protected. Other rights and responsibilities of part-time faculty are
designated in this Appendix.
c. Part-Time Faculty (with the title of Clinical Adjunct or other relevant titles): those individuals, paid
or volunteers, who serve as mentors of UIW students at clinical and practice sites in the community.
Mentor rights and responsibilities are identified in policies and procedures maintained in various
deans’ offices.
The following is a list of basic instructional duties that apply to part-time faculty (adapted from the
Faculty Handbook, Ch. 5):
1. Utilize outlines based on approved departmental syllabi.
2. Work collaboratively with departmental faculty to ensure standard curriculum outcomes are met.
3. Apply the necessary knowledge, skills, resources, and understanding of current scholarship in
order to achieve the course objectives.
4. Employ methods appropriate to course objectives and be able to modify procedures in response to
unforeseen change when necessary.
5. Utilize a suitable style and effective organization to communicate the course information with
clarity and integrity.
6. Create an environment that will enable the student to achieve the course objectives. 7. Critique his/her own work, using student and faculty evaluations to improve the quality of future
work.
8. Prepare, correct and return tests and assignments within a reasonable time.
9. Properly evaluate student achievement according to criteria communicated to students at the
beginning of each course.
10. Be available outside of class to help students learn and to answer their questions (1 hour per 3-hr.
class, physically and/or electronically).
114
11. Conduct respectful relationships with faculty, staff, and students both in and outside the
classroom.
Also see Ch. 7 of the Faculty Handbook, on Policies/Procedures Related to Instruction that apply to part-
time faculty.
All part-time faculty with instructional duties are subject to the following policies in the handbook and in
the Employee Handbook at the Human Resources organization on Blackboard.
Faculty Handbook Appendices 8: Policy Statement Relating to Misconduct in Science (APPENDIX 8: POLICY STATEMENT
RELATING TO MISCONDUCT IN SCIENCE )
11: Declaration of Affiliation Policy (Declaration of Affiliation Policy)
12: Copyright Policy and Guidelines (APPENDIX 12: COPYRIGHT POLICY AND GUIDELINES )
19: Student Complaints (APPENDIX 19: STUDENT COMPLAINTS )
Employee Handbook on Bb, Chapters
5: Benefits
7: Rules and Conduct
8: Life Threatening Illness Policy
9: Harassment-Free Work and Learning Environment Policy
13: Computer Policy
14: Intellectual Property
Employment Offer
Actual employment (first time and reappointment) is contingent upon successful completion of a required
background check, course availability as determined by the dean in relation to other staffing needs, and
adequate class enrollment. The employment offer is not a guarantee of employment.
Issues During Employment
Part-time faculty who believe they are being treated unfairly or their academic freedom is being violated
by department heads or other faculty may appeal to the college/school dean for resolution of the matter.
Dean decisions may be appealed by the faculty member in writing to the provost or vice president for
extended academic programs (VP), depending on source of employment authorization. The provost or VP
will consider the appeal and make a decision or appoint an ad hoc faculty committee to conduct a hearing
and make a recommendation to the provost or VP; the provost or VP then makes a decision and notifies the
part-time faculty in writing. The provost’s or VP’s decision is final and no further appeal at the university
is available.
Reappointment
Reappointment of part-time faculty is contingent upon acceptable teaching performance. The dean makes
this judgment based on a number of factors including end-of-term Student Assessment of Teaching data,
class observations as appropriate and other input from students if available, and consultation with the
department head. Previous part-time employment does not create an obligation on the part of the university
to offer continued employment.
When possible, written notice of reappointment or non-reappointment will be issued to senior lecturers no
later than one month before the end of the existing appointment.
114
Dismissal Before End of Term
UIW reserves the right to dismiss part-time faculty before the end of the period of appointment based on
the dean’s determination of unsatisfactory performance that is not in the best interests of the students. Prior
to making this decision, the dean will consult with the department head and may request a class observation
with feedback from students. The dean will notify the part-time faculty in writing of the reasons for
dismissal and the date of this notice is used to calculate the amount of salary to be paid as proportionate to
the time actually taught.
The dean’s decision may be appealed by the faculty to the provost or the vice president for extended
academic programs (VP). Within 3 working days of the dean’s notice of dismissal, the part-time faculty
must initiate the appeal with a written statement of complaint forwarded through the dean to the provost or
VP, depending on source of employment authorization. The provost or VP will consider the appeal and
make a decision or will appoint a 3-member subcommittee of the Grievance Committee of the Faculty
Senate to conduct a hearing and make a recommendation to the provost or VP within 7 working days of the
date of the part-time faculty’s letter of appeal. Within 2 more days, the provost or VP makes a decision and
notifies the part-time faculty in writing. The provost’s or VP’s decision is final and no further appeal at the
university is available.
Part-Time Faculty Workload Policy
(Approved by the Provost, May 2014) Effective Date: August 2014
Purpose
To describe the workload limits and calculation for part-time faculty.
Definitions
Part-time faculty: Those individuals who teach one or more courses on a term-to-term basis without
additional academic duties, with a workload equivalent to less than 30 workload units (clock hours)
per week, and who are paid by course or by the hour.
Workload Unit (WLU): the number of clock hours worked each week, calculated week by
week. Part-time faculty workload includes time in the class, time preparing for class, time
attending faculty meetings (if required), and time for office hours. Part-time faculty
members are expected to provide 1 office hour per week for each 3-credit course taught
(UIW Faculty Handbook).
Office hours: time dedicated outside of class for meeting with students. Part-time faculty who teach on-line may conduct office hours electronically.
Narrative
By federal regulation, part-time faculty workload must be calculated week by week. Part-time faculty may
teach up to 29 workload units (WLU) during any given week of any term. This applies to faculty who teach
across divisions, Main Campus and Extended Academic Programs, or any combination of these plus any
of the UIW sponsored high schools.
The WLUs will be included on each Part-time Faculty Payroll Authorization submitted to the Provost or
VP for Extended Academic Programs at the start of each term. Prior to submitting a Payroll
115
Authorization, Deans should determine if part-time faculty are intending to teach in more than one
college/school or division at UIW or the high schools before committing to the workload. If the combined
workload for any period will be 30 WLUs or more, the Deans should confer and work with the faculty
member to reduce the workload.
Part-Time Faculty Workload Calculation
“Lecture” courses (face-to-face or on-line)
Part-time faculty work load units are calculated assuming that for each semester credit hour the faculty
member spends time both in class and out of class.
For a 16-week course, 1 credit hour equates to 1 hour in class and 1.25 hours outside of class per week for
a total of 2.25 workload units (WLU).
Formula: WLU = semester credit hours x 2.25
For an 8-week course, 1 credit hour equates to 2 hours in class and 1.375 hours outside of class per week
for a total of 3.375 WLU.
Formula: WLU = semester credit hours x 3.375
Example for faculty teaching three 16-week courses:
Duty # courses / time required Work load Units
Instruction 3 courses x 3 credits x 2.25 hours 20.25
Office hours 1 hour per course per week 3
Department mtg 1 hour per week (on average thru the term) 1
Total 24.25 WLUs each week
Department meetings may be optional, but if recommended or required must be accounted for in the workload.
So, for the calculated example, the total WLUs are below the 30 WLU limit, and this workload is allowable
for this part-time faculty member.
Example with two 8-week courses:
Duty # courses / time required Work load Units
Instruction 2 course x 3 credits x 3.375 hours 20.25
Office hours 1 hour per course per week 2
Department mtg 1 hour per week 1
Total 23.25 WLUs each week
Note: Faculty can teach two 3-credit courses in this example.
In this example, the total WLUs are below the 30 WLU limit, and this workload is allowable for this part-
time faculty member for each mini-semester; an individual faculty member may teach a total of four 8-
week courses across an entire (16 week) semester.
Options for combining 8-week and 16-week courses
If a part-time faculty member teaches one 16-week (3-credit) course, their workload will allow the addition
of one 8-week course per mini-term, but not two in a single term. The following table works out the
calculation for the first mini-term, to compare both of those cases.
116
One 16-week course, one 8-week course One 16-week course, two 8-week courses in the
same mini-term
3-credit 16-week course 6.75 WLU 3-credit 16-week course 6.75 WLU
3-credit 8-week course 10.125 WLU 1st 3-credit 8-week course 10.125 WLU 2nd 3-credit 8-week course 10.125 WLU
Office hours per week 2 WLU Office hours per week 3 WLU
Department meeting 1 WLU Department meeting 1 WLU
Total 19.875 WLU Total -- over the limit 31 WLU
Similarly, if a part-time faculty member teaches two 16-week (3-credit) courses, their workload will allow
the addition of one 8-week course during each mini-term.
Two 16-week courses, one 8-week course
1st 3-credit 16-week course 6.75 WLU
2nd 3-credit 16-week course 6.75 WLU
3rd 3-credit 8-week course 10.125 WLU
Office hours per week 3 WLU
Department meeting 1 WLU
27.625 WLU
Individual workload calculations need to be done for each semester’s teaching assignments, accounting for
the possibility that one faculty person may teach in more than one college/school or division at UIW or the
high schools. Variations of the calculations, unique to several disciplines, are provided below.
Non-lecture courses
Studio, Lab, clinical, private music lessons or practicum courses have a different ratio(s) of class and
preparation time. For example:
Private Lesson Course In class
workload per
week
Out of class
workload per
week
Total Work Load Units
(average clock hours per
week)
MUAP 1244 (private piano lesson) 1 0.5 1.5 hours per student
No additional office hours required for private lessons
Note: Faculty could teach up to 18 private lessons / week for total of 27 WLU
Studio Course Example
Course In class
workload per week
Out of class
workload per week
Total Work Load Units
(average clock hours per week)
FADS 1320 (studio) 6 6 12 clock hours per week
Office hours 1 per course 1
Note: Faculty could teach two studio classes for total of 26 WLU
Lab Course Example Course In class
workload per
week
Out of class
workload per
week
Total Work Load Units
(average clock hours per
week)
117
BIOL 2122 2.5 1 3.5
Office hours for each section 0.5 0.5
Note: Faculty could teach 7 lab sections for total of 29 WLU
Clinical Course Example Course In clinical
workload per
week
Out of clinical
workload per
week
Total Work Load Units
(average clock hours per
week)
NURS 3510, combined classroom and
clinical with 3 credits to classroom + 2
credits to clinical, part-time faculty is
only teaching clinical portion of course.
8 4 12
Office hours 1 hour per course per week
1
Note: Faculty could teach two clinical sections for 26 WLU
OVERSIGHT RESPONSIBILITIES FOR THIS POLICY
1. Oversight of this policy is assigned to the provost. 2. The policy will be published in the UIW Faculty Handbook.
3. The provost will assure its compliance, and report results to the director of human
resources.
4. This policy will be reviewed annually.
118
APPENDIX 1: ORGANIZATIONAL CHARTS President—Executive Administration
Board of Trustees
President Chancellor
VP/General Council Chief of Staff
Exec Assist/Legal Assist
Director of Human Resources
Provost VP Business &
Finance
VP Enrollment Management & Student Services
VP Institutional Advancement
VP International Affairs
VP Extended Academic Programs
VP Mission & Ministry
VP Information Resources
119
Provost—Academic Administration
VP for Extended Academic Programs
Provost President
Faculty Senate
School of Professional Studies Studies
School of Applied Science
Administraive Assistant
Associate Provost for Civic
Engagement
Associate Provost for Institutional
Effectiveness
Ettling Center for Civic Leadership
Director of Institutional
Research
Office of Sustainability
Director, Center for Teaching and
Learning
Dean
Office of Research & Graduate Studies
Associate Provost and Dean
College of Humanities, Arts
and Social Sciences
Assoc. Prov. & Dean
Dreeben School of Education
Dean
School of Media and Design
Dean
School of Math, Science and Engineering
Dean
HEB School of Business and Administration
Dean
Miller School of Nursing and Health
Professions
Dean
Feik School of Pharmacy
Dean
Rosenberg School of Optometry
Dean
School of Physical Therapy
Dean
School of Osteopathic
Medicine
120
APPENDIX 2: UIW EXCEPTIONS TO THE TERMINAL DEGREE (Policy approved by the Provost, 3/1/13)
Exceptions must be approved by the department, college/school, Faculty Senate, and the provost;
reaffirmation, including minor revisions, must be approved by the college/school and the provost every five
years.
1. Exception to the terminal degree in Accounting: The MBA degree, the Master of Professional
Accountancy, the Master of Science in Accounting, or the equivalent related degree, together with
the Certified Public Accountant certificate and license are considered terminal qualification.
(Approved 10/21/04; Reaffirmed 3/1/13)
2. Exception to the terminal degree in Interior Design: A Master of Fine Arts degree in Interior Design
or Master of Arts in related field with significant industry experience is sufficient for a full-time,
tenure-track position. (Approved 04/26/17)
3. Exception to the terminal degree in the College of Humanities, Arts & Social Sciences: A Master’s
level degree (or equivalent industry experience) is sufficient for a full-time, tenure-track position in
Art, Dance, Music, and Theatre Arts when no standard discipline-specific terminal degree exists or
is not readily available. (Approved 12/3/14)
4. Exception to the terminal degree in the 3D Animation & Game Design: A Master’s level degree (or
equivalent industry experience) is sufficient for a full-time, tenure-track position when no standard
discipline-specific terminal degree exists or is readily available. (Approved 04/26/17)
121
APPENDIX 3: FACULTY DEVELOPMENT FUND REVIEW GUIDELINES (Revised by Faculty Senate, 12/11/09)
Preface
Research in faculty development consistently demonstrates that the development of faculty, the university’s
most important resource, results in enhanced teaching and learning in the classroom. In addition, thinking
of faculty development in terms beyond travel complements the university’s decision to follow the Boyer
Model of Scholarship and expands the concept of institutional support of faculty development beyond travel
funding.
The intent of this policy is to reflect an approach which best supports the maximum number of faculty
participating in one UIW funded faculty development activity per fiscal year. Decisions to approve awards
from the Faculty Development Funds Review Committee (FDFRC) will be based on the type of activity,
the amount of funds requested, whether the faculty member making the request has participated in a UIW-
funded (university or college/school level) during the fiscal year in which the request is being made, and
whether the faculty member has been or will be funded from the main campus department/school for faculty
development activity. Exceptions are appropriate for faculty support received from non-UIW funds such as
grants. Faculty who have access to separate faculty development funds through professional schools or EAP
are not eligible for main campus development funds.
Procedures for the Faculty Development Funds Review Committee
1. The chairperson shall be a full-time faculty member, have previously served on the FDFRC, and
shall be presented on the ballot to the faculty through the Nominations Committee.
2. To apply for funds, the following criteria must be met by the faculty. Each applicant must:
a. Be in a full-time faculty status based on the main campus.
b. Demonstrate a direct link between the proposed activity/project and the applicant’s Faculty
Self Inventory (FSI).
c. Have completed all required “settlement” procedures, according to university policy, for
previously funded travel, in previous years and the current fiscal year.
d. Have a recommendation from the respective dean. e. Provide evidence that UIW funding for faculty development is not available from the
department/school. (Exception can be made for faculty development activities scheduled
for the fourth quarter of the fiscal year.)
3. Terms:
a. National conference: domestic location of a state or national conference.
b. International conference: non-U.S. location of a national or international conference. 4. At the beginning of the fiscal year, the chairperson will forward a copy of the current FDF
application and the FDFRC meeting dates to the Faculty Senate Executive Committee to be posted
on the Faculty Association Blackboard site.
5. At the beginning of the fiscal year, the chair of FDFRC will forward the meeting dates to the Senate
Executive Committee for posting to the Faculty Association Blackboard site. Applications must be
received by the FDFRC chair by the first of the month.
6. Procedure for consideration of applications for funding. Once the FDFRC has determined that the
application for funding has met the criteria in paragraph 2 above, the committee, at the meeting,
will rank proposals according to the following criteria:
a. First priority: Presentation at a conference. b. Second priority: Other professional development activities directly linked to the
individual’s FSI.
122
c. Third priority: Conference attendance for professional development, but without
presentation.
d. Fourth priority: Funds permitting, during the fourth quarter of the academic year,
individuals who have received funds from sources other than the FDF to participate in a
qualified activity during the academic year will be considered.
7. Fiscal year awards shall be limited to the maximum amount of funding for one international
presentation, e.g., $1,500 OR the maximum allowed for domestic presentation, e.g., $1,000, in
order to ensure that FDF funding is available to the greatest number of UIW full-time faculty. The
maximum amount of funding for attendance is limited to the total amount for attending;
consideration can be given to support attendance if the awarded amount does not bring the total
award above the limits to funding as stated above.
8. The minutes of the committee meeting will:
a. Include applications received, reviewed and decisions (awards granted, funds denied and
reason)
b. Indicate awards and amounts previously awarded to a faculty member but not used. The
amounts will be posted to the appropriate fiscal year budget.
c. Provide a running balance of the awarded (encumbered) funds for the fiscal year.
d. Be forwarded to the provost and Accounts Payable after each meeting.
9. Award Letters a. Will be prepared for the applicant to include a cover letter indicating the amount of the
FDF award and directions for access to the award.
b. A copy of the award letter will be sent to the department/college/school dean and secretary.
10. Prior to the monthly meeting, the FDFRC chair will request a report of the total of funds paid to
faculty from Accounts Payable.
11. Monthly, the FDFRC chair will provide a written, updated report to the Senate of the total funds
encumbered and paid to faculty, highlighting the unencumbered balance.
Procedure for Application for FDF
1. The faculty member must forward one copy of the completed application and one copy of the
activity announcement including registration information to the FDFRC chair for consideration at
a FDFRC meeting prior to the date of the faculty development activity.
2. If the request is for funding to support a presentation, include a copy of the letter of acceptance
(LOA) for the presentation. Award can be made contingent upon receipt of the LOA.
3. On the application form, the dean must indicate that the faculty development activity for which
FDF funding is being sought is congruent with the FSI and the extent that department/school
funding is available to fund this request AND whether or not the applicant has received
department/school funding for the purpose of faculty development during the current fiscal year.
4. Policies and procedures for using awarded Faculty Development Funds. a. All air travel arrangements are to be made, following department/school procedures,
through Alamo Travel.
b. The Faculty Development Fund Award (FDFA) letter must be submitted with each
Purchase Order (PO) request for airfare, registration, lodging, etc.
c. Cash advances prior to travel should be requested using the UIW Travel Expense Report,
with a copy of the FDFA letter attached.
d. Immediately notify the FDFRC chair if the award funds will not be used. This allows the
funds to be used by other faculty.
e. Settlement of travel expenses is due within 15 days of the last day of the activity. Failure
to comply with reimbursement procedure can jeopardize your reimbursement.
123
123
FDF Application Process
UIW Faculty Development Funds Review Committee
Date: 2017-2018 Academic Year
To: All Full-Time Faculty
From: Dr. Alberto Rubio, FDFRC Chair
Subject: Faculty Development Funds Application Process
In order to successfully apply and be considered for Faculty Development Funds for this fiscal year*, you must submit the following items to your school’s secretary for submission to the Faculty Development Committee:
The attached FDF application
A copy of the Acceptance Letter (if presenting)
Copy of registration information for the Program/Event (this information should include what is actually covered by Registration fees; e.g. what meals, if any, are included in the registration fee)
Airfare/Mileage/Hotel quote(s) or estimate(s) Submitting your complete application in electronic format would facilitate review by the Committee; the completed application, with all of the above included, may be submitted as an email attachment to the FDFRC account— [email protected]. The Committee cannot review incomplete applications. We thank you for assisting us in helping this process go smoothly. Any questions can be forwarded to the FDFRC Chair. Thank you, The Faculty Development Funds Review Committee *Note: At UIW, the “fiscal year” begins on June 1 and ends the following May 31.
124
124
Faculty Development Funds Application Form last updated: 5 May 2017
Chairperson: Dr. Alberto Rubio INSTRUCTIONS: Please see cover letter for instructions.
Office Phone: (210) 930-8766 UIW Mailbox: CPO 473
Name: Level of Proposed Activity
Phone: Attending a National Conference or Event ($600)
School: Attending an International Conference or Event ($600)
Email: Presenting at a National Conference or Event ($1200)
Status: Full Time Faculty Presenting at an International Conference or Event ($1800)
Sponsoring Organization (Please see cover letter for list of required attachments)
Name of Conference or Event:
Title of Project/Presentation:
Date(s) of Conference or Event
Location of Conference or Event:
Budget (Total requested expenses for travel to the conference or event above)
Travel: Airfare: Car Miles: x $0.565/mile (or current rate) Total Transportation: $
Lodging: No. of Nights: Cost per night: Total Lodging: $
Meals: $40/day x days (or current per diem) Total Meals: $
Note: Faculty development funds cannot be applied to membership fees. Total Registration: $
Total Expenses: $
Have you received support from Faculty Development funds in the current fiscal year (June 1 –May 31)?: No Yes (see below)
If “Yes” please list below:
Conference/Event: Date: Amount: $
Have you completed the General Travel Expense Report? No Yes
Impact on Faculty Self Inventory (FSI) Describe the impact of your proposed activity on teaching, scholarship, professional development and/or
service as described in your current FSI (use additional sheet if needed).
Dean’s Recommendation Describe how proposed activity is related to current FSI (use additional sheet if needed).
Is funding for this activity available from other sources?: No Yes Source: Amount: $
Is funding available from the Department? No Yes Amount: $
Signature of Applicant: Date:
Signature of Dean: Date:
125
125
FDF COMMITTEE APPROVED: NO YES AMOUNT AWARDED: $ DATE:
Application No.: 1 or 2 for fiscal year 2017-2018
126
126
APPENDIX 4: FACULTY AWARD REPORTING FORM
Faculty receiving institutional financial support are required to complete this form to document work
completed for institutional assessment and program effectiveness and to retain eligibility for future awards.
Attach a single copy of all written materials (book chapters, journal articles, abstracts, posters, grant
applications, etc.) completed as a result of the award. Please submit this form and its attachments within
four weeks of the completion of the award period to the School of Graduate Studies and Research.
Please type or print
1. Name Date
2. UIW Office # P.O. Box Phone Email
3. Indicate the award program from which you received institutional financial support
Faculty Sabbatical Award Faculty Workload Redirection Award
Faculty Research Endowment Award
Graduate Research Assistantship Award
4. List the principal aims and objectives of your award 1.
2.
3.
5. Describe the progress achieved during the award period on your stated principal aims and objectives
1.
2.
3.
Please indicate the year that work completed was reported on your FSI:
6. Further Comments
7. I indicate that the information contained on this form is accurate and complete.
Signature
127
127
APPENDIX 5: FACULTY AWARDS SUMMARY (Approved by the Provost, 12/9/09; see individual award announcement for details)
Award Given by Eligibility Application
or Nomination
Due
Date
Sent to Selection
Body
Celebration Award Additional
Responsi- bilities
Mission
Continues
Faculty Awards (up to
5 annually):
Innovation, Truth,
Education,
Service, Faith
Faculty FT Faculty Nomination
Minimum of 3
nominations
per award must be
received for
that award to be given in
any year.
Nominations
to be carried forward to
subsequent
years if not selected as recipient.
Oct 15
VP- Mission
Effective-
ness
Faculty sub- group
of UIW
Mission
Committee and Faculty
Senate
President
Piper/Conne
lly and
Mission Continues
Award
Reception (Opening
Faculty
Ceremony, Spring
Semester)
Annually, one
plaque
displaying winners for
each
value;
Individual
winners receive
a door
plaque
None
Piper Professor
Award
Nomination
Faculty Faculty
with
excellence in teaching
and service
to the university
and the
community
1 nomination
from each
college/ school
Sept 1
president
of
Faculty Senate
Faculty Senate Piper/Connelly Reception
$1,000 Piper Foundation
Awards;
$5,000 if nominee is
chosen as a
state- wide winner + gold pin
Apply for the
Statewide
Piper Award
Robert J.
Connelly
Leadership Award
Faculty
Senate
FT Faculty
with 15 or
more years of service
at UIW
Nomination Nov
15
president
of
Faculty Senate
Past
presidents
Group
Piper/Conne
lly and
Mission Continues
Award
Reception
$1,000 Winners
listed on
plaque on the Legacy Wall
none
CCVI Spirit Award
Mission Committee
Any member of
UIW
community
Nomination Feb 15
VP Mission
and
Ministry
Mission Committee
Incarnate
Word
Day
$500 to a CCVI
sponsored
charity; award
sculpture for the year
none
Presidential
Teaching
Award
UIW president
All UIW Faculty
Nomination Mar 1
Office
of the
Provost
Finalists
selected
by PTA
committee; Final
Selection by president
Faculty
Appreciat
ion Luncheon
$5000 Submit
current vita
and short statement by
March 15
Moody Professor-
ship
Moody Foundation
Senior Faculty:
Teaching
Scholarship Service
1 nomination from each
college/
school
Mar 15
president of
Faculty
Senate
Faculty Senate Faculty Appreciat
ion
Luncheon
$2000 Stipend
2 public lectures
(UIW &
OLLU);
December
Graduation Speaker
128
128
Ed
Zlotkowski
Service Learning
Award
Faculty
Senate
Full time
faculty
nomination Mar
1
Ettling
Center
for Civic Ldrshp
Service Learning
Committee
Faculty
Appreciat
ion Luncheon
$500 and winner listed on plaque displayed in college/school
none
129
129
APPENDIX 6: OPTIONAL FACULTY RETIREMENT INCENTIVE PROGRAM (Approved 10/21/08)
1. Short History
Several plans of other universities presented by faculty
Presented plan alternative to Executive Council
Presented plan alternative to deans, and Faculty Senate
Presented plan alternative to legal counsel
Presented concept to the Board of Trustees and approved
2. Qualifications
Tenured Faculty (or tenured administrators)
Reach 20 yrs. full-time service between ages of 63 to 68 by 8/1 of next academic year, or
Reach 15 yrs. full-time service between ages of 63 to 67 by 8/1 of next academic year, or
Reach 10 yrs. full-time service between ages of 63 to 66 by 8/1 of next academic year, or
Faculty members beyond the maximum age are qualified only during the initial year
(which is this year, 2008-09) of the plan (and not beyond)
Notification of retirement by December 15 of full retirement at year end May 15th of
phased retirement
3. Objective
Incentive for tenured faculty to retire in their mid-sixties
Plan benefits reduced after age 66 and to none after age 68 (except during
implementation)
Provide flexibility in retirement planning
Affordable for the university
4. Optional Teaching – Immediate or Phased Retirement
Reduced teaching load at contract pay rates (each course contract salary divided by 8
courses)
With 20 years of service, can phase out teaching over 3 or fewer years
With 15 years of service, can phase out teaching over 1 or 2 years
With 10 years of service, can do 1 year reduced teaching
See attached schedule, by age and years, for maximum courses
After maximum load is taught, retired faculty may be hired as part-time faculty at regular
summer rates
5. Incentives
Maximum retirement payment incentive of 75% of faculty base with 20 years, 50% with
15 years and 25% with 10 years
See attached schedule, by age and years, for exact percentage of base
Incentive payments made in 2 installments: one half June 30th after plan elected and
second half the following January 31st
6. Grandfather Provision – Tenured faculty, beyond age 66 by August 1, 2009 (this first year the plan
is available) will be offered the plan on the same basis as if they were age 66 by August 1, 2009
130
130
7. Complement Emeriti Health Insurance Plan
Participant may remain on the university health plan until age 65 or while teaching
Retirees can enroll in the Emeriti plan at age 65 however may not actively participate in
the plan while teaching at the university in any capacity.
8. TIAA-CREF Retirement Plan
All incentives and compensation qualify for the retirement plan, including university
match
Unless retiree starts to draw annually under the plan (cannot contribute and draw at same
time)
9. Termination, Tenure Issues
Termination will occur upon completing the last class under the agreement
Until termination occurs plan participant enjoys same rights, privileges and status as
tenured faculty
Upon electing the benefit, tenured right to continuous rolling contract ends
10. Schedule of Incentive Payments and Option Teaching by year of service and age:
Service Years Age 63-66 67 68 10 25%--4 crs’s, 1 yr
11 30%--4 crs’s, 1 yr
12 35%--5 crs’s, 1 yr
13 40%--6 crs’s, 1 yr
14 45%--6 crs’s, 1 yr
15 50%--8 crs’s, 2 yrs 25%--4 crs’s, 1 yr
16 55%--8 crs’s, 2 yrs 30%--4 crs’s, 1 yr
17 60%--9 crs’s, 2 yrs 35%--5 crs’s, 1 yr
18 65%--10 crs’s, 2 yrs 40%--6 crs’s, 1 yr
19 70%--11 crs’s, 2 yrs 45%--6 crs’s, 1 yr
20 75%--12 crs’s, 3 yrs 50%--8 crs’s, 2 yrs 25%--4 crs’s, 1 yr
Optional Faculty Retirement Incentive Program Examples
On the following page are examples. Salaries of $80,000 and $60,000 at retirement are assumed. The
salaries determine the amount of the incentive payment and how much will be paid per course under the
plan.
131
131
Age 63-66/ 20 years $80,000 (75% is $60,000)
Year 1 Year 2 Year 3 All Years
Incentive Payment 60,000 - - 60,000 Teaching Courses 6 4 2 12 Teaching Salary 60,000 40,000 20,000 120,000 Total Payment 120,000 40,000 20,000 180,000
Age 63-66/ 15 years $80,000
Year 1 Year 2 Year 3 All Years
Incentive Payment 40,000 - - 40,000 Teaching Courses 4 4 - 8 Teaching Salary 40,000 40,000 - 80,000 Total Payment 120,000 40,000 - 120,000
Age 63-66/ 20 years $60,000 (75% is $45,000)
Year 1 Year 2 Year 3 All Years
Incentive Payment 45,000 - - 45,000 Teaching Courses 6 4 2 12 Teaching Salary 45,000 30,000 15,000 90,000 Total Payment 90,000 30,000 15,000 135,000
Age 63-66/ 15 years $60,000
Year 1 Year 2 Year 3 All Years
Incentive Payment 30,000 - - 30,000 Teaching Courses 4 4 - 8 Teaching Salary 30,000 30,000 - 60,000 Total Payment 60,000 30,000 - 90,000
132
132
APPENDIX 7: POLICY CONCERNING SALARIES FUNDED BY GRANTS (Approved by the Executive Council, 8/17)
Full-time faculty with nine-month appointments may request compensation for work on a sponsored grant
or project during the summer months, contingent on the limits of the sponsoring organization. Faculty with
nine-month appointments are permitted to work a maximum of three months of compensated effort during
the summer. Compensation for faculty members by a sponsored project is calculated at the rate of 1/9th of
the individual's annual academic base salary (ABS) rate up to a maximum of 3/9th of the academic salary
for summer work. The summer salary is based on the new ABS salary rate that goes into effect for the fiscal
year that begins on June 1st of that summer. Fringe benefits must be included in the summer salary
calculations.
Summer salary chargeable to grants and contracts is limited to that effort actually expended to the purposes
of the grant or contract. Faculty may charge salary for up to three full summer months however UIW will
not provide compensation to faculty while they are on vacation. Therefore, faculty members who take
vacation may not be paid for 100% of effort during that month. Additionally, faculty requesting three
months summer salary at 100% effort on a sponsored project will not be compensated for non-project
activities (teaching, advising, administrative work).
Faculty who will work on non-project activities (teaching, advising, administrative work) or wish to take
vacation will normally be compensated for two months (2/9th) sponsored compensation. Additionally, if
non-project activities and vacations are limited, faculty can be compensated for up to 2.7/9th (90% effort)
sponsored compensation. The non-sponsored activities will be compensated at the normal UIW faculty
summer rate.
Summer salaries are paid in two payments, June and July.
Sponsored project funding may not be used during the summer months to pay for work performed during
the academic year.
Faculty receiving summer salary above 2/9th must submit a projected time and effort report to the academic
dean by March 31st. The report should document how the faculty member will spend his/her time on one or
more sponsored projects and give specific start and end dates to include vacation. The request will include
the amount requested, percent effort charged to the contract or grant, objectives to be accomplished and
other duties and responsibilities that are not to be charged to the grant or contract (teaching, advising,
administrative work).
This request will be submitted in writing and must be approved in advance by the dean. All requests must
be routed to the Office of Grants Accounting for verification of sponsor approval.
133
133
APPENDIX 8: POLICY STATEMENT RELATING TO MISCONDUCT IN SCIENCE (Approved by the President, 3/95)
The University of the Incarnate Word strives to create a research climate that promotes faithful adherence
to high ethical standards in the conduct of scientific research without inhibiting the productivity and
creativity of the scientist or academician. Misconduct in science is an offense that damages not only the
reputation of those involved, but also that of the entire educational community.
Misconduct in science means fabrication, falsification, plagiarism, or other practices that materially deviate
from those that are commonly accepted within the scientific community for proposing, conducting, or
reporting research. It does not include honest errors or honest differences in interpretations or judgments of
data.
Misconduct in science is a major breach of the relationship between a faculty or staff member and the
institution. In order to maintain the integrity of research projects, every investigator must keep a permanent
auditable record of all experimental protocols, data and findings. Co-authors on research reports of any type
must have had a bona fide role in the research and must accept responsibility for the quality of the work
reported.
Any inquiry or investigation of allegations of misconduct in science must proceed promptly and with due
regard for the reputation and rights of all individuals involved.
The university will take all reasonable steps to assure that the persons involved in the evaluation of the
allegations and evidence have appropriate expertise and that no person involved in the procedure is either
biased against the accused person(s) or has a conflict of interest.
Procedures for Addressing Misconduct in Science
Allegations of misconduct in science should be brought to the attention of the appropriate program director
or dean, or if such allegations involve a program director or dean, they should be brought to the attention
of the provost. The program director, dean, or, in the case of allegations made against the program director
or dean, a person designated by the provost or the provost, will bring such allegations to the attention of the
principal investigator of the research program and any researchers affected by the allegations. The program
director, dean, or person designated by the provost, with due regard for the reputations of all parties
involved, will immediately conduct an inquiry into the allegations. The inquiry must be completed within
sixty (60) calendar days unless circumstances clearly warrant a longer period, in which case the inquiry
record must include documentation of the reasons for exceeding the 60-day period.
At the conclusion of the inquiry, a written report shall be prepared and delivered to the provost. The report
will include a description of the evidence reviewed, a summary of relevant interviews, and a statement of
the conclusion(s) reached, together with the rationale for such conclusion(s). The report shall be
accompanied by all written statements, data, or other evidence considered during the inquiry. The provost
shall provide the person(s) against whom the allegations have been made with a copy of the report and
request that any comment in response be made within ten (10) days.
The provost, with such advice or consultation as may be deemed appropriate, shall review the inquiry report,
the inquiry record, and the comments (if any) of the person(s) accused of misconduct and recommend to
the president either that:
134
134
1. The allegations are unfounded and that no further proceedings are warranted, or 2. There is substantive evidence to support the truth of the allegations, and that hearing procedures to
discipline or terminate the accused person(s) should commence pursuant to the established due
process procedures of the university. Such hearing procedures constitute the “investigation”
required by Public Health Service (PHS) rules in those cases involving funding from that agency.
The hearing must begin within thirty (30) days after the conclusion of the inquiry.
If it is determined that the alleged misconduct is not substantiated, diligent efforts will be undertaken by
the university to continue to protect the reputation of the accused person(s) and also to protect the position
and reputation of the person(s) who, in good faith, made the allegations.
In the event that the allegations are admitted by the accused person(s), or the hearing procedures result in a
determination that the allegations of misconduct are true, the university will notify the sponsoring agency
of the facts related to the allegations, the conclusions reached, and the penalty imposed by the university.
In addition, notice will be given to the editors of all journals to which articles related to the affected research
have been submitted.
Additional Procedures for Allegations of Misconduct in Science Related to Public Health Service
Projects
In the event that allegations of misconduct in science are made with regard to an existing grant or application
for or a grant of funds for research, research training, a research-related activity, or a cooperative agreement
under the PHS Act, the following action must be taken:
1. Notify the Office of Extramural Research/Grants Compliance and Oversight of the Office of the
Director of the National Institutes of Health (NIH), when it appears at any time during the inquiry
or other procedures that:
a. An immediate health hazard is involved; b. There is an immediate need to protect Federal funds or property or to protect the interests of
the persons(s) making the allegations or of the person(s) against whom allegations have been
made and/or their co-investigators;
c. It is probable that the alleged misconduct will be made public; d. Reasonable information exists indicating that there has been a criminal violation, in which case
the OSI must be notified within 24 hours of obtaining such information.
2. Notify the OSI that a decision has been made to initiate disciplinary or termination procedures (the
“investigation” under the PHS rules), including the name of the person(s) against whom the
allegations of misconduct have been made, the general nature of the allegations, and the PHS
application or grant number(s) involved.
3. Notify the OSI of any decision that an inquiry or other procedure based upon the allegations will
not be pursued to completion together with the reasons for such decision.
4. Provide the OSI with a final report of any disciplinary or termination procedure, including a
description of such procedures, the sanction imposed, how and from whom relevant information
was obtained, the conclusions reached, the basis for such conclusions, and any statement or views
of the person(s) found to have engaged in misconduct.
135
135
APPENDIX 9: RESEARCH ACTIVITIES PERFORMED BY OUTSIDE
ORGANIZATIONS
The University of the Incarnate Word will use the following guidelines in considering requests from an
outside organization to perform research activities at the university.
1. University faculty research must have priority over all private-sector research with respect to all
resources including facilities, equipment, services, and personnel.
2. The services that are to be provided to the outside organization should be for stated periods of time
rather than permanent.
3. The research being conducted in the university facilities must be within the research mission of at
least one of the university programs.
4. The university will receive reimbursement for all costs associated with each individual project.
Such reimbursement shall include incremental costs incurred by the university as a result of the use
plus the appropriate indirect costs for sponsored projects.
5. All organizations proposing to use university resources must have a sponsoring program that is
willing to certify to at least the following:
a. The department has the space available for the outside organization to perform the project.
b. The project will not detract from any of the department’s functions or activities. c. The department will be responsible for all administrative details relating to the proposed
company’s use of the facilities, such as obtaining temporary parking permits through campus
security, arranging for keys, etc.
d. If resources for which the university has an obligation to a third party are to be used, the
sponsoring program director or his/her designee will be responsible for the conduct of the
outside company relating to those resources.
6. All such arrangements should be subject to a business agreement to be negotiated by the Office of
the vice president for business and finance upon the recommendation of the sponsoring program
director, appropriate dean, and vice president, with final approval by the provost.
136
136
APPENDIX 10: PROFESSIONAL ETHICS COMPLAINT PROCEDURES
Procedure for an Informal Complaint.
a. Professional ethics complaints alleging faculty behavior inconsistent with institutional fit
guidelines should be directed to the faculty member’s dean. Initially, the dean may suggest that the
complaining party meet with the accused party to express concerns about the alleged behavior. A
major purpose of the informal complaint procedure is to resolve problems, heighten awareness, and
achieve changes in behavior, if necessary, without resort to formal investigatory or disciplinary
proceedings. If the meeting of the parties does not provide a resolution or the complaining party
gives reasons for not making such contact, the dean shall begin an informal investigation.
b. The dean shall consider the degree of seriousness of the accusation and evaluate the validity of the
complaint. To resolve the matter, the dean shall meet with the accused party, provide the identity
of the complaining party, and disclose the nature of the complaint. The accused party may then
present a response. The dean may investigate the matter further, with careful attention given to
mitigating or aggravating circumstances.
c. Upon reaching a decision, the dean has three directions for action:
1) Report to the parties that the incident did not constitute a violation of the fit guidelines, or
2) Report to the parties that a violation of fit guidelines has been found, requiring a warning. The
dean shall clarify to the accused party the objectionable behavior, secure cessation of such
behavior, and caution that repetition of such conduct could lead to formal investigation and
sanctions, or
3) Report to the parties that a violation of fit guidelines has been found that warrants the dean’s
initiation of a formal complaint. The dean shall inform the accused party of findings that show
a sufficient degree of seriousness or pattern of behavior that requires consideration by the
provost. The dean will initiate a formal complaint.
d. To the extent that the complaining party is dissatisfied with the resolution of the informal complaint,
a formal complaint may be filed.
e. The dean shall preserve documentation reflecting the results of processing any informal inquiry.
Procedure for a Formal Complaint.
f. If a professional ethics accusation cannot be resolved through the informal complaint process, the
dean or an accusing party may initiate a formal complaint by submitting to the provost a written
description of the offensive behavior and the surrounding circumstances. (Complaints against a
dean are submitted directly to the provost.) Upon receipt of the complaint, the provost shall provide
the accused party with a copy of the statement and identity of the party making the complaint.
g. Investigation. The provost will conduct an investigation or appoint an ad hoc committee composed
of three tenured faculty members (or faculty with multi-year renewable-term appointments in
schools without tenure) to investigate the allegations and to recommend sanctions, if any, or may
recommend that the complaining party take the complaint to the Grievance Committee if
appropriate. In the case of an appointed ad hoc committee, the accused
137
137
party shall have one opportunity to remove, without stated cause, one member of the committee.
The provost will replace the removed faculty member with a qualified alternate. Documentation
from any informal complaints will be provided to the committee for review purposes.
Members of the committee will meet to consider the complaint. Unless the committee concludes
that the complaint is without merit, the parties to the dispute shall be invited to appear before the
committee and to confront any adverse witnesses. Each party to the dispute may invite one UIW
faculty member to be present in an advisory capacity. Advising faculty take no part in presenting
facts or examining witnesses before the committee. The committee may conduct its own informal
inquiry, call witnesses, and gather whatever information it deems necessary to assist it in reaching
a determination as to the merits of the allegations. The senior faculty member of the committee
shall communicate in writing its decision to both parties, along with a summary of the basis for the
determination. The provost shall preserve documentation reflecting the results of any formal
investigations.
h. Recommended Sanctions. In determining whether a recommendation of sanctions is appropriate,
the committee must consider the seriousness of the offense, the context in which the incident
occurred, any mitigating or aggravating circumstances, and any history of past offenses of a related
nature. If sanctions are recommended, the committee’s written report and the recommendation for
sanctions will be sent to the accused party and the provost.
Recommended sanctions may include (but are not limited to) the following: written reprimand,
imposition of a fine only as an alternative to suspension without pay, restitution, restrictions on the
individual’s participation in research or other projects, reassignment of duties, mandatory training,
additional supervision, probation, or suspension, with or without partial pay, for a definite period
of time.
Within 30 days of receiving a written report from the ad hoc committee, the accused party may
request reconsideration through the Grievance Committee (Article X - Grievance Committee). The
provost decision will conclude the formal complaint process including any reconsideration done by
the Grievance Committee. No further appeal at the university is available.
138
138
APPENDIX 11: PUBLIC WRITING/SPEAKING POLICIES
Declaration of Affiliation Policy (Approved by the Board, 10/01; revised by the President, 9/07)
The University of the Incarnate Word recognizes that freedom of speech and academic freedom are an
integral part of our country and the university community. The Board of Trustees has the responsibility of
protecting the integrity and the reputation of the university. It is the policy of the Board of Trustees to
recognize that members of the administration, faculty or staff have the right to free speech. Should any
individual desire to use the name of the university or show any affiliation with the university in any print,
newspaper column, editorial piece, or electronic medium, he/she is required to submit the proposed
comments or article for approval of the use of the university name or affiliation, to the president of the
university prior to submission. The individual will be notified within two working days about the decision.
This policy does not extend to items placed in professional journals and publications or to being interviewed
by the news media as an expert in a discipline.
Public Speakers Policy
(Approved by the President, 9/11/08)
This policy on public speakers refers to presentations or performances that are intended for or open to the
entire university or to the general public. It does not refer to or diminish the right of faculty to invite guest
speakers to a class. As stated in the Faculty Handbook, “Instructors may schedule off-campus speakers to
appear before classes. However, the instructor in charge of the class is completely responsible for the
acceptability of such a speaker and his or her relevance to the course.” This policy likewise recognizes the
right of student organizations to hear presentations that reflect the interests for which the group was
established.
The University of the Incarnate Word is committed to its role as an academic institution in which a variety
of ideas can be responsibly presented and critically examined. As the mission of our institution states: “The
University of the Incarnate Word is a Catholic institution that welcomes to its community persons of diverse
backgrounds, in the belief that their respectful interaction advances the discovery of truth, mutual
understanding, self-realization, and the common good.” Because the university is a teaching/learning
community, it provides a forum for speakers and performances that will be of interest and benefit primarily
to our students, the leaders of tomorrow, and faculty, and in some cases, the general public. The goal is to
encourage reasoned and respectful discussion about serious issues of the day, without the expectation of
total agreement in the end.
The University of the Incarnate Word, as a not-for-profit institution, is obliged to comply with federal and
state regulations which prohibit the support of political candidates, political parties or political positions
pending before legislative bodies. The university does not sponsor programs designed to raise funds for
political candidates, parties, or positions. UIW provides equal access to candidates and political opinions
to stimulate the kind of debate that will educate our students about political agendas and issues that are
important in the electoral process.
The university values its identity as a Catholic university sponsored by the Sisters of Charity of the Incarnate
Word. It seeks to balance diverse theological opinions within the Catholic community but does
139
139
not provide a platform for attack or derision directed to the Catholic Church, its governance or doctrine or
any other religions, beliefs or practices. It does provide the space and opportunity to address difficult
contemporary questions and does this in a way that advances understanding and does not silence contrary
opinion.
Procedures:
1. When an invitation to a speaker or performance group is being seriously considered, and before an
invitation or contract is initiated, the department, student organization or individuals planning the
event, will give their dean or the dean of student life the information about speaker, topic, etc.
2. If the dean in discussion with the director, or faculty advisor sees no connection to or conflict with
the UIW Speakers Policy, the event is cleared and the department, student organization or
individuals planning the event may proceed.
3. If the dean, after discussion with the director, or faculty advisor has concerns about the speakers or
presenters involved or the content or topic being addressed, the next step will be to discuss the
matter with the provost, who in turn will seek guidance from knowledgeable experts on campus.
4. In light of the UIW Speakers Policy, and after sufficient dialogue, the provost will make a
determination about whether or not an invitation should be extended.
5. In the event of disagreement about the decision of the provost, the president of the university will
be consulted.
140
140
APPENDIX 12: COPYRIGHT POLICY AND GUIDELINES
Copyright Law and Fair Use Guidelines: What Educators Need to Know
Prepared by Cheryl A. Anderson, Ph.D.
(Revised, 4/20/12)
In 1995, the University of the Incarnate Word (UIW) passed an institutional copyright policy. Educating
faculty about what they can and cannot copy for use in instruction is an important aspect of implementing
such a policy. Since 1995, the use of new technologies has resulted in additional legislation affecting use
of copyrighted materials on the Internet and in distance learning. The following information may help you
in your teaching.
Copyright Laws
The Federal Copyright Act of 1976 synthesized prior statues, common law and constitutional provisions
that were established to protect the rights of authors and artists have to print, copy, publish and sell their
works. In 1976, the law was extended beyond the printed word to all mediums including: sound recordings,
film, videotape (now DVDs), photographs, plays, choreographic work and pictorial, graphic, and sculptural
works. In 1980, literary work status was extended to computer software. Copyright protects "any original
work that is fixed in some tangible medium of expression" (17, U.S.C. Section 102(a)). An author's rights
cover his or her lifetime plus 50 years. The Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act of 1998 extended
this to 75 years beyond the death of the author or creator for works created after 1978.
Copyright law protects the author from the moment an item is created. There is no need for an author to
register a work with the U.S. Copyright Office. A work does not have to be “published” anywhere to be
protected by copyright law. In addition, published works that are out of print may still be protected from
copying, depending upon who owns the copyright.
A copyright violator can be sued for loss of profits as well as statutory damages up to $50,000 and payment
of attorney fees. In 1982, the law was amended to include a maximum fine of $250,000 and a jail term of
up to 5 years for those who seek to make a financial profit from the violation.
The Clinton Administration made the recommendation that the Copyright Act be changed to cover materials
that are electronically distributed over the Internet. This resulted in the Digital Millennium Act of 1998,
which prohibited the use of products designed to “crack” codes that protect and secure copyrighted works.
This act also protected online service providers from being held responsible for violations committed by
users. Libraries were given rights to preserve and store information in digital format under certain
circumstances. In addition, the Copyright Office was charged to investigate the issues related to copyright
and distance education because until a recent change in the law the fair use guidelines only covered “face-
to-face” instruction. In 2002, the TEACH Act was enacted which expanded a faculty members ability to
use copyrighted material in a distance learning setting if it directly related to the curriculum and represented
“reasonable and limited portions” of the material.
Fair-Use Doctrine
The Copyright Act of 1976 recognized that there may be times when the exclusive rights of a copyright
owner should be limited, particularly when the material is being used for educational purposes by non-
profit organizations. Therefore, Congress asked the register of Copyright to develop specific guidelines to
cover such instances. These are known as the "Fair Use Guidelines." These guidelines were established
in an agreement with representatives from the publishing industry (music, print, and media)
141
141
and a Congressional Committee called the Ad Hoc Committee of Educational Institutions and
Organizations on Copyright Law Revisions. Fair use of copyrighted material depends on the following:
The character and purpose of the use (whether it is for commercial or not-for-profit):
The nature of the work (the type of materials i.e. print, video etc.);
The amount of work copied in relation to the a body of work as a whole, and
The effect of the use of the copied material on the market (depriving someone of profits from the sale
of material).
Print Materials
A single copy may be made of a chapter, an article, a short story, poem or essay, a chart, graph, diagram,
drawing, cartoon, or picture from one book, periodical or newspaper.
Multiple copies (not exceeding one per student) may be made if the action meets three tests: (1) brevity
and spontaneity, (2) cumulative effects and (3) each copy includes a notice of copyright (name of
author, date, publication).
Brevity: a poem or excerpt less than 250 words and no more than two pages; prose less than 2500 words
or for excerpts from works of less than 1000 words - no more than 10% of the work. Spontaneity:
meaning there is insufficient time to write for permission to use the work.
Cumulative Effect: meaning that copying may only be done in one course, only one copy (two excerpts)
per author; no more than three copies from a collection of work and no more than nine instances of
multiple copying for one class during one term. Copies from print material may not be made in an effort
to create, replace or substitute for collective works. Multiple copies may not be made of consumable
items i.e. tests, workbooks. Copies should not be a substitution for purchasing. This action is not to be
repeated from term to term.
Audio Materials
Copies of music may be made on a temporary basis if a replacement has been ordered. Excerpts of
works may be made, but not to exceed more than 10% of the whole work (one copy per pupil).
One audio recording of an evaluative or rehearsal performance by students may be done (the institution
or the instructor may keep the recording). Also, a copy (1) of a copyrighted sound recording may be
made from one owned by the university or the instructor for the purpose of preparing exercises and
examinations. However, an audiotape may not be made from a record or a compact disc for permanent
use.
Audio material may not be copied in an effort to create, replace or substitute for collective works.
An entire sheet of music may not be copied because it deprives the composer of royalties. A teacher
may make copies of excerpts (not) to exceed 10% of the work) for each student. The teacher may also
make one copy of out-of-print works for his or her own scholarly research. Pieces may be simplified
but not so distorted that the character of the piece is changed.
Recording musical performances requires written permission from the professional musicians as well
as the publisher/composer of the music. Most institutions seek licenses for all work that is performed
in public.
Recorded music at social occasions is not allowed nor is playing music through a public address system
to multiple rooms without a license.
Video Materials
Off-air video recordings of commercial broadcast transmissions may be made by a non-profit institution
and kept for 45 days after the date of the recording. Permission to use the recording must
142
142
then be sought or the recording must be erased. A limited number of copies of the off-air recording
may be duplicated for the use of other instructors under the 45-day retention period.
No pay-for-view programs (HBO, Cinemax etc.) may be recorded and shown in class. Television news
broadcasts may be recorded.
Educational television programs (PBS) may be recorded and kept for seven days unless otherwise
specified by the station. These off-air recordings must be at the request of and used by an individual
instructor. A program may be recorded only one time for that instructor no matter how many times it is
transmitted. The instructor may record a program at home; however, the use and 45-day guidelines still
apply. The copyright notice must appear on the tape.
Within the first 10 teaching days following the broadcast, the recording must be shown once and may
be repeated once again for review.
Video recordings may not be edited or altered in any way. The recording may not be combined with
other video material.
Video material may not be copied in an effort to create, replace or substitute for collective works.
Archival copies of copyrighted programs may not be made. In addition, commercial products should
not be transferred from one format to another without the written permission of the publisher.
Recording off satellite may only be done with written permission or if a license has been purchased.
Because private satellite transmissions are protected under the Federal Communications Act, the Fair
Use Guidelines do not apply.
Use of a rental recording in the classroom is permissible if it is shown only by the teacher in a "face-
to-face" class session in a place dedicated to instruction. The course must be for academic credit.
Finally, video recordings may not be shown over closed circuit systems to multiple classrooms within
the same building or at multiple sites.
Computer Software
Back-up copies of software are permitted for archival purposes if provided for in the licensing
agreement. In general, the rule is one program on a single machine. Multiple copies of a program may
be made and placed on a number of computers if licensed to do so. Each licensing agreement is
different; therefore, it is necessary to read the agreement that comes with the package. For example,
some agreements allow the user to place the software on a laptop or on a computer at home and some
do not.
Electronic Scanning
Electronic scanning of books, text, graphics and photographs may be done only for research purposes
but not if the work is to be altered or manipulated in anyway. Otherwise permission must be sought
from the creator. Students may scan items as a learning experience, but the file must be erased.
Dramatic Works
Licenses must be sought to perform dramatic works publicly. However, students may perform works
in class. The performance must only be for the teacher and the other students enrolled in the course.
Student Projects
Students may use copyrighted materials in the creation of work for class assignments. The product must
remain the property of the student and may not be kept by the teacher or institution. In addition, the
product may not be shown outside of the class.
143
143
Filmstrips and Slide Sets
Written permission must be sought in order to copy filmstrips or slides. Recording an entire set of
slides or a filmstrip onto another medium such as videotape without permission is prohibited.
Fair Use at a Glance
Media Fair Use Guideline
Chart, cartoon, photograph 1 per book
Poem 1 or 250 words
Article 1 or 2500 words
Book 1 chapter or 10,000 words
Speech 1 speech
Anthology, encyclopedia 1 story
Sheet music 10% of work
Audio recordings In classroom for instruction only
Commercial off-air broadcast Show 2 times within 10 days. Keep 45
days
Educational off-air broadcast 7 days or as stipulated by station
Library/Personal/Rental videos In classroom for instruction only
Software As stated on licensing agreement
Multimedia Guidelines
In 1994, a Federal panel was convened to begin to establish guidelines for using copyrighted material as
part of multimedia productions developed for instructional purposes by educators. Members of the
publishing, music and software industries worked together with members from a variety of professional
organizations to outline some guidelines of fair use for multimedia. These guidelines are not “law”, but
were approved in a report by the Subcommittee on Courts and Intellectual Property, Committee on the
Judiciary, U.S. House of Representatives, on September 27, 1996. The industry and educational
organizations that established these guidelines defined multimedia as "stand-alone, interactive programs
that use original and copyrighted works in various formats." The circumstances that apply to this use by
faculty include:
instructing face-to-face,
assigning students to use the material as self-study,
real-time use over a secure network,
portfolio use,
displaying the product to peers, and
2-year limit on use.
Students may use copyrighted material in this fashion for course projects, portfolio purposes, to display to
peers and as part of a performance.
Multimedia Use at a Glance
144
144
Multimedia Fair Use
Motion Picture 10% or 3 minutes Text 10% or 1000 words
Poem 250 words, 3 poems per poet Music 10% or less than 30 seconds
Photographs, illustrations 5 images per artist or 15 from a collection of works
Data sets 10% or 2500 fields
The Technology, Education and Copyright Harmonization Act (TEACH Act)
The TEACH Act was passed in 2002 with the purpose of clarifying the Copyright laws in relation to
distance education. Prior to this law educators were allowed to use copyrighted work in face-to-face
classroom instruction under the Fair Use Guidelines, but the guidelines were not extended to distance
education courses. The TEACH Act expands what an educator can do in distance education farther than the
original law; however, the use is still limited when compared to face-to-face instruction. In addition, there
are conditions that the institution must meet under this law.
The TEACH Act impacts how an instructor would use copyrighted materials in Blackboard in the following
ways:
An instructor can use non-dramatic literary or musical work, such as poetry readings or short story readings
but there are limits on dramatic works.
An instructor can use “reasonable and limited portions” of any other performance, including audiovisual
works (film, video) and dramatic music.
An instructor can display work such as still images, cartoons and charts in amounts that are similar to those
set by the guidelines for face-to-face instruction.
Educators can make digital copies of analog works (i.e. videotape/audiotapes) if there is no digital copy
available and must only use the amount allowed. Conversion from analog to digital is not allowed for the
purposes of streaming the video for more that what would be used during a normal class period.
Instructors cannot use material that is specifically designed to be marketed for the distance education market
such as textbooks and coursepacks. This would impact the ability of publishers to make a profit. Check the
licensing agreement for conditions of use in course management systems such as Blackboard.
Instructors should avoid posting full-text articles which have been downloaded from library databases or
other electronic resources. Instead, they should provide the citation or the link to the material so students
can find it on their own. At the end of the electronic document, it usually states that the article cannot be
copied, emailed or posted for multiple users without permission from the copyright holder. Individual users
can print, download or email it to themselves. Thus, by providing the resource link, the faculty member is
following the law.
145
145
Conditions
The institution must be accredited and not-for-profit. It must have published copyright policies and make
efforts to educate students, faculty and staff on copyright law and the institution’s policies.
The institution must implement reasonable technological controls on the dissemination and storage of
copyrighted material so that the work is not retained by students beyond the course session and which also
prevent the students from further distributing the materials. In addition, the institution cannot “interfere
with technological measures” that are designed to specifically to prevent the distribution and retention of
copyrighted work.
When a faculty member uses copyrighted materials in teaching, students must be given notification. The
transmission of the materials must be technologically available only to the students who are enrolled in the
course. The use must be under the supervision of the teacher and directly related to the course content.
Materials cannot be used for supplemental study by students on their own, but must be an integral part of
the lesson.
Obtaining Copyright Permission
Coursepack Creation
Some faculty members like to put together packs of materials to use in their courses thinking that this is
covered by the Fair Use Guidelines. They may ask to have the coursepack distributed by the UIW
Bookstore. However, the UIW Bookstore has a policy that states they will not reproduce or sell materials
that are copyrighted by others unless permission to duplicate has been obtained from the intellectual
property holder. There is a form which the faculty must fill out before the Bookstore will consider the
request. Faculty may obtain this form from the Textbook Manager. It is clear from the agreement, that the
faculty member must be the one who takes responsibility for seeking permission to use the materials.
The Bookstore’s Website refers faculty to two services that can assist faculty in obtaining permission. LAD
Custom Publishing (http://www.ladcustompub.com/) and XanEdu Publishing (http://www.xanedu.com/)
are two services that will seek permission from the copyright holder for use of the articles. Once permission
is obtained, they will copy and bind the articles or provide access to them online. Faculty can work with the
UIW Bookstore in collaboration with these companies to provide course pack access to your students.
Warning: faculty must work 3 - 4 months in advance to ensure that collections are available for students
when the semester starts.
Permission for Images and Music
Faculty who wish to research the copyright ownership of a particular piece of work can have the U.S.
Copyright Office do a search for $165 per hour (http://www.copyright.gov/forms/search_estimate.html).
Another source is the Copyright Clearance Center (http://www.copyright.com). Sources for permission to
use cartoons include Universal Uclick http://universaluclick.com/, and the New Yorker
(http://cartoonbank.com). Rights to use music can be sought from the American Society of Composers,
Authors and Publishers (http://www.ascap.com) or Broadcast Music, Inc. (http://bmi.com). Film and video
permission can be sought from the Motion Picture Licensing Corporation (http://www.mplc.com).
146
146
Web Resources
What follows are some online resources where faculty and students can go to find out more about the
copyright laws and fair use.
American Library Association (ALA) website on copyright covers topic ranging from specific laws,
legislation, and intellectual property and to international copyright issues.
(http://www.ala.org/advocacy/copyright).
Association of Research Librarians site allows you to download a brochure entitled “Know Your
Copyright Rights: Using Copyrighted Works in an Academic Setting” that can answer many of your
questions about using materials in both face-to-face and online courses.
(http://www.knowyourcopyrights.org/resourcesfac/kycrbrochure.shtml#ideas).
Fair Use Evaluator http://librarycopyright.net/fairuse/ is a tool that was developed by Michael Brewer and
the ALA Office of Information Technology. It can assist you in learning about the copyright laws and
help you determine if your intended use of a material meets fair use standards.
Columbia university Libraries/Information Services Copyright Advisory Office has an excellent site that
provides information on copyright laws and fair use. ( http://copyright.columbia.edu/copyright/).
Summary
The Copyright law is there to protect the rights of the author. The need to protect one’s intellectual property
certainly is something that university faculty should be able to identify with and respect. However, the Fair
Use Guidelines have been established to allow faculty to use copyrighted materials under the circumstances
outlined in this document. If the work is to be used not in public and/or under circumstances in which one
is getting paid, it is a good idea to seek permission for use. Payment to the copyright owner may be required.
Although permission is granted, be sure to cite the original source and copyright information.
References:
Ashley, Christopher L .(2004). The TEACH act: higher education challenges for compliance. EDUCAUSE Center for Applied Research Bulletin (Research Report No. 13). Retrieved from
EDUCAUSE website:
http://www.educause.edu/ECAR/TheTEACHActHigherEducationChal/157521
Becker, Gary H. (2003). Copyright: a guide to information and resources. (3rd ed). Lake Mary, Florida:
Gary H. Becker.
Bielefield, Arlene and Cheeseman, Lawrence (1997). Technology and copyright law: a guidebook for the
library, research and teaching professions. New York: Neal-Schuman Publishers, Inc.
Copyright code of the United States and related laws contained in Title 17 of the United States code.
Retrieved from http://www.copyright.gov/title17/
Crews, Kenneth D. (2000). Copyright essentials for librarians and educators. Chicago: American
Library Association.
147
147
Fair use guidelines for educational multimedia (1996). Retrieved from
http://www.ccumc.org/assets/documents/MMFUGuidelines.pdf
Fineberg, Tobi. (2009). Copyright and course management systems; educational use of copyrighted
materials in the United States and the United Kingdom. Libris (59): (238-247)
Digital millennium copyright act (1998). Retrieved from: http://www.copyright.gov/legislation/dmca.pdf
Hoon, Peggy. Using copyrighted works in your teaching – FAQ: questions faculty and teaching assistants
need to ask themselves frequently. Retrieved from Association of Research Libraries website:
http://www.knowyourcopyrights.org/bm~doc/kycrfaq.pdf.
Lipinski, Tomas A. (2006). The Complete copyright liability handbook for librarians and educators.
New York: Neal-Schuman.
Lipinski, Tomas A. (2005). Copyright law and the distance education classroom. Lanham, Maryland :
Scarecrow.
Technology, education and copyright harmonization (TEACH) act (s.487) (2001). Retrieved from
http://www.copyright.gov/docs/regstat031301.html
148
148
APPENDIX 13: ACADEMIC SERVICES
J.E. and L.E. Mabee Library Services for Faculty
The Facility
The UIW facility houses approximately 280,000 physical items, a computer research area with Internet
access and Microsoft Office, inviting study spaces and meeting rooms, wireless Internet access and
photocopy and scanning equipment. The collection contains more than 120 databases, almost 29,000
electronic books and many of our 44,000 journals are available electronically.
The library is open seven days a week for 103 hours per week during the regular semesters.
Library Mission Statement
The library actively participates in the life of the university. It supports the university’s academic programs
with materials, instruction, and technology that advance the intellectual development of its students and the
scholarship activities of its faculty. The library’s collections encourage lifelong learning and reflect
differing viewpoints, various cultures, and a global perspective. Materials and services encompass the
Catholic social teaching and social justice issues espoused by the Sisters of Charity of the Incarnate Word
and the university
Developing the Library Resource Collections
Development of an appropriate collection of library resources to support the curriculum and meet the
research and reference needs of the academic community is a vital academic activity. Development of the
library resource collections, in all formats, is the joint responsibility of all members of the library faculty
and of the teaching faculty at the University of the Incarnate Word. The librarians maintain an overview of
the entire collection to achieve balance and completeness while faculty members are expected to take an
active role in identifying appropriate titles specific to their areas of expertise. They have the subject content
knowledge needed to develop adequate holdings in their curricular areas.
Librarians are assigned as subject liaisons to the college/schools and will work with faculty in collection
development, assisting in providing a library research component for a course, embedding in Blackboard
courses, preparing program review documents for library resources and services in specific disciplines and
hosting information literacy sessions. Reference librarians are on duty for key operational hours of the
library and by appointment.
Faculty members are expected to identify and request new book, journal, audiovisual, and electronic
resources for purchase as well as to identify out-of-date items for withdrawal from the collection. This can
be done by contacting a subject librarian or by submitting a request online
(http://library.uiwtx.edu/facultyservices.html). The library’s new Collection Development Policy allows a
more detailed accounting of funds spent toward each discipline. The full policy is available upon request
and an abbreviated version can be found on the library Website http://library.uiwtx.edu/. Our new collection
focus is “e-preferred” due to the enhancements associated with simultaneous use and remote access. Faculty
will receive notification when a requested item(s) is received in the library, cataloged and ready for
circulation.
The Undergraduate Council and Graduate Council should automatically consider any implications for
library resources when considering any curriculum or program change, especially new majors or courses.
149
149
In addition, the library should be contacted when programs are seeking accreditation so that the collection
and services can be analyzed in light of accreditation criteria.
Special Collections within the library include:
Audiovisuals A separate collection of materials of CDs, DVDs and streaming video is provided in
support the curriculum. The collection consists of more than 14,000 items. The
Audiovisual Librarian or subject librarians can assist faculty in identifying AV that would
be appropriate for classroom instruction.
Children’s Collection
Easy, Juvenile, and Young Adult books are collected and maintained for students and faculty in Education and related courses studying Children’s Literature.
Special Collections
First editions, autographed editions, rare books, unique books and very valuable books are shelved in the Special Collections Room. These are non-circulating items with
access by advance appointment only. There is a small card catalog that identifies the items.
Texana Most items written by Texas authors or about the state of Texas are housed in a the Texana room on the first floor.
Frost Collection
The Frost Play Research Collection currently contains over 1250 unique and specialized materials on play research. The collection was donated by Dr. Joe L. Frost, a world recognized expert in the field of play.
Access to Selected Library Materials
The library’s Website, http://library.uiwtx.edu/ is the window to all library resources. It features links to the
library’s discovery tool – Primo, the online catalog, links to databases and e-journals as well as a complete
listing of our print journals. The site also provides specific information on library services, policies, hours
of operation and contact information. The Website is accessible through the university’s Website,
Blackboard and through the MyWord portal.
All UIW library resources, including books, audiovisuals, journal articles, and government documents, etc.
are discoverable through PRIMOSearch. PRIMOSearch will not only search catalog holdings, but will also
search our subscribed database content in one step. PRIMOSearch, and other electronic resources are
accessible from off-campus through the library’s Website. Remote access requires your UIW network
username (email) and password.
Faculty Services
Class and Curriculum Support:
Reference & Research Support – Reference librarians are on duty to assist patrons with their research.
Visit the library or contact them at [email protected] or by phone 210-829-3835.
Librarians can be embedded in Blackboard and/or create research guides (LibGuide) tailored to specific
classes. If you are interested in having a librarian create a guide for your class, please contact your subject
librarian - http://library.uiwtx.edu/subjectlibs.html.
150
150
Information Literacy & Library Instruction – The library’s information literacy program provides students
with transferrable life-long critical thinking and evaluation skills and streamlines their information seeking
behaviors. Classes can be scheduled with the Information Literacy Coordinator. Visit the Webpage -
http://library.uiwtx.edu/facultyservices.html, for more information.
Course Reserves – This service provides controlled access to books, media, articles and other readings for
a specific class at the request of faculty. Students can obtain reserve materials at the Circulation Desk.
Arrangements for reserves must be made each semester. In the online reserve module, items are listed by
instructor, department or course number. Faculty may dictate the loan periods for their reserve materials –
i.e. two hours, two days or one week. Items being placed on reserve should arrive at the library no less than
one week before the time items will be needed by students. Reserve materials are automatically withdrawn
at the end of each semester.
The faculty member must obtain written copyright clearance from the author, publisher or producer of a
work if the specific item is on reserve beyond one semester. Faculty members are responsible to comply
with all copyright laws regarding materials they are placing on reserve. They must sign a Copyright
Clearance form at the time of submission. The library reserves the right to refuse processing of Reserve
materials not in compliance with the current US Copyright Law and the university Copyright Policy.
The library will allow faculty to place personal copies of resources on reserve, however, the library cannot
assume replacement liability, nor can the library assume the responsibility for such materials as
teacher/student answer sheets or similar classroom materials. Computer generated reports on usage of
reserve materials may be used by faculty for evaluation.
Faculty Borrowing Privileges – Faculty may check out books for a semester. The loan period for AV items
is seven days. If a faculty member is unable to come to the library, he or she can designate a proxy
borrower to check out materials. The Proxy Borrowing form is available on our Website -
http://library.uiwtx.edu/forms/proxy_patron_form.pdf.
Other Services:
Interlibrary Loan – If a faculty member cannot find an item in the library, he or she can borrow books or
get copies of articles from other libraries through our ILL service (ILLiad). Log on to the library’s website
http:// library.uiwtx.edu and click on the Interlibrary Loan link to complete a user profile. Faculty members
can request books and articles from their desktop, check the status of their request and obtain some items
via e-mail.
TexShare - the UIW library participates in a state-wide borrowing program called TexShare, sponsored by
the Texas State Library and Archives Commission. Our library can distribute TexShare library cards to
UIW faculty and students, which allow them to borrow items from any participating library in Texas. For
a list of participating libraries, go to www.TexShare.edu.
Fines and replacement costs for lost materials are set by the lending institution. Charges for overdue, lost
or mutilated materials will be the responsibility of the faculty member borrowing these items.
Photocopy
While not for personal use, faculty making copies on library copiers for university research, committee
and departmental work may ask the librarian for use of a courtesy photocopy card kept at the Reference
151
151
Desk. The total number of copies made and which department to charge is recorded when the card is
returned.
Rooms
Group Study Rooms – The library’s group study rooms are the perfect location for students to network and
share ideas and resources. Study rooms can be checked out through the Circulation Desk for two hours by
two or more people. Several of these rooms have flat screens with laptop connections. Faculty can reserve
two of these rooms for meetings by calling 210-829-3838.
Electronic Classroom – Room 230 is equipped with 30 computers and one instructor’s computer for hands-
on instruction. This classroom, primarily used for information literacy instruction, is available for single,
non-repetitive class sessions. Call 210-829-3841 to reserve.
Meeting Rooms – The library has other rooms that are suitable for meetings. The Special Collections Room
and the Sterling International Conference Room can be reserved by calling 210-829-3838. There is also a
125 seat auditorium with a lecture capture system, which can be reserved as well.
Other UIW Libraries
George W. Brackenridge Library at the Feik School of Pharmacy
The library is available to Feik School of Pharmacy students, faculty and staff and to others
by appointment. It has limited hours of operation and houses a reference collection of
books and other resources of interest to the doctor of pharmacy curriculum.
Library materials are for in-house use only and cannot be checked out.
For information contact: Pharmacy Librarian. Phone: 210-883-1121.
Geneva R. Johnson School of Physical Therapy Library
This library serves the faculty and students of the UIW School of Physical Therapy program at the
Debby and Naty Saidoff Center and to others by appointment.
It has limited hours of operation and houses a reference collection of books and other resources of
interest to the Physical Therapy discipline.
Reference desk number: 210-283-6926
For information contact: Physical Therapy Librarian - Phone: 210-283-6920
UIW School of Osteopathic Medicine Library
This library serves the faculty and students attending the School of Osteopathic Medicine, including
students in the Masters of Biomedical Sciences. The facility is located at Brooks City Base.
Library access is restricted to students and faculty associated with the UIW School of Osteopathic
Medicine.
Reference Phone: 210-619-7040
Circulation Phone: 210-619-7038
For more information contact: Director of Library Services at the UIW School of Osteopathic
Medicine - Phone: 210-619-7039.
George W. Brackenridge Library at the Rosenberg School of Optometry
This library serves the faculty and students of the UIW Rosenberg School of Optometry and guests
by appointment.
152
152
It has limited hours of operation and houses a reference collection of books and other resources in
Optometric Science, Vision Science and other related topics.
Circulation desk phone number: 210-930-8686
For information contact: Director of Optometric and Clinical Library Service – Phone: 210-930-
8688.
Media Center and Instructional Technology
Media Center:
The Media Center provides equipment delivery on campus and provides computer access to the UIW community.
Equipment Delivery - Faculty can reserve VCRs, portable speakers, microphones, web cameras, document cameras and data projectors. Student workers will deliver equipment to classrooms (2 to 3 day notice is required). Video Conferencing setup and support is also managed through Media Services. Please call (Media Center) 829-3945 for more information. Requests can be made online at: http://www.uiw.edu/technology/request-forms/classroom-audiovisual-request-form/.
Computer Access - The Media Center Computer Lab is located on the ground floor of the Mabee Library
where there are 50 PC’s on the main floor and a small lab with 9 MAC’s. There are also 4 Express Print
stations in the foyer area to for quick printing and Go-Print stations where students pay for printing services.
http://www.uiw.edu/technology/media-center/
Instructional Technology
Instructional Technology is a service for faculty which provides consultation, development and production of materials in electronic, audio, graphic, photographic, video, and other formats. It offers software and training for such products as Blackboard and other Web 2.0 technologies. The offices are located on the ground floor of the library.
Graphic, Photography, Video, and Special Events Services
The Multimedia Specialist handles graphic and photographic services and video and audio taping of special
events by request. In addition, the Multimedia Specialist provides video conferencing and satellite
teleconferencing support. Telephone the Multimedia Specialist at 829-3946.
Technology Training
The technology training staff provides faculty and staff with the pedagogical tools, training and resources
needed to promote student engagement and success and to enhance and improve teaching, research, and
administrative operations. Look for announcements in “The Word Today” Newsletter and check the web
site: http://www.uiw.edu/technology/training-tutorials/
The Multimedia Specialist helps faculty, students and staff learn to use the variety of multimedia software
and equipment available in the Media Center. The Director of Instructional Technology can also be
consulted about technology training needs.
Networks, Computers and Technical Support
153
153
Presently, all classrooms, offices and computer labs have Internet access and 100% of the university campus
has wireless internet access. EZProxy is an authentication service that provides members of the UIW
community to access library databases from off-campus sites. Users must have a UIW network username
(email username) and password for access.
154
154
The Office of Infrastructure Support manages the wired and wireless network infrastructure, the network
operations center, telecommunications, email systems (Outlook for employees; Live@Edu for students),
Blackboard Learning Management System and mobile applications. New faculty members should contact
our Help Desk at 829-2721 to obtain their e-mail and Blackboard accounts. Additional Blackboard support
is provided by the university Blackboard Manager.
All full-time sophomores, juniors and seniors are required to possess a laptop computer as part of the UIW
laptop program. All full-time faculty members may be eligible to receive a laptop computer as well. The
deans distribute laptops to their faculty members through our laptop refresh initiative. Laptops are placed
on a 3-year refresh.
Technical Support Services provides helpdesk and desktop support services for all students, faculty, staff,
and administrators. They also manage UIW’s laptop program and coordinate the purchase and rollout of all
desktop and laptop systems in employee offices spaces, classrooms, and lab environments. To reach the
Help Desk call 829-2721.
155
155
APPENDIX 14: FACULTY SEARCH PROCEDURE GUIDELINES (Approved by the President, 3/95; revised 6/04, 11/07, 3/12)
The following is designed to provide guidelines and procedures for the establishment and performance of
Search Committees with responsibility to recommend candidates for positions as faculty members at the
University of the Incarnate Word. Fundamental criteria, to be observed and honored by Search Committees,
are found in the institutional Mission Statement.
Authorization of Positions
Academic discipline coordinators, discipline faculty, and the college/school dean will develop proposals
for any new or replacement full-time faculty positions, whether tenure track, visiting, or non-tenure track.
Decisions concerning the authorization of positions for the following academic year should be made in the
fall of the current year and early enough for the fall budget process to reflect the positions in division
budgets. The president, acting on the advice of the provost, must approve all new and replacement positions.
The Academic Deans Council considers all proposals for the next academic year and advises the provost
concerning priorities and ranking. Following the authorization of a search, the academic dean should consult
with the provost in order to obtain a budget for each search and then inform the search committee of the
limits on the scope of the search.
Constitution of Search Committees
The use of a search committee is mandatory for all full-time faculty positions. At the discretion of the dean,
search committees may be appointed for other faculty positions as well.
Once a faculty position has been established, the dean recommends the membership of the search committee
to the provost. The committee membership, usually three to five individuals, should include at least one
faculty member from the involved discipline, one from another college/school, and one from a discipline
whose students are served by the involved discipline, if such service occurs. Occasionally, a discipline
expert from outside the university may be asked to serve on a search committee. The dean will notify faculty
in writing of their appointment to the search committee.
In the constitution of a search committee, care should be taken to select members who will together possess
and reflect:
1. Substantial knowledge of the expertise necessary for the position being filled, and
2. Sensitivity to the values and needs of the institution as a whole.
The dean may name one committee member to chair the faculty search committee, or ask that the committee
elect a chairperson. Most often, this person will be the discipline chair/coordinator or a faculty member in
the discipline of the position. After selecting the member to chair the search committee, the dean forwards
the recommendation to the provost, who will either approve or modify the selection.
Position Announcement and Advertising
Once the search committee has been established, its first goal should be the drafting of a job description
which specifies the criteria candidates must satisfy in order to be considered for the position. Once
complete, this should be approved by the dean of the appropriate college/school and then forwarded to the
provost for approval. Should the dean consider it appropriate to modify the job description, he or she should
consult with the search committee until a consensus on the change is reached. Upon approval of the provost,
the job description will be sent to the director human resources who, in consultation with the
156
156
search committee, will develop a job specification and then target the appropriate publications for
advertising the position. At the initial meeting of the search committee, the director of human resources
will review the various forms and strategies that should be used to document the selection process and
ensure compliance with EEOC regulations.
In keeping with the university’s need for diversifying its faculty, every effort should be made to solicit
qualified minority candidates, either directly or through advertising in appropriate publications. To this end,
the director of human resources should apprise the search committee of the university’s diversity goals as
well as EEOC guidelines.
If any specific recommendations regarding searches are introduced by the president or by other
administrators, the recommendations should be presented to the search committee by the administrator in
question, and discussed until a consensus is reached and all parties agree that the recommendations are
beneficial to the institution as a whole. The Office of Human Resources should be consulted to ensure that
any changes to procedures or recommendations are consistent with EEOC guidelines and current updates
of EEOC case law and regulations.
Search Procedure
Hiring Managers are responsible for managing their applicant pool. When the applicant pool exceeds 20
qualified candidates a minimum of 5 candidates will be selected for phone. When the applicant pool is equal
to or less than 20 a minimum of 3 candidates will be selected for interviews. The initial interview will be
made by telephone.
Faculty search committees will adhere to a strict non-discriminatory procedure. All members of the search
committee must make every effort to participate as a group in the interview of all candidates selected for
interviews (telephone and on-campus). Contributions of committee members, including discussion and
ranking of candidates, is limited to specific evidence obtained by the member as a participant in the search
process. Chairs are responsible for summarizing the level of participation of all members as regards what
is recommended by the search committee to the dean for inviting applicants for on-campus interviews. All
candidates selected for interviews (telephone and on campus) will be asked the same general questions;
however, differing backgrounds and circumstances may require a variation in specific questions asked of
the candidates. See sample questions for faculty below. These questions are illustrative only and may be
used as guidelines for developing specific questions for each search committee. See below for a list of
Permitted and Prohibited questions in interviews. Prior to inviting candidates to campus for interviews,
members of search committees must check the professional and personal references provided by the
candidates.
Following the evaluation of faculty candidates, the search committee will recommend at least three
individuals to the dean, in rank order, and seek permission to invite two or more to campus for more formal
interviews. When the dean is satisfied that the search has honored all requirements, the dean recommends
the three candidates to the provost.
After consultation with the dean and the chair of the search committee, the provost will approve the
invitation of two or more of the candidates to visit the university for more formal interviews. The finalist(s)
will be interviewed by the search committee, by the dean, by the provost, and by the vice president for
mission and ministry. Whenever possible, the faculty candidates should also be invited to present a teaching
demonstration in an actual class setting.
157
157
At the conclusion of the on-campus interviews, the search committee will prepare a report summarizing the
strengths and weaknesses of each candidate and submit the report, without prioritizing candidates, to the
dean in the case of a faculty search.
Hiring and Bringing Searches to Closure
The interview process as described above will continue until a satisfactory candidate is selected. Once the
interview process is complete and the candidate has satisfied all concerned parties, the provost, in
consultation with the president, will authorize an offer. If rank is to change for the candidate, the Rank and
Tenure Committee must be convened and submit a recommendation before an offer is tendered. The dean
will telephone the candidate with the terms of the offer, and if they are acceptable, will notify the provost
to send a letter of offer which contains rank and date of tenure review, if applicable. Once a letter of
acceptance from the candidate is received, the provost can authorize processing of the contract.
When the contract is signed and returned, the person selected, with rank specified, is approved by the
Board of Trustees.
As soon as the search committee determines not to pursue a candidate, either by virtue of a hire or, given
other considerations, previous to a hire, the candidate should the thanked in writing for applying and
informed that he or she is no longer being considered for the position.
If on-campus interviews or position offers turn out unsuccessful, the provost will determine what further
action will be taken and inform the dean and search committee.
Sample Interview Questions for Faculty
Interviewers should request that answers to suggested questions include reference to personal experience
examples.
Mission
1. How does its mission distinguish UIW from other universities you are familiar with?
2. What do you think distinguishes an institution in the Catholic tradition?
3. How might the document, Ex Corde Ecclesiae, affect what you do in the classroom?
Teaching
4. Describe your philosophy of teaching.
5. How do you engage students in and out of the classroom? For example, what active/collaborative
strategies do you use?
6. Describe significant innovations you brought to a recent course you have taught.
7. What is your experience in using a service-learning methodology in a course? 8. What technology applications have you utilized in the classroom? What is most effective in your
estimation?
9. If you have developed a new course in the last 5 years, why did you do it and did the implementation
live up to your expectations?
10. How do you feel your teaching style can serve our student population; namely, to accept where
students are and help them to be successful?
11. How do you adjust your style to be effective with the less-motivated, under-prepared or academically
marginal students?
12. What pedagogical changes do you see on the horizon in your discipline? 13. What do you think are your greatest strengths as an instructor? In which areas do you feel you can
use some further development?
158
158
Scholarship
14. What are your current research interests and how do you see yourself continuing with these at UIW?
15. What do you see as research possibilities in collaboration with colleagues at UIW?
16. Your work best fits where in the Boyer model of scholarship (teaching, discovery, integration,
application)?
17. Describe any grant proposals you are working on or considering.
18. How have you involved your students in your research?
Service
19. How would your background and experiences strengthen this X academic department? 20. How do you see yourself supporting the faculty role in governance through participation on the
Senate or other institution-wide committees?
21. What is your top priority for being involved in service to the wider community?
Professional Development
22. What are your priorities for professional development in the next few years?
23. Where would this new position at UIW fit into your career development goals?
Collegiality/Fit
24. Describe your ability to communicate well and work effectively with others. 25. How do you see yourself as responding to teaching what is needed in the discipline, or the Core
Curriculum as necessary?
26. Describe what you see as the demands for civility in the academic work environment.
Interview Questions (Permitted and Prohibited)
[The following 3 pages are from HR materials.]
The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission issued its Pre-Employment Inquiry Guidelines in 1981
and its Enforcement Guidance: Pre-Employment Disability-Related Questions and Medical Examinations
in 1995. These address the issue of interview questions which, if used in making a selection decision, have
a discriminatory effect by screening out minority applicants, female candidates, and older applicants and
individuals with a disability, etc., for the particular job in question.
1. Race – There are no job-related considerations that would justify asking an applicant a question based
on race.
2. Religion - There are no job-related considerations that would justify asking about religious convictions,
unless your organization is a religious institution, which may give preference to individuals of their own
religion.
3. Gender – Generally, there are no appropriate questions based on the applicant's gender during the
interview process. Specifically:
(a) Women are no longer protected under state wage/hour laws re: number of hours worked,
lifting restrictions, etc.
(b) It is unlawful to deny a female applicant employment because she is pregnant, or planning to
have a child at some future date.
159
159
(c) Questions on marital status, number of children, child care arrangements, etc. are not
appropriate.
(d) Questions as to availability to work should be job-related: What hours can you work? What
shift(s) can you work? Can you work on weekends and/or holidays?
4. Sexual Preference - There are no permissible questions regarding an applicant's sexual preferences.
5. Height and/or weight restrictions – These questions may support gender or national origin
discrimination claims unless their relationship to specific job requirements can be demonstrated.
6. Age –Any question during the interview process that deters employment because of age is unlawful. The
Age Discrimination Act of 1967 bars discrimination against persons age 40 or over.
7. Arrest & Conviction Records – Questions relating to an applicant's arrest record are improper, while
questions of an applicant's conviction record may be asked, if job related. The Equal Employment
Opportunity Commission and many states prohibit use of arrest records for employment decisions because
they are inherently biased against applicants in protected classes. The EEOC has issued a Revised Policy
Statement covering the use of conviction records by employers in making employment decisions:
(a) The employer must establish a business necessity for use of an applicant's conviction record in
its employment decision. In establishing business necessity, the employer must consider three
factors to justify use of a conviction record:
1) Nature and gravity of the offense for which convicted;
2) Amount of time that has elapsed since the applicant's conviction and/or completion of
sentence; and
3) The nature of the job in question as it relates to the nature of the offense committed.
(b) The EEOC's Revised Policy Statement eliminated the existing requirement that employers
consider the applicant's prior employment history along with rehabilitation efforts, if any. The
Revised Policy Statement requires that the employer consider job-relatedness of the conviction,
plus the lapse of time between the conviction and current job selection process.
8. National Origin – You may not ask an applicant where he/she was born, or where his/her parents were
born. You may ask if the applicant is eligible to work in the United States. Our application will have already
asked this question.
9. Financial Status – An interviewer should not ask if the applicant owns or rents a home or car, or if wages
have been previously garnished, unless financial considerations for the job in question exist. Any employer
who relies on consumer credit reports in its employment process must comply with the Fair Credit
Reporting Act of 1970 and the Consumer Credit Reporting Reform Act of 1996.
10. Military Record – You may not ask what type of discharge the applicant received from military service.
You may ask whether or not the applicant served in the military, period of service, rank at time of discharge,
and type of training and work experience received while in the service.
160
160
11. Disability – You may not ask whether or not the applicant has a particular disability. You may only ask
whether or not the applicant can perform the duties of the job in question with or without a reasonable
accommodation.
Although federal EEO laws do not specifically prohibit any pre-employment questions, the EEOC does
look with "extreme disfavor" on questions about age, color, disability, national origin, race, religion, gender
or veteran status. Following is a representative list of unacceptable and acceptable questions. It is NOT all-
inclusive.
TOPIC UNACCEPTABLE ACCEPTABLE
Reliability,
Attendance
-Number of children?
-Who is going to baby-sit?
-What religion are you?
-Do you have pre-school age children at
home?
-Do you have a car?
-What hours and days can you work?
-Are there specific times that you cannot work?
-Do you have responsibilities other than work that
will interfere with specific job requirements such as
traveling?
Citizenship/
National Origin
-What is your national origin?
-Where are your parents from?
-What is your maiden name?
-Are you legally eligible for Employment in the
United States?
- Same as above
-Have you ever worked under a different name?
For Reference
Checking
-What is your father's surname?
-What are the names of your relatives?
-None
-None
Arrest and
Conviction
-Have you ever been arrested? -Have you ever been convicted of a crime? If so,
when, where and what was the disposition of the
case?
Disabilities -Do you have any job disabilities? -Can you perform the duties of the job you are
applying for?
Emergency -What is the name and address of the
relative to be notified in case of an
emergency?
-What is the name and address of the person to be
notified in case of an emergency? (Request only after
the Individual has been employed.)
Credit Record -Do you own your own home?
-Have your wages ever been garnished?
-Have you ever declared bankruptcy?
-None
-Credit references may be used if in compliance with
the Fair Credit Reporting Act of 1970 and the
Consumer Credit Reporting Reform Act Of 1996.
-None
Military Record -What type of discharge did you receive? -What type of education, training, Work experience
did you receive while in the military?
Language -What is your native language? Inquiry
into use of how applicant acquired ability
to read, write or speak a foreign language.
-Inquiry into languages applicant speaks and writes
fluently. (If the job requires additional languages)
Organizations -List all clubs, societies and lodges to
which you belong
-Inquiry into applicant's membership in organizations
which the applicant considers relevant to his or her
ability to perform job.
161
161
Race or Color -Complexion or color of skin. Coloring. -None
Worker's
Compensation
-Have you ever filed for worker's
compensation?
-Have you had any prior work injuries?
-None
-None
Religion or Creed -Inquiry into applicant's religious
denomination, religious affiliations,
church, parish, pastor or religious holidays
observed.
-None
Gender -Do you wish to be addressed as Mr.?,
Mrs.?, Miss?, or Ms.?
-None
Addresses -What was your previous address?
-How long did you reside there? -How long have you lived at your current
address?
-Do you own your own home?
-None
-None
-None -None
Education -When did you graduate from high school
or College?
-Do you have a high school diploma or equivalent?
-Do you have a university or college degree?
Personal -What color are your eyes, hair? -What is your weight?
-Only permissible if there is a bona fide occupational
qualification.
Check List for Implementation of Faculty Search Process Guidelines
Authorization of Position
Action Who
Development of position - Initial formulation by discipline
faculty in consultation with dean
- Dean reviews the description to
ascertain
program needs
university objectives of
Mission
Globalization
multicultural/diversity
Approval provost approves description
Advertisement includes - The discipline
- The college/school
- Tenure-track or not
- Area(s) of specialization
sought
Call for
- letter of interest
- c.v.,
- statement of teaching
philosophy,
- and at least 3 references
(names, titles, ph. #s,
- Discipline/program
chair/coordinator drafts
advertisement.
- Dean reviews the final draft to
ascertain that it meets program and
university objectives and contains
all the legal requirements.
162
162
addresses, and e-mail
address) Some committees
may opt to request
reference with application.
- Deadline and
- addressee (c/o dean)
- Residency requirement
(INS) or work permit,
EEOC, etc.
Submission of Advertisement Discipline faculty recommend to the
dean where the advertisement should be
placed (locally, nationally, discipline
journals), which should include venues
consulted by women and minorities.
Dean submits advertisement to HR.
Dean decides if a faculty person is sent
to a discipline convention to search for
possible candidates.
Search Committee
Action Who
Composition of Committee
(decision)
- Discipline chair/coordinator and the
dean, who approves it.
- The dean, in some instances,
coordinates the formation of the
Search Committee with the provost.
Make-Up Committee includes at least one
faculty from:
- discipline (usually includes
program coordinator)
- college/school - outside college/school
- The dean selects the chair, who is
probably from the discipline; the
provost selects a dean as a chair for
dean search committees.
Instruction to committee includes:
- parameters of search
- strategies for large pool of
applicants
- EEOC, INS regulations
- Mission of university - Ex Corde Ecclesiae issues
- Dean ensures that the committee receives the orientation.
Criteria (priority of
qualifications, articulation of
questions to be asked)
- The chair meets with the Search
Committee to articulate the
questions related to the discipline to
be asked of the candidates.
- The dean approves these questions.
Search Procedure
- The chair invites the committee to review the applications online and calls the meeting(s) to discuss the
applicants. The committee will select five applicants (if over 20 received) or three (if 20 or less) for
further review and eliminate certain candidates.
163
163
- The chair coordinates the process of calling the applicants to inform them of their status in the process
and to notify them that members of the Search Committee will be contacting the references.
- The chair coordinates the process of members of the committee calling references and additional
references as needed.
- The chair calls the meeting for the committee to review references and prepares for telephone
interviews so that the same questions are asked of all candidates.
- The chair calls the meeting for the committee to hold telephone interviews.
- The chair coordinates members of the committee checking out references by phone (if these had not
been contacted before) and checking out other references as needed.
- The chair assures that the committee recommends three faculty candidates to the dean, in writing,
describing the strengths and weaknesses of the candidates.
- The dean and the provost approve the invitation of at least two candidates for an on-campus visit, and
the dean notifies Human Resources.
- The chair of the committee plans the dates and schedule for the campus visits and checks out
budgetary implications (travel, meals, etc.) with the dean.
- The chair of the committee invites the candidates.
The On-Campus Visit
- The visit is usually for one day, including two nights (arrangements for overnight accommodations
are made at the ICC or at a hotel).
- The chair makes all the arrangements (pick up at airport, meals, meetings, etc.). - The chair (or someone who replaces the chair) gives the candidate a tour of the campus and
department facilities.
- The chair coordinates the Meetings, which include:
(chair distributes and collects evaluation forms at all meetings.)
the whole committee
all faculty in the discipline or in related disciplines
an open meeting with all faculty faculty from related disciplines or from other colleges/schools could accompany the candidate to
meals
faculty with shared interests
an open meeting or gathering with students
a class or seminar given/led by the candidate the dean (who discusses qualifications, salary, terms of employment, tenure and promotion
expectations and process)
the vice president for mission and ministry
provost
Post-Interview
- The chair collects all evaluations or other kinds of comments. - The chair calls a meeting of the Search Committee to develop a recommendation to the dean in
writing, with a revised summary of strengths and weaknesses, but no prioritization of the candidates.
- If the search was not completely satisfactory, the recommendation to the dean may include:
the appointment of one of the candidates
changing the nature of the appointment (e.g., to a one-year visiting)
an on-campus visit by other candidates
re-opening the search
postponement of the search
- The dean makes recommendation to the provost, who decides to whom to make the offer.
164
164
- The dean calls the candidate to whom the offer will be made and informs the candidate of
the offer
the terms of the offer
the letter that will be sent (a reply is needed before the contract is sent).
- The dean initiates the formulation of the letter of offer, which is sent by the provost. - The dean ensures that if the offer includes rank higher than the one presently held by the candidate, the
offer needs to be reviewed by the Rank and Tenure Committee or that the candidate be informed that
any such change of rank involves review by the Rank and Tenure Committee.
- The dean, when the candidate responds positively to the offer, initiates the contract, which is submitted
by the provost to the President’s Office.
- The dean reviews the contract before it is sent out by the President’s Office. - The chair of the Search Committee drafts the letter to all the other candidates that an offer has been
made and accepted.
165
165
Application/Interview Review Sheet for Faculty Searches
Name Position
Letter of Application
Vita
Highest degree
Letters / References Other information requested in advertisement
MISSION
What in the candidate’s background suggests that
he/she will live the mission of Incarnate Word (the
dignity of the human person, the spiritual quest,
service to students and the community, and the ideals
of Catholic higher education articulated in Ex Corde
Ecclesiae)?
SCHOLARSHIP
Is there a record of scholarship (of teaching, discovery, integration,
application) or, in the case of recently graduated candidates, of
dedication to scholarship?
Publications/Artistic Productions/Performances
Research Projects
Grant Projects
INSTITUTIONAL FIT
Is there evidence of collegiality that would suggest
that this candidate would fit well in the Incarnate
Word community?
TEACHING
Is there evidence of: - a clearly articulated philosophy of teaching,
- a commitment to the teaching mission of
Incarnate Word of accepting students where
they are and taking them to the levels
required by the discipline,
- teaching effectiveness.
DEVELOPMENT
Is there evidence of commitment to professional development?
SERVICE
Is there evidence of service:
To students
To the discipline/department/college/school
To the university community
To the larger community
To the profession
FOR OTHER COMMENTS USE BACK OF PAGE.
166
166
APPENDIX 15: DEAN SEARCH PROCEDURE GUIDELINES (Approved by the President, 3/95; revised 6/04, 11/07)
The following is designed to provide guidelines and procedures for the establishment and performance of
Search Committees with responsibility to recommend candidates for positions academic deans at the
University of the Incarnate Word. Fundamental criteria, to be observed and honored by Search Committees,
are found in the institutional Mission Statement.
Authorization of Positions
The Academic Deans Council considers all proposals for the next academic year and advises the provost
concerning priorities and ranking
Constitution of Search Committees
The use of a search committee is mandatory for all academic dean positions.
Once a dean position has been established, the provost appoints a dean as chair, creates the membership of
the search committee and notifies the members in writing of their appointment to the search committee.
The committee membership should include at least three faculty members from the involved college/school,
and may include other faculty members from related disciplines in other college/schools if appropriate.
Occasionally, an expert from outside the university may be asked to serve on a search committee. In some
cases, the provost may engage the services of a search firm to work with the search committee
In the constitution of a search committee, care should be taken to select members who will together possess
and reflect substantial knowledge of the expertise necessary for the position being filled, and sensitivity to
the values and needs of the institution as a whole.
Position Announcement and Advertising
Once the search committee has been established, its first goal should be the drafting of a job description
which specifies the criteria candidates must satisfy in order to be considered for the position. Once
complete, this should be approved by the dean who chairs the dean search committee and then forwarded
to the provost for approval. Should the provost consider it appropriate to modify the job description, he or
she should consult with the search committee until a consensus on the change is reached. Upon approval of
the provost, the job description will be sent to the director of Human resources who, in consultation with
the search committee, will develop a job specification and then target the appropriate publications for
advertising the position. At the initial meeting of the search committee, the director of human resources
will review the various forms and strategies that should be used to document the selection process and
ensure compliance with EEOC regulations.
In keeping with the university’s need for diversifying its faculty, every effort should be made to solicit
qualified minority candidates, either directly or through advertising in appropriate publications. To this end,
the director of human resources should apprise the search committee of the university’s diversity goals as
well as EEOC guidelines.
If any specific recommendations regarding searches are introduced by the president or by other
administrators, the recommendations should be presented to the search committee by the administrator in
question, and discussed until a consensus is reached and all parties agree that the recommendations are
beneficial to the institution as a whole. The Office of Human Resources should be consulted to ensure
167
167
that any changes to procedures or recommendations are consistent with EEOC guidelines and current
updates of EEOC case law and regulations.
Search Procedure
Hiring managers are responsible for managing their applicant pool. When the applicant pool exceeds 20
qualified candidates a minimum of 5 candidates will be selected for interviews. When the applicant pool is
equal to or less than 20 a minimum of 3 candidates will be selected for interviews. The initial interview will
be made by telephone. Once interviews are scheduled, the hiring manager should change the status of
those applicants selected for interviews to “interview”. This allows the applicants to track the status of their
applications.
Dean Search Committees will adhere to a strict non-discriminatory procedure. All members of the search
committee must make every effort to participate as a group in the interview of all candidates selected for
interviews (telephone and on-campus). Contributions of committee members, including discussion and
ranking of candidates, is limited to specific evidence obtained by the member as a participant in the search
process. Chairs are responsible for summarizing the level of participation of all members as regards what
is recommended by the search committee to the provost for inviting applicants for on- campus interviews.
All candidates selected for interviews (telephone and on campus) will be asked the same general questions;
however, differing backgrounds and circumstances may require a variation in specific questions asked of
the candidates. See below for a list of Permitted and Prohibited questions in interviews. Prior to inviting
candidates to campus for interviews, members of search committees must check the professional and
personal references provided by the candidates.
Following the evaluation of dean candidates, the search committee will recommend at least three
individuals to the provost, in rank order, and seek permission to invite two or more to campus for more
formal interviews.
After consultation with the chair of the search committee, the provost will approve the invitation of two or
more of the candidates to visit the university for more formal interviews. The finalist(s) will be interviewed
by the search committee, by the dean, by the provost, by the vice president for mission and ministry and,
should scheduling permit, by the president.
At the conclusion of the on-campus interviews, the search committee will prepare a report summarizing the
strengths and weaknesses of each candidate and submit the report, without prioritizing candidates, to the
provost in the case of a dean search.
Hiring and Bringing Searches to Closure
The interview process as described above will continue until a satisfactory candidate is selected. Once the
interview process is complete and the candidate has satisfied all concerned parties, the provost, in
consultation with the president, will authorize an offer. The provost will telephone the candidate with the
terms of the offer, and if they are acceptable, will send a letter of offer. Once a letter of acceptance from
the candidate is received, the provost can authorize processing of the contract.
When the contract is signed and returned, the person selected is approved by the Board of Trustees.
As soon as the search committee determines not to pursue a candidate, either by virtue of a hire or, given
other considerations, previous to a hire, the candidate should the thanked in writing for applying and
informed that he or she is no longer being considered for the position.
168
168
If on-campus interviews or position offers turn out unsuccessful, the provost will determine what further
action will be taken and inform the search committee.
Interview Questions (Permitted and Prohibited) [The following 3 pages are from HR materials.]
The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission issued its Pre-Employment Inquiry Guidelines in 1981
and its Enforcement Guidance: Pre-Employment Disability-Related Questions and Medical Examinations
in 1995. These address the issue of interview questions which, if used in making a selection decision, have
a discriminatory effect by screening out minority applicants, female candidates, and older applicants and
individuals with a disability, etc., for the particular job in question.
1. Race – There are no job-related considerations that would justify asking an applicant a question based
on race.
2. Religion - There are no job-related considerations that would justify asking about religious convictions,
unless your organization is a religious institution, which may give preference to individuals of their own
religion.
3. Gender – Generally, there are no appropriate questions based on the applicant's gender during the
interview process. Specifically:
(a) Women are no longer protected under state wage/hour laws re: number of hours worked,
lifting restrictions, etc.
(b) It is unlawful to deny a female applicant employment because she is pregnant, or planning to
have a child at some future date.
(c) Questions on marital status, number of children, child care arrangements, etc. are not
appropriate.
(d) Questions as to availability to work should be job-related: What hours can you work? What
shift(s) can you work? Can you work on weekends and/or holidays?
4. Sexual Preference - There are no permissible questions regarding an applicant's sexual preferences.
5. Height and/or weight restrictions – These questions may support gender or national origin
discrimination claims unless their relationship to specific job requirements can be demonstrated.
6. Age –Any question during the interview process that deters employment because of age is unlawful. The
Age Discrimination Act of 1967 bars discrimination against persons age 40 or over.
7. Arrest & Conviction Records – Questions relating to an applicant's arrest record are improper, while
questions of an applicant's conviction record may be asked, if job related. The Equal Employment
Opportunity Commission and many states prohibit use of arrest records for employment decisions because
they are inherently biased against applicants in protected classes. The EEOC has issued a Revised Policy
Statement covering the use of conviction records by employers in making employment decisions:
169
169
(a) The employer must establish a business necessity for use of an applicant's conviction record in
its employment decision. In establishing business necessity, the employer must consider three
factors to justify use of a conviction record:
1) Nature and gravity of the offense for which convicted;
2) Amount of time that has elapsed since the applicant's conviction and/or completion of
sentence; and
3) The nature of the job in question as it relates to the nature of the offense committed.
(b) The EEOC's Revised Policy Statement eliminated the existing requirement that employers
consider the applicant's prior employment history along with rehabilitation efforts, if any. The
Revised Policy Statement requires that the employer consider job-relatedness of the conviction,
plus the lapse of time between the conviction and current job selection process.
8. National Origin – You may not ask an applicant where he/she was born, or where his/her parents were
born. You may ask if the applicant is eligible to work in the United States. Our application will have already
asked this question.
9. Financial Status – An interviewer should not ask if the applicant owns or rents a home or car, or if wages
have been previously garnished, unless financial considerations for the job in question exist. Any employer
who relies on consumer credit reports in its employment process must comply with the Fair Credit
Reporting Act of 1970 and the Consumer Credit Reporting Reform Act of 1996.
10. Military Record – You may not ask what type of discharge the applicant received from military service.
You may ask whether or not the applicant served in the military, period of service, rank at time of discharge,
and type of training and work experience received while in the service.
11. Disability – You may not ask whether or not the applicant has a particular disability. You may only ask
whether or not the applicant can perform the duties of the job in question with or without a reasonable
accommodation.
Although federal EEO laws do not specifically prohibit any pre-employment questions, the EEOC does
look with "extreme disfavor" on questions about age, color, disability, national origin, race, religion, gender
or veteran status. Following is a representative list of unacceptable and acceptable questions. It is NOT all-
inclusive.
TOPIC UNACCEPTABLE ACCEPTABLE
Reliability,
Attendance
-Number of children?
-Who is going to baby-sit?
-What religion are you?
-Do you have pre-school age children at
home?
-Do you have a car?
-What hours and days can you work?
-Are there specific times that you cannot work?
-Do you have responsibilities other than work that
will interfere with specific job requirements such as
traveling?
Citizenship/
National Origin
-What is your national origin?
-Where are your parents from? -What is your maiden name?
-Are you legally eligible for Employment in the
United States? - Same as above
170
170
-Have you ever worked under a different name?
For Reference
Checking -What is your father's surname?
-What are the names of your relatives?
-None
-None
Arrest and
Conviction
-Have you ever been arrested? -Have you ever been convicted of a crime? If so,
when, where and what was the disposition of the
case?
Disabilities -Do you have any job disabilities? -Can you perform the duties of the job you are
applying for?
Emergency -What is the name and address of the
relative to be notified in case of an
emergency?
-What is the name and address of the person to be
notified in case of an emergency? (Request only after
the Individual has been employed.)
Credit Record -Do you own your own home?
-Have your wages ever been garnished?
-Have you ever declared bankruptcy?
-None -Credit references may be used if in compliance with
the Fair Credit Reporting Act of 1970 and the
Consumer Credit Reporting Reform Act Of 1996.
-None
Military Record -What type of discharge did you receive? -What type of education, training, Work experience
did you receive while in the military?
Language -What is your native language? Inquiry
into use of how applicant acquired ability
to read, write or speak a foreign language.
-Inquiry into languages applicant speaks and writes
fluently. (If the job requires additional languages)
Organizations -List all clubs, societies and lodges to
which you belong
-Inquiry into applicant's membership in organizations
which the applicant considers relevant to his or her
ability to perform job.
Race or Color -Complexion or color of skin. Coloring. -None
Worker's
Compensation
-Have you ever filed for worker's
compensation?
-Have you had any prior work injuries?
-None
-None
Religion or Creed -Inquiry into applicant's religious
denomination, religious affiliations,
church, parish, pastor or religious holidays
observed.
-None
Gender -Do you wish to be addressed as Mr.?,
Mrs.?, Miss?, or Ms.?
-None
Addresses -What was your previous address?
-How long did you reside there? -How long have you lived at your current
address?
-Do you own your own home?
-None
-None
-None
-None
Education -When did you graduate from high school
or College?
-Do you have a high school diploma or equivalent?
-Do you have a university or college degree?
Personal -What color are your eyes, hair? -What is your weight?
-Only permissible if there is a bona fide occupational
qualification.
171
171
APPENDIX 16: AWARDING OF HONORARY DEGREES (Approved by the President, 10/93)
Background and Rationale
The University of the Incarnate Word reserves the right to award honorary doctorates. The university
awards the honorary doctorate to recognize exceptional achievement and exemplary service to the
institution. The faculty of the university as a collective body holds the credentials to award the doctoral
degree and thus may bestow the honorary doctorate.
Criterion
Candidates for the honorary doctorate should meet the following criterion:
Distinguished achievement in his or her field of endeavor, be it education or other forms of service. A
person achieves distinction by embodying to an extraordinary degree the ideals of the Mission Statement.
Procedure
Nominations: Anyone in the university community may nominate persons to receive honorary degrees. This
includes trustees, faculty, administrators, students, and alumni. All nominations, including rationale, should
be submitted in writing to the Honorary Degree Committee through the provost.
Approval Process: Persons nominated will be awarded honorary degrees only after obtaining favorable
recommendations from the Honorary Degree Committee, the Faculty Senate, and final approval by the
Board of Trustees.
The Honorary Degree Committee shall be a four-person committee consisting of the provost, the president
of the Faculty Senate, the chancellor, and the president of the university. This committee shall carefully
investigate each nominee.
Nominees recommended by the Honorary Degree Committee shall be submitted to the Faculty Senate for
approval at a regularly scheduled meeting 60 days before the awarding of the degree. Nominations approved
by the Faculty Senate shall be forwarded to the UIW president who, if he or she approves, shall bring the
nomination to the Board of Trustees for final approval.
172
172
APPENDIX 17: AWARDING OF POSTHUMOUS DEGREES (Approved by the Provost, 2/11/09)
The University of the Incarnate Word may confer posthumous baccalaureate and graduate degrees upon
students who are deceased prior to but nearing formal completion of all degree requirements of the program
being pursued.
Guidelines
The student has completed a substantial portion of the UIW work required for the degree. A substantial
portion of work is defined as follows:
a) Undergraduate Students: Within 30 hours of graduation after having completed a minimum of 45
hours at UIW;
b) Graduate Students: Must be within 6 hours of completion of degree requirements;
c) Doctoral Students: Must have completed all coursework and made substantial progress on the
dissertation;
d) Pharmacy Students: Must be within 1 course rotation of completion of degree requirements.
Cases that do not meet these specific guidelines may be considered by the provost as circumstances dictate.
Procedures
1. Members of the student’s family, faculty members in the student’s major or the administration of
the university may initiate the request for the conferral of a posthumous degree.
2. The chair of the department where the deceased person was a student, and in the case of doctoral
students, the chair of the dissertation committee, will be consulted and will make a recommendation
to the provost prior to a decision regarding the awarding of the posthumous degree.
3. The recommendation for awarding a posthumous degree shall be made to the president by the
provost at the recommendation of appropriate faculty and deans.
Degree Conferral Process
The decision to award the degree should be made and family members notified at least six weeks before
the end of the semester so that the student’s name and degree may be included in the commencement
program and the diploma prepared for the ceremony.
173
173
APPENDIX 18: POLICY ON ACADEMIC INTEGRITY (Approved by the Board, 6/94; revised by VPASA, 9/07)
The University of the Incarnate Word is strongly committed to the nurturing of academic excellence. The
university expects its students to pursue and maintain truth, honesty and personal integrity in their academic
work. Academic dishonesty, in any form, constitutes a serious threat to the freedoms which define an
academic community. The following definitions and guidelines have therefore been established to secure
the maintenance of academic integrity at Incarnate Word.
Forms of Academic Dishonesty (these include, but are not limited to:)
A. Cheating on tests, examinations, or other class or laboratory work. B. Involvement in plagiarism (appropriation of another’s work and the unacknowledged
incorporation of that work in one's own written work offered for credit).
C. Counterfeit work - including turning in as one's own, work that was created, researched, or
produced by someone else.
D. Falsification of Academic Records - knowingly and improperly changing grades on
transcripts, grade sheets, electronic data sheets, class reports, projects, or other
academically related documents.
E. Unauthorized Reuse of Work - the turning in of the same work to more than one class
without consent of the instructor involved constitutes academic dishonesty.
F. Theft - unauthorized use or circulation of tests or answer sheets specifically prepared for a
given course and as yet not used or publicly released by the instructor of a course, or theft
of completed tests.
G. Collusion - unauthorized collaboration with another person in preparing course work.
H. Facilitating Academic Dishonesty - intentionally or knowingly helping or attempting to
help another to violate a provision of the code of academic integrity. Instructors who are
concerned that some form of academic dishonesty has occurred shall confront the student
directly and may take the matter to the dean of their college/school. Any member on the
student body or the staff of the University of the Incarnate Word who is concerned that a
student has engaged in some form of academic dishonesty should report the incident to the
dean of the college/school which oversees the course in question. The college/school dean
will then convene the college/school's Academic Honor Board and initiate the process of
investigation outlined in II.B. below.
Procedures for Investigating Claims of Academic Dishonesty and Assessing Sanctions
I. Sanctions Assessed by Faculty
Before any sanction by a faculty member is assigned, the instructor must meet with the
student about the violation. Sanctions must be confirmed in writing to the student, copied
to the dean of the college/school which the instructor is a member and to the provost. These
records are NOT placed in the student's permanent academic file and will be destroyed
when the student graduates or otherwise ceases his/her relationship with the university.
1. When Guilt Is Admitted: If a student who is confronted by a faculty member for
engaging in academic dishonesty openly admits to wrongdoing, the instructor will:
a. give the student an F for the assignment in question, and may b. forward the case to the Academic Honor Board of the college/school to consider
additional sanctions.
174
174
2. When Guilt Is Not Admitted: If a student accused by a faculty member of academic
dishonesty does not admit wrongdoing, his or her appeal should be made directly to
the dean of the college/school with course responsibility so that the Academic Honor
Board can formally investigate the allegation and decide which appropriate action
should be taken.
J. Sanctions Assessed by the Academic Honor Board
When cases alleging academic dishonesty are forwarded to a college/school dean, he or
she will convene an Academic Honor Board. The board will be comprised of two faculty
from the college/school selected by the academic dean and two students selected from a
list of students previously identified by the college/school faculty. The college/school dean
will serve as chairperson of the board; however, he/she will only vote in cases where the
board is split on any given decision.
The accused may request that a student or faculty member not sit in judgment if he/she
feels that the vote may be biased or prejudiced as a consequence. Some substantiation of
the claim may be required, and the final decision shall rest with the college/school dean.
The college/school dean is responsible for any substitution to the board in order to obtain
a quorum of five members.
A student is presumed innocent until proven guilty by the preponderance of evidence, or
until guilt is admitted or a simple majority vote of the board members is reached.
Sanctions such as receiving an F for the assignment in question, receiving an F for the
course, academic suspension, and dismissal from the university or other action deemed
appropriate, will be assessed by the Academic Honor Board presiding over the case. The
decision of the Board will be communicated in writing to the student, as described in II. A.
In order to assure a student's right to due-process, the procedure of formal inquiry by the
Academic Honor Board will include:
1. securing a written statement describing the nature and circumstances of the alleged
offense from the student, faculty, or staff member making the allegation,
2. securing a written statement describing the incident from the accused student, 3. interviewing separately the accused student, and the faculty/staff member alleging the
dishonesty in order to clarify and to expand the written statements,
4. interviewing any witnesses or other persons claiming knowledge of the incident,
5. securing, examining, and retaining any physical evidence related to the incident.
Using written statements, interviews, and available physical evidence, the Academic Honor Board
will decide the validity of the alleged incident of academic dishonesty.
If the academic dishonesty has been verified, the Academic Honor Board will make a determination
of appropriate sanctions to be imposed and, in a written statement, inform the student in question
of the decision.
175
175
Pending the final action of the Academic Honor Board, the status of the student shall not be altered,
nor his/her right to be present on campus, to attend classes, and to participate in university-
sponsored activities.
Appeals of Disciplinary Sanctions Assessed by the Academic Honor Board
Any student who feels he/she has not been accorded justice by the Academic Honor Board may
appeal to the provost for review of the decision. If the provost determines that there should be a
review, he/she convenes a Committee on Academic Integrity which is comprised of two senior
tenured faculty members (or faculty with multi-year renewable-term appointments in schools
without tenure) and an elected member of the Student Government Association. The Committee
shall determine whether the process followed by the Academic Honor Board was fair and impartial
and that adequate consideration was given to evidence and information presented.
K. Timetable - Appeals to Academic Honor Board decisions must be submitted in writing to
the Committee on Academic Integrity within ten working days of the board's decision.
L. Following a review of the appeal, the Committee on Academic Integrity will determine
whether to uphold or modify the decision of the Academic Honor Board.
M. The decisions of the Committee on Academic Integrity shall be considered FINAL. A
written statement shall be sent to the student in question no later than three days after the
committee’s final decision is reached.
176
176
APPENDIX 19: STUDENT COMPLAINTS
Student Complaint Policy (Approved by Executive Council, 3/2/05; revised by Provost, 8//6/13)
The University of the Incarnate Word (UIW) is committed to fostering a learning environment that
promotes academic excellence and personal development. Students are encouraged to voice their
complaints and concerns in a manner that is respectful of the dignity of the individual, if any, who is the
subject of the complaint. It is the policy of UIW that students with complaints be treated honestly and fairly,
and that their complaints be handled in a timely manner with regard to resolution of the issue(s) presented.
Any UIW student may express a concern or complaint by following these procedures. Please note that UIW
explicitly prohibits any member of the UIW community from harassing or retaliating against students who
file complaints.
General Guidelines Complaints are most effectively and efficiently managed by first expressing them to the individual, if any,
who is the subject of the complaint. Students are strongly encouraged to first discuss their complaint directly
with any such individual involved.
If the complaint involves a policy, procedure, or area of responsibility of a specific administrative
department, it should be directed to the supervisor/manager of that department. In each instance of a
departmental complaint, the appropriate individual will investigate the complaint, seek a solution, and
report back to the student in writing within 10 school days. The department supervisor/manager will keep
a record of the decision.
For more information about how to process a complaint or to appeal a decision, the student should contact
the appropriate office below.
Offices to Contact for Different Kinds of Complaints
Course Work Complaints Students who have complaints about what they believe to be unfair treatment involving their academic
work should contact the appropriate college/school dean.
College of Humanities, Arts, and Social Sciences Division of Extended Academic Programs (ADCaP, UIW Online, UIW Prep)
Dreeben School of Education
Feik School of Pharmacy
HEB School of Business and Administration Ila Faye Miller School of Nursing and Health Professions
Rosenberg School of Optometry
School of Mathematics, Science, and Engineering
School of Media and Design
School of Osteopathic Medicine
School of Physical Therapy
Other Academic Complaints Undergraduate students who have complaints about academic advisement or other issues related to
academic policies, procedures, or deadlines should contact the dean of student success, Student Support
Center. Graduate students should contact the dean of graduate studies and research.
177
177
Administrative Department Complaints Students who have complaints about the policies, procedures, or deadlines of an administrative area of
UIW, or the personal treatment they have received from an administrative area of UIW, should contact the
appropriate major office of UIW.
Admissions
Business
Financial Aid
Graduate Studies and Research
Library
Registrar
Student Success
Technology Services
Center for Veterans Affairs
Violations of the Student Code of Conduct Any member of the UIW community, including faculty and students, may file a complaint against any
student for alleged violations of the UIW Student Code of Conduct by contacting the dean of campus life.
General Concerns or Complaints Undergraduate students who have a general complaint regarding UIW policies, procedures, or personnel
should contact the dean of campus life. Graduate students should contact college/school deans (see previous
page) or the dean of graduate studies and research.
Harassment Complaints Students who believe that they have been subjected to harassment or treated in a way that violates UIW’s
anti-harassment policy (i.e., harassment related to an individual’s race, color, sex, religion, national origin,
sexual orientation, citizenship status, or disability) by another student, a UIW employee, a contractor, or a
visitor to the campus, should immediately report the alleged harassment to the director of human resources,
or to the dean of campus life.
Additional Resources Mediation Services Mediation is a process that attempts to establish communication between people having disputes and assists
them in finding a mutually acceptable solution. The end result of a successful mediation is that there are
neither winners nor losers, but rather, generally satisfied individuals who have arrived at an agreement,
which resolves their dispute as they define it. Mediation is a confidential process. The agreements made by
the parties involved are non-binding. UIW offers a mediation program designed to assist all members of
the UIW community to resolve problems and disputes. Anyone may initiate mediation. To initiate
mediation, contact the Counseling Center.
The Student Government Association
Students may address various concerns and comments to the executive officers of the UIW Student
Government Association (SGA). Concerns regarding specific matters related to clubs and organizations,
university policies and practices, or ideas and suggestions for UIW administrative offices may be directed
to SGA. Concerns are accepted verbally at their twice-monthly general assembly meetings, at SGA-
sponsored student forums, or by addressing an SGA officer. Students may also share their concerns in
writing by using the forms provided at SGA suggestion boxes that are located in each building on campus.
Concerns directed to the SGA may be submitted anonymously. Concerns are subject to publication in the
Logos, the UIW student newspaper. Students’ concerns are addressed by officers at their regular meetings
with UIW administrators or in public forums. The concerns received are also compiled each semester by
the SGA and priority issues are presented to the Executive Council for discussion and action, as needed.
Student government officers may be reached in the Student Government Office.
178
178
Student Complaints Related To Faculty Decisions About Student Course Work Procedure
Guidelines
(Approved by VPASA, 10/27/05)
The University of the Incarnate Word (UIW) is committed to maintaining a learning environment which
promotes academic excellence and personal development. The following procedure guidelines assure
students the opportunity to register their complaints about what they believe to be unfair treatment involving
their academic work and to receive prompt resolution of matters related to the complaint.
“Unfair treatment” applies to any act which may be perceived as either prejudiced or arbitrary in the
evaluation of a student’s performance, or in the imposition of sanctions without regard for due process.
Students are to complete the following steps:
Informal Meeting with the Instructor to Resolve a Complaint
The student should seek resolution of a complaint by talking to the instructor as soon as an incident of
perceived unfair treatment occurs. After this step, the student may decide to initiate a Formal Conference
for the record.
Formal Conference with the Instructor to Resolve a Complaint
The student is responsible for initiating a Formal Conference by completing Part I of the Conference
Documentation Form obtained from the office of the dean in whose college/school the instructor resides.
a. The student completes Part 1 of the Documentation Form and then meets with the instructor within
10 school days of the alleged unfair treatment, or in the case of a final grade, before the beginning
of the semester following the alleged unfair treatment. The student explains the complaint and
attempts to resolve the matter with the instructor.
b. The instructor will sign the form acknowledging that there was discussion with the student about
the complaint and indicate whether she/he is providing comments.
c. The instructor may provide written comments as an attachment to the complaint form. The
comments must be provided to the student within three days of meeting with the student.
d. After the conference, the student completes Part 2 of the Documentation Form and signs the
document.
e. The student delivers this form, and any written comments provided by the instructor, in a sealed
envelope to the dean of the college/school in which the instructor resides.
Appeal to the College/School Dean
If the complaint is not resolved to the satisfaction of the student, the student shall have the right to appeal a
decision in writing to the dean or a person designated by the dean. The student completes the form called
the Appeal Form for Student Complaints about Faculty Decisions and delivers it in a sealed envelope to the
appropriate dean’s office within three school days of meeting with the instructor.
1. To begin the appeal process, the student completes the Appeal Form for Student Complaints about
Faculty Decisions and attaches to the form a written statement a) of the complaint, b) the student’s
perception of the results of the conference with the instructor, and c) reasons why the meeting did not
resolve the matter of the alleged unfair treatment.
2. The dean shall meet with the instructor, and others as appropriate, to clarify the relevant facts and
perceptions in the matter.
179
179
3. The dean shall meet with the student* to clarify the relevant facts and perceptions in the matter as
described in the student’s written statement.
4. The dean then makes a decision on the matter.
As an alternative, the dean has the option of deciding to convene a review committee.
2. a. The dean creates a committee consisting of at least two faculty, and one of these, if possible,
from the same department as the faculty being complained about, and a student (the SGA
school senator is one possibility), who is not in the same course as the complainant. The dean
shall appoint one of the faculty to chair the meeting.
3. a. The committee will meet with the student** and the instructor. 4. a. The committee shall report its findings and recommendations to the dean who makes a decision
on the matter.
5. The dean’s decision shall be communicated in writing to the student and the instructor within 10
school days of receipt of the student’s completed Appeal Form for Student Complaints about Faculty
Decisions.
6. The dean’s decision is final and there is no further appeal to another administrator or office.
If the complaint involves an individual assignment grade or a final grade, the dean may ask the
instructor to change the grade only in cases involving a procedural error in the conduct of the course
or due to evidence of unfair treatment.
7. Records of the dean’s decision shall be kept in a file separate from the faculty permanent file in the
dean’s office.
*The student may choose to bring an observer to the meeting. The role of observers is to provide support
but they may not actively participate in the conversation. If an observer is present, the dean may also choose
an observer to be present. If the student’s observer is also a lawyer, the dean shall postpone the meeting
until university counsel can be present.
** The student may choose to bring an observer to the meeting. The role of observers is to provide support
but they may not actively participate in the conversation. If the student’s observer is also a lawyer, the
faculty chair shall notify the dean and postpone the meeting until university counsel can be present and the
dean will then chair the meeting.
180
180
Formal Conference Documentation Form
(For a Student Complaint about an Instructor’s Decision)
Part I
The student completes this part prior to the meeting with the instructor.
Student Name: ID #:
UIW email: Phone/cell: ( )
Address:
Instructor’s Name: UIW extension #:
Issue (completed by the student prior to the conference):
……………………………………………………………………………………………………………… By signature I acknowledge that I have met with the above named student to discuss this issue. I am/am not
(circle one) providing written comments. (Comments must be submitted to your college/school dean within
three days of this meeting.)
Signature of Instructor: Date:
………………………………………………………………………………………………………………
Part 2 The student, after the meeting, describes whether resolution of the complaint was reached or not:
Signature of Student: Date:
Whether there is resolution or not, the student delivers this form in a sealed envelope to the dean of the
college/school in which the instructor resides.
If resolution was not reached and the student wishes to appeal the instructor’s decision, then the student
requests from the dean’s office the Appeal Form for Student Complaints about Faculty Decisions,
completes it and returns to the dean’s office within three days.
cc: Student
Instructor
181
181
Appeal Form For Student Complaints About Faculty Decisions
Student Contact Information*
Student’s (Complainant’s) Name:
ID #: UIW Email address:
Address:
Home Phone Number: Cell: Work:
Complaint Information
Date of the incident/complaint:
Time of the incident (if applicable):
Place the incident occurred (if applicable):
Name(s) of the instructor who made a decision that directly affected you and is the subject of your
complaint:
Date of last conversation with such person(s) when you tried to resolve your complaint:
Please attach a letter explaining your complaint and the reasons why a decision or action that affected
you should be changed.
What happens next? 1) Your complaint will be investigated by the appropriate college/school dean who will seek a fair
solution, and report back to you in writing within 10 school days.
2) The final decision may not be appealed to a higher level.
3) Your file will be kept in the office where the final decision was made.
*PLEASE NOTE: UIW explicitly prohibits any member of the university community from harassing or
retaliating against students who file complaints and appeal decisions.
Student Signature: Date:
182
182
OFFICE USE
ONLY
Date Appeal Received: Date Response Due:
Dean’s Name:
Date Response Sent to Student:
Comments:
183
183
Student Receipt of Complaint Procedure Guidelines and Forms
(Approved by VPASA, 11/4/05)
The University of the Incarnate Word (UIW) is committed to maintaining a learning environment which
promotes academic excellence and personal development. Procedure guidelines assure students the
opportunity to register their complaints about what they believe to be unfair treatment involving their
academic work and to receive prompt resolution of matters related to the complaint.
Here is a summary of the Procedure Guidelines that explain the process a student must follow in registering
a complaint:
Hold an Informal Meeting with the Instructor to Resolve the Complaint.
If the complaint is not resolved, the student may decide to initiate a Formal Conference for the record.
Hold a Formal Conference with the Instructor after filling out Part I of the Conference
Documentation Form.
If the complaint is still not resolved to the satisfaction of the student, the student shall have the right to
appeal a decision in writing to the dean of the college/school in which the instructor resides.
Initiate the process of appealing to the college/school dean by completing the form called the Appeal
Form for Student Complaints about Faculty Decisions.
I understand the basic 3-step process for resolving a complaint related to faculty decisions about student
course work and realize that for further details I must read the Procedure Guidelines and Forms I have
received. I also understand that the college/school dean is the appropriate administrator for making a final
decision on the appeal and that I am not entitled to appeal to another administrator or office.
Print Student Name:
Student Signature: Date:
184
184
APPENDIX 20: GRADUATE FACULTY APPOINTMENT PROCEDURE
Eligibility All faculty members regularly appointed to the university are eligible for appointment as Members of the
Graduate Faculty. Other individuals, external to the UIW community, who are needed to perform specific
functions of the Graduate Faculty may be approved as Associate Members.
Functions of the Graduate Faculty Full Members and Associate Members of the Graduate Faculty are eligible for consideration to serve in
the following ways.
1. Teach graduate level courses.
2. Mentor students in graduate degree and certificate programs.
3. Serve on graduate thesis, dissertation, or examination committees. 4. Serve on the Graduate Council and its subcommittees, on college/school graduate committees,
and on other university committees relating solely to graduate education.
In addition, Full Members may direct graduate theses, and dissertations.
Criteria for Appointment The criteria for appointment to the graduate faculty include: 1. Academic preparation. Graduate faculty members are expected to hold the highest earned degree
in their disciplines. In some cases, experience and high productivity may substitute for the earned
doctorate.
2. Scholarship. Persons selected as graduate faculty must be productive, creative scholars. Productive
scholarship requires devotion to the discovery, development, refinement, and application of
knowledge and techniques in one's field of expertise. Active engagement in scholarly activities is
defined as activity having taken place within the period five years preceding the date of
appointment.
3. Teaching Experience. Faculty must have successful experience in teaching and mentoring
graduate students or demonstrate potential for same.
Note: Academic programs maintain additional requirements for specific service on their thesis and
dissertation committees.
Term of Appointment of Members The usual period of an appointment to membership in the Graduate Faculty shall be for one year from 1
June of a given year to 31 May. Shorter periods of appointment are possible but they must end on 31 May
of a given year. Faculty members holding a temporary appointment shall not be given an appointment to
membership on the Graduate Faculty for a period of time in excess of their term of appointment to the
university. Appointments with effective dates other than 1 June shall be for a period of time not exceeding
one year and shall expire on 31 May.
Procedures for Appointment of Members 1. Each college/school offering graduate work shall designate for membership in the Graduate
Faculty those eligible faculty members who meet the established criteria.
2. College/school designations shall be forwarded to the graduate dean annually by the
college/school dean (via list).
3. All administrative officers holding appointments with the rank of dean or higher shall be Members
of the Graduate Faculty during tenure of such appointments. Administrators below the rank of
dean shall be nominated for membership in the Graduate Faculty by the appropriate
185
185
college/school dean for which they will perform the duties of Graduate Faculty members. Other
administrators, not holding appointments to the faculty, shall be reviewed by the graduate dean on
a case by case basis.
Reappointment and Termination of Appointment 1. Each appointment of a member of the Graduate Faculty shall be reviewed by the college/school
during the spring semester preceding its expiration date. Reappointment shall follow the same
procedures as for appointment.
2. Appointment of thesis and dissertation committees extends to the life of the committee.
3. The termination of an appointment of an individual to the faculty of UIW shall automatically
terminate the individual's appointment as a Member of the Graduate faculty. Certain exceptions
may be granted by the graduate dean (e.g., emeritus status, etc.).
Associate Members 1. Any individual may be designated as an Associate Member of the Graduate Faculty for the purpose
of performing specific functions of the Graduate Faculty, such as teaching a graduate course or
serving on an examination or thesis or dissertation committee.
2. Approval for Associate Membership shall be for the period of time required to perform specific
function(s) for which the approval is granted. Designation for Associate Membership must be
granted before an individual who is not a Member of the Graduate Faculty may begin assigned
duties relating to graduate education. Appointment to thesis and dissertation committees extends to
life of the committee.
3. Associate Members shall be designated by a simple list from the college/school dean to the graduate
dean accompanied with a brief description or rationale for appointment (e.g., description of
function).
Graduate Faculty Assemblies The graduate dean may call for meetings of the graduate faculty to discuss current issues in graduate
education or gather feedback about new ideas or proposals being considered. The graduate faculty so
assembled does not have authority to approve or recommend any action related to graduate education. Any
such action or proposals must be processed through regular channels of the Faculty Senate and Deans
Councils.
186
186
APPENDIX 21: CLASSROOM RECORDING POLICY (Approved by the Provost, 11/20/13)
TITLE: Classroom Recording Policy
EFFECTIVE DATE: January 2014
Policy Purpose: To provide a method for approving or limiting a recording of a classroom experience.
Rationale:
Recordings can be useful for those unable to attend class, or individuals or groups of students from the class
wanting to increase their understanding of presented course material, or to accommodate students with
disabilities. Instructors may make recordings for personal study or self-evaluation or sharing with other
instructors for educational purposes, or to accommodate students with disabilities. However, the recording
of classroom lectures and discussions may involve both privacy and copyright issues and may have an effect
on the quality of class participation and the learning experience.
While gaining permission to record is possible and allowable, students are strongly encouraged to make
notes of classroom experiences because taking notes requires students to be actively engaged in the
classroom environment and results in improved learning. Recording of lectures and discussions interferes
with the learning process and may negatively affect students in their learning to quickly grasp ideas and
information, summarize them and relate them in a coherent manner.
Definition of Terms:
Recording—any audio or audio/visual reproduction of a classroom experience. Classroom Experience—all recordable content in a face-to-face or online class including lectures, audio
and audio/visual presentations, handouts, student and guest participation.
Narrative:
Advanced Written Permission for Students Advance written permission of the instructor is required for any enrolled student to make audio and/or video
recordings of a classroom experience(s). The instructor may provide open-ended permission for the class
as a whole in the course syllabus or outline (see Appendix B below for samples); otherwise, a Recording
Permission Form must be used and will be kept by the instructor (see Appendix A below).
Student Disability Services Students seeking disability accommodation must first contact the Student Disability Services Office.
Students are advised of this policy in the Student Handbook; instructors are encouraged to include a
statement regarding this policy in their syllabus or outline. Instructors are required to grant permission to
record to students who have been determined to need such accommodation by the Student Disability Center.
All stated policies on sharing and distribution of class recordings still apply.
Limitations on Use Permission to allow a recording of a class experience is not a transfer of any copyrights related to contents
in the recording. Public distribution or commercial use of recordings by students in any medium is a violation of this policy
and may constitute a violation of state or federal law. A violation may subject a student to
187
187
disciplinary action under “The Student Code of Conduct” and legal action regarding any copyrighted
material.
Students must destroy recordings at the end of the term in which they are enrolled in the class. Instructors recording a class experience with the intention of posting or distributing it for use by students
in the class should record only the lecture or audio/visual presentation portions of the class.
Instructors recording a class experience with the intention of presenting selections in a public forum
require the written consent of every student in that class if students are identifiable in some way.
Disclosure At the beginning of the term, the instructor in class clarifies the recording policy and informs the class if
permission has been granted for a student(s) to record for the entire semester. Otherwise, for each class day
that a student has been given permission to record or the instructor intends to record, the instructor at the
beginning of the class must inform the students. The instructor will not identify for the class or otherwise
call attention to any student given permission to make a recording.
Procedure
If the course syllabus or outline does not contain instructions regarding the instructor’s policy on recording
the classroom experience, the interested student must approach the instructor and obtain written permission.
UIW office or vice president responsible to oversee policy compliance and updates:
Provost
Process to communicate this policy to those affected by it: Student Handbook
Faculty Handbook
Course Syllabi
Process to monitor compliance and report results:
How often, and when, policy will be reviewed for possible updates:
Every 5 years; Next review Fall 2018
For Academic policy proposals: Submit this form to the Provost’s Office
For all other policy proposals: Submit this form to your supervising vice president (or
Human Resources for Employee Handbook only)
188
188
Appendix A
Class Recording Permission Form
is permitted to make a class recording
Check one: audio audio/visual
Course Title:
Course Number:
Instructor:
Semester/Term: Fall Spring Summer Term 20_
I understand that recording of class lectures, audio/visual presentations, or discussions is for my personal use
or for group study with other students in class.
I understand the policy prohibits public distribution in any medium or commercial use of recordings and any violations will warrant disciplinary action according to “The Student Code of Conduct” and possibly legal
action in the case of copyrighted material.
I also promise to destroy recordings at the end of this term that I am enrolled in the class
Student Signature Date
Instructor Signature Date
Copy: Student
189
189
Appendix B
Sample Policy Statements for Syllabi or Outlines
Audio or Audio/Video Recordings Prohibited
Students may not record classroom lectures, audio/visual presentations, or discussions.
Students found in violation of this policy may be subject to disciplinary action under the university’s Code of
Student Conduct.
Audio or Audio/Video Recordings Allowed 1--Students may record classroom lectures, audio/visual presentations, or discussions at any time without the
instructor’s permission.
2--Students may record classroom lectures, audio/visual presentations, or discussions but only with the
instructor’s permission.
3--Students registered with the Disability Services Office who wish to record classroom lectures, audio/visual
presentations, or discussions must present a signed Letter of Accommodation from the Office of Disability
Services.
For each option (1-3), add the following: Such recordings are to be used solely for the purposes of individual or group study with other students enrolled
in this class. They may not be reproduced, shared with those not in the class, or uploaded to publicly accessible
web environments. Students must destroy recordings at the end of the term in which they are enrolled in the
class.
Students found in violation of this policy may be subject to disciplinary action under the university’s Code of
Student Conduct.
190
190
APPENDIX 22: BLENDED-ONLINE COURSE POLICY (Approved by the Provost, spring 2011, revised spring 2017)
Purpose
This policy is intended to outline the policies and procedures for the approval, scheduling, and
implementation of credit-bearing distance education courses for the main campus and the professional
schools.
Definitions UIW uses the same definition for distance education as the Texas Higher Education Coordinating Board:
“the formal educational process that occurs when students and instructors are not in the same physical setting
for the majority (more than 50 percent) of instruction.” http://www.thecb.state.tx.us
A course is considered to be blended if 50-84% of the instruction occurs when students and instructors are
not in the same place.
A course is considered to be online if 85% or more of the instruction occurs when students and instructors
are not in the same place.
These definitions exclude internship and practicum courses.
Contact and Instruction Hours
To meet legal expectations in Texas, a traditionally delivered three-semester-credit-course should contain 45
to 48 contact hours depending on whether there is a final exam (Texas Administrative Code 19.1.4.A.4.6e).
Proposed blended and online courses must comply with state and UIW standards in this area (see UIW’s
“Definition of a Credit Hour,” Faculty Handbook, p. 109).
Approval Process 1) For already approved face to face courses.
Proposals to offer an already approved face to face course in a blended or online format are handled
at the college/school level (category A change). Approval is handled by the college/school
curriculum committee and the dean. Faculty or disciplines requesting approval to add the course as
an on-line/blended option for the first time will fill out the Request to Offer a Blended or Online
Course. Once approved at the college/school level, the dean will forward the curriculum processing
form to the undergraduate or graduate curriculum council for notification to the registrar so that the
appropriate coding is added to the Banner course catalog.
2) For new courses or disciplines intending to offer the majority of courses in a blended or online
format.
Disciplines that wish to offer new courses in a blended or on-line option or are proposing that the majority
of courses in a major be offered at a distance or for multiple delivery methods will follow the normal
curriculum approval process as outlined in Chapter 7 of the UIW Faculty Handbook.
Consistency in Quality Instruction and Delivery Methods
For the sake of student learning outcomes, blended and online course content must be presented in a manner
that uses a consistent style guide, navigational structure, content standards, and interaction standards. To
guarantee adherence to the best practices instructional standards (currently Quality Matters standards)
adopted by UIW, faculty members must use the approved university learning management system and the
official course template for blended and online delivery.
For a both blended and on-line courses, faculty are required to submit a Request to Offer a Blended or
Online Course (see at end of this document). If the course has previously been taught by other instructors in
a blended or online format, the new instructor is encouraged to use and build upon the course developed and
191
191
previously approved. If faculty members lack experience or training, it is expected that faculty will
participate in training offered by the UIW Instructional Technology staff and the Center for Teaching and
Learning to insure that the course is developed according to Quality Matters course design standards.
Quality Matters (QM) is a faculty-centered, peer review process that is designed to certify the quality of
online courses and online components of blended courses. The faculty member will provide such evidence
with the proposal submitted for course approval. In designing the course in Blackboard, faculty must utilize
the UIW course template and are encouraged to consult with the UIW Instructional Technology staff to
ensure course design consistency. A minimum of 1/3 of the learning modules must be built in the approved
LMS before the course can be reviewed and approved by the appropriate curriculum committee.
Teaching Load Guidelines Blended and online course assignments are determined by each college/school. Blended, online and face-to-
face courses are considered equivalent teaching responsibilities. The individual faculty workload is
determined in consultation with the academic program leader and dean.
Class Size Blended or online course class size is determined by the dean and should not vary significantly from related
face-to-face classes. Deans consult with faculty on workload if enrollments are to increase.
Availability All faculty teaching blended or online courses must comply with all policies related to office hours, advising,
and service to their department or college/school. Refer to the Faculty Handbook for specific policies.
Faculty must post their availability, contact information, and response-time policy in their outlines. All
faculty must abide by a response time commitment of no longer than 48 hours, not including weekends or
holidays.
Student Notice and Support
Each blended course should be identified as such in UIW’s Schedule of Courses with a BL designation, and
each online course with an ONL designation. If a course required for the completion of a degree program is
offered only in a blended or online format, notice of that requirement should also be posted in the degree
plan and bulletin. All blended and online courses should include an orientation session to familiarize
students with the technology being employed. The course outline should also contain information about
required technological tools, any helpful tutorials, and access information for the 24-hour Help Desk. UIW’s
policies on students with disabilities apply to all courses and the official policy statement should be included
in the course outline for blended and online courses.
Intellectual Property
Course materials developed by the instructor of a blended or online course are subject to the UIW policy on
intellectual property (see the Employee Handbook, Ch. 14, p. 126 on the HR website).
192
192
University of the Incarnate Word
Request to Offer a Blended or Online Course or Set of Courses
This form is used the first time a faculty member or discipline is seeking approval to offer a course or set of
courses as either blended or on-line.
Instructor or Discipline:
Date of Request: Semester to be Offered:
Course Title: Blended
Online
For a blended course, the proposed combination of instructional time is _____% face-to-face and _____% non-face-to-
face. This combination must satisfy the 50 - 84% standard.
1. Would this blended or online course be the only way of satisfying a degree requirement?
____Yes ____No
2. Provide a rationale in terms of value to students for offering this course in a blended or online format.
3. Describe the technology to be used in teaching the course in addition to Blackboard course learning system
and explain how it adds value to the learning outcomes.
4. Describe the training that you have received or your experience with blended or online instruction.
5. Describe your action plan for acquiring necessary skills if you are new to blended or online teaching and have
not participated in formal training.
6. Has the course been reviewed using the Quality Matters Higher Education Rubric?
___ Yes ___ No
7. Please attach the course syllabus and course outline for the first 1/3 of the learning modules. Include the
following information:
1. How students will be oriented to the online portion of the course.
2. The faculty availability and response time policy.
3. Individual class topics, format, activities, assignments, assessments
Class # Topic
Format (on-line
or
face-to-face)
Class activities Assignments Assessment
The following are UIW policies for blended and online courses. Please check to indicate that you understand and
intend to comply with each policy:
The approved UIW LMS (Blackboard) site serves as the course portal
The course design meets the standards of the Quality Matters (QM) Higher Education Rubric
Plan for participating in UIW faculty development for blended or online teaching or description of
experience in such teaching
Date of Approval: ____________ Dean’s Signature: ______________________________
193
193
APPENDIX 23: FACULTY CREDENTIALS FOR TEACHING (Approved by the Provost, 11/5/14)
Policy
All teaching faculty who are instructors of record for credit-bearing courses are expected to meet the
credential guidelines published by SACSCOC (www.sacscoc.org/policies.asp#guidelines). In rare
occasions, limited exceptions to the guidelines may be justified.
To ensure that UIW employs only faculty who meet the SACSCOC requirements, the chair of the
employing department must formally request the employment of each full-time or part-time member of the
teaching faculty. The request must be made for the faculty member’s initial hire, and any time teaching
assignments are proposed to extend beyond those originally approved.
The request will be submitted on the Certification of Faculty Qualifications form, indicating the course(s)
the faculty member will teach along with the faculty member’s qualifications to teach the course(s). In cases
that require exceptions, a justification must be documented, which may include relevant publications,
awards, prizes, employer references on letterhead stationery, professional training, work experience, and
evidence of recognition of competence by peers in that field.
The chair’s request must be approved by the respective dean, the vice president for extended academic
programs (for EAP faculty), and finally the provost. The approved request will be maintained in the faculty
member’s personnel file – in the provost office for full-time faculty, and in the respective dean’s office for
part-time faculty.
Certification Form (See next page)
194
194
UNIVERSITY OF THE INCARNATE WORD
Certification of Full-time and Part-time Faculty Qualifications for Teaching Complete upon initial hiring of full-time and part-time faculty. Update when proposed teaching assignments extend beyond those originally approved.
☐Full Time Faculty ☐Part Time Faculty
Hire Date Academic Term Academic Year
Name UIW PIDM
Appointing Department School/College
Degrees Awarded Field of Study Awarding Institution Teaching Field (s) Research Field(s)
COURSES FACULTY MEMBER IS QUALIFIED TO TEACH -- LIST EITHER THE GROUPS OF COURSES FOR WHICH THE
FACULTY MEMBER IS QUALIFIED TO TEACH, OR LIST THE INDIVIDUAL COURSES THE FACULTY MEMBER IS QUALIFIED
TO TEACH (e.g. all courses, introductory, non-majors courses within the discipline; a specific sub-discipline within
the major).
Identify Group or Related Courses Individual Course(s)
Course Number Course Title
MARK THE FACULTY MEMBER’S QUALIFICATION TO TEACH GROUPED/LISTED COURSES:
( ) Terminal degree in the teaching field
( ) Master’s degree and 18 graduate hours in the teaching field
(18 hours might not be in the awarded master’s, and that is allowable)
Narrative Required When Marked Below
( ) **18 graduate hours in the teaching field, no master’s degree (list course titles, credit hours, include narrative)
If justification includes “18 graduate hours” or more of coursework, list the course titles and number of credit hours, drawn from the
faculty member’s transcripts. Include special limitations on teaching assignments as required by the department or dean.
( ) **Exception requested (Include narrative and fully document) Briefly explain how the faculty member’s credentials qualify the teaching of courses listed. (e.g. industry experience).
**Required Supporting Narrative
Certified by: Department Chair Print Name Date
Approved by: Dean Print Name Date
EAP Candidate Approved by: VP, EAP Print Name Date Approved by:
Provost Date
195
195
APPENDIX 24: MULTI-YEAR, RENEWABLE TERM FACULTY APPOINTMENTS (Approved by Provost, 6/16)
Policy
This policy is intended to define the option to offer qualified faculty multi-year renewable-term appointments.
Definition Multi-year, renewable-term faculty appointments are non-tenure-track positions in which the faculty member will be
provided a contract with a term of two to five years which may be renewed. Multi-year appointments at the rank of
assistant professor, associate professor, and full professor are considered General Faculty with full faculty status and
the right to participate in faculty governance. Faculty members holding a multi-year appointment will be neither
tenured nor eligible to achieve tenure in this position. Evaluations will be annual. Faculty holding a multi-year
appointment are evaluated according to standards and procedures outlined in Chapter 5 of the UIW Faculty Handbook.
Eligibility While UIW is an institution that honors and supports the tenure system for the majority of faculty, having the option of
a non-tenure track with promotion provides the university with a way to make a commitment to faculty in disciplines
or schools that do not normally use a tenure system. Renewable-term faculty are those with terminal degrees or
professional degrees hired to work in academic units where tenure is not an option or is optional. Currently those units
are the Rosenberg School of Optometry, the School of Osteopathic Medicine and the Division of Extended Academic
Programs. Once faculty have completed a probationary period of one to five years and upon the academic dean’s
recommendation and with the approval of the provost, a multi-year appointment may be granted to faculty who meet
the standards outlined in Chapter 5 of the UIW Faculty Handbook and the following criteria:
a. Faculty member who qualifies for the rank of assistant professor or above.
b. Faculty member consistently demonstrates satisfactory performance as assessed by the annual evaluation
as outlined in the UIW Faculty Handbook.
c. Position must be a permanently funded line.
Reappointment Multi-year, renewable-term appointments may be renewed if the faculty member meets the “Eligibility” criteria set out
in the preceding paragraph.
The multi-year appointment is contingent upon the continuing viability of the particular academic unit, program or
course, and the decision of the university to continue funding this department at current levels.
Promotion
Renewable-term faculty may be eligible for promotion according to the standards and procedures outlined in the UIW
Faculty Handbook for all full-time faculty.
Salary and Benefits Salary and benefits will adhere to established university policies. Merit increases in salary will be under the same
terms and conditions as apply to all UIW faculty.
Non-reappointment
Notification of non-reappointment for faculty holding a multi-year appointment will be given in writing by October 1st
of the final year of the appointment.
The University reserves the right to take necessary and appropriate employment action in the event of violation of
University policies and procedures.
Appeal of Non-reappointment Decisions The non-tenure track non-reappointment appeal process is found in Chapter 4 of the UIW Faculty Handbook “Policies
and Procedures Governing Faculty Employment.”
196
196
REVISIONS SINCE OCTOBER 2012—SUMMARY
10/12/12: The Board approves the October 2012 edition of the Faculty Handbook.
10/24/12: The Provost approves the president and Chairs of the Undergraduate Curriculum Committee
and the Graduate Council becoming voting members of the University Planning Commission
and the Academic Leadership Team.
10/24/12: The Provost approves the process for appointment to the Graduate Faculty. 11/14/12: The Senate clarifies that “adjunct” is reserved for faculty mentoring students at clinical or
practice sites in the community.
3/20/13: The Provost approves a Sabbatical Application Template, and Senate action to add the Faculty
Athletic Representative as a non-voting member of the Senate, and add procedures for
breaking a tie vote in elections.
8/6/13: The Provost approves changing the name and description of the Assessment Committee to the
Institutional Effectiveness Committee; revised to Council, 11/20/13.
11/20/13: The Provost approves changing the name and description of the Core Advisory Committee to
a Council; also approved is the Classroom Recording Policy.
3/13/14: The Core Advisory Council approves inclusion of CAC in Ch. 8 to reflect practice.
3/19/14: The Provost approves the amended Faculty Senate Constitution and Bylaws.
3/19/14: The Provost approves a statement on the Faculty Athletics Representative in Chapter 2.
3/19/14: The Provost approves amendments to the description of Unsatisfactory Performance in
Chapter 5. 4/16/14: The Provost approves an amendment to the Policies on Academic Freedom.
4/16/14: The Provost approves a change for when FSIs are due, the Friday after grades are in.
4/27/14: The Provost approves the Blended Course Policy.
5/14: The Provost approves the Part-Time Faculty Workload Policy.
7/14/14: The Provost approves the policy on Definition of a Credit Hour.
11/5/14: The Provost approves the addition of clarification in A and J under Article V, and change of
name of the Undergraduate Curriculum Committee to the Undergraduate Council.
11/5/14: The Provost approves the policy and form on faculty credentials for teaching as Appendix 23.
12/3/14: The Provost approves the addition of an exception to the terminal degree for CHASS.
12/5/14: The Board endorses a revision to the Mission Statement; and the Congregation approves the
revision on 2/5/15.
3/4/15: The Provost approves the clarification of the duties and of officers and senators.
4/29/15: The Provost approves revisions of the application timelines for the third-year review and
promotion to Senior Instructor.
9/30/15: The Provost approves removal of progress toward terminal degree condition from promotion
to Senior Instructor.
11/4//15: The Senate clarifies the promotion timeline to connect tenure and promotion review.
12/2/15: The Senate clarifies that for promotion, the Rank & Tenure Committee receives separate
recommendation letters from the dean, the college/school meeting of tenured faculty, and other
individuals.
2/3/16: The Provost approves updates to Ch. 7, Curriculum Development and Revision (effective May
2016).
3/30/16: The Provost approves a change of minimum faculty office hours, addition of Rank and Tenure
Advisory Committee Guidelines, and revisions to the Application Timeline for
Tenure/Promotion to Associate Professor and Full Professor (all effective May 2016).
5/11/16: The Provost approves additions to the Scholarship Activity Checklist Guidelines (effective
May 2016); the Senate clarifies additions needed for election ballot information (effective May
2016).
6/16: Provost approves policy on multi-year, renewable term appointments
9/7/16: The Provost approves the addition of requiring candidates for elected positions in the Faculty
Senate to provide a brief biographical statement to the Nominations and Elections Committee
197
197
(effective June 2017).
10/7/16: The Provost approves eligibility of faculty with multi-year renewable-term appointments to
hold positions in Faculty Governance previously restricted to faculty members with tenure,
such as, Faculty Senate President and Vice-President and members of the Grievance
Committee and the University Rank and Tenure Committee (effective June 2017).
11/2/16: The Provost approves modification of timeline in Letter from Rank and Tenure to faculty
eligible for promotion and/or tenure (effective June 2017).
01/17: The Acting President dissolves the University Planning Commission
4/26/17: The Provost approves updates to the Faculty Development Funds Process and Application
Form (effective June 2017).
4/26/17: The Provost approves the modification of the exception to terminal degree in Interior Design
(effective June 2017).
4/26/17: The Provost approves the addition of the exception to the terminal degree in 3D Animation
and Game Design (effective June 2017).
5/31/17 The Provost approves revisions to the Blended-Online Course policy
5/31/17 The Provost approves revisions to Policy Concerning Salaries Funded by Grants
6/31/17 The Provost Approves adding term limits to FAR.